Canon 2983b013aa IPF750 User Manual B6fb9f70 F53a 4151 A117 C3a7f75b1d3d
User Manual: canon 2983b013aa Canon Printer 2983B013AA User Guide |
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 742
Download | |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
Lar g e F o r m a t P r i n t e r User Manual ENG Contents Contents Introduction 1 How to use this manual.....................................................................................1 About This User Manual...............................................................................................................1 Searching Topics..........................................................................................................................3 HTML Version of the Manual for Printing......................................................................................5 Printer Parts 13 Printer parts.....................................................................................................13 Front...........................................................................................................................................13 Side............................................................................................................................................15 Top Cover (Inside)......................................................................................................................16 Roll Cover (Inside)......................................................................................................................17 Carriage......................................................................................................................................17 Ink Tank Cover (Inside)...............................................................................................................18 Stand..........................................................................................................................................19 Control Panel..............................................................................................................................20 Control Panel...................................................................................................22 Control Panel..............................................................................................................................22 Turning the Printer On and Off...................................................................................................24 Control Panel Display.................................................................................................................26 How to View Instructions With Navigate.....................................................................................29 Printer Menu Operations............................................................................................................30 Menu Operations........................................................................................................................32 Menu Structure...........................................................................................................................35 Menu Settings............................................................................................................................49 Menu Settings (During Printing).................................................................................................60 Status Print.................................................................................................................................62 Printing Interface Setting Reports..............................................................................................65 Checking Instructions During Printer Operations.......................................................................69 Optional accessories.......................................................................................70 Roll Holder Set...........................................................................................................................70 Printer Specifications.......................................................................................71 Specifications.............................................................................................................................71 Print Area....................................................................................................................................75 Basic Printing Workflow 76 Printing procedure...........................................................................................76 Printing Options Using Rolls and Sheets...................................................................................76 Loading and Printing on Rolls....................................................................................................78 Loading and Printing on Sheets.................................................................................................81 Printing in Windows....................................................................................................................83 Contents � Contents Printing in Mac OS X..................................................................................................................84 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows)......................................................................86 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X)....................................................................88 Canceling print jobs.........................................................................................90 Canceling Print Jobs from the Control Panel.............................................................................90 Canceling Print Jobs from Windows...........................................................................................91 Canceling Print Jobs from Mac OS X.........................................................................................92 Pausing Printing...............................................................................................94 Pausing Printing.........................................................................................................................94 Handling Paper 95 Paper...............................................................................................................95 Types of Paper...........................................................................................................................95 Paper Sizes..............................................................................................................................100 Handling rolls.................................................................................................103 Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls.............................................................................................103 Loading Rolls in the Printer......................................................................................................106 Changing the Type of Paper..................................................................................................... 110 Specifying the Paper Length.................................................................................................... 112 Printing From a Desired Starting Point..................................................................................... 113 Removing the Roll from the Printer.......................................................................................... 116 Removing the Roll Holder from Rolls....................................................................................... 118 Clearing Jammed Roll Paper...................................................................................................120 Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot).............................................................................123 Feeding Roll Paper Manually...................................................................................................125 Keeping Track of the Amount of Roll Paper Left......................................................................126 Specifying the Ink Drying Time for Rolls...................................................................................127 Specifying the Cutting Method for Rolls...................................................................................129 Cutting the Leading Edge of Roll Paper Automatically.............................................................133 Reducing Dust from Cutting Rolls............................................................................................134 Roll Holder Set.........................................................................................................................135 Handling sheets.............................................................................................136 Loading Sheets in the Printer...................................................................................................136 Changing the Type of Paper.....................................................................................................139 Printing From a Desired Starting Point.....................................................................................141 Removing Sheets.....................................................................................................................144 Clearing a Jammed Sheet........................................................................................................145 Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot).............................................................................148 Output Stacker...............................................................................................150 Using the Output Stacker.........................................................................................................150 Working With Various Print Jobs 152 Printing Photos and Images...........................................................................152 Printing Photos and Images.....................................................................................................152 Printing Photos and Images (Windows)...................................................................................154 ii Contents Contents Printing Photos and Images (Mac OS X).................................................................................156 Printing CAD Drawings..................................................................................159 Printing CAD Drawings.............................................................................................................159 Printing Line Drawings and Text...............................................................................................160 Printing Line Drawings and Text (Windows).............................................................................162 Printing Line Drawings and Text (Mac OS X)...........................................................................164 Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings.........................................................................167 Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings (Windows).......................................................168 HP-GL/2 Printing......................................................................................................................170 Printing Office Documents.............................................................................171 Printing Office Documents........................................................................................................171 Printing Office Documents (Windows)......................................................................................172 Printing Office Documents (Mac OS X)....................................................................................174 Enhanced Printing Options 177 Adjusting Images...........................................................................................177 Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver...................................................................................177 Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Windows).............................................................181 Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Mac OS X)...........................................................184 Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing....................................187 Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Windows)..........................................190 Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Mac OS X)........................................192 Choosing Paper for Printing...........................................................................194 Choosing a Paper for Printing..................................................................................................194 Changing the Type of Paper.....................................................................................................195 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver......................................................................................197 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows)....................................................................197 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X)..................................................................199 Printing enlargements or reductions..............................................................201 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size.............................................................................201 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows)...........................................................202 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X).........................................................204 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width....................................................................................207 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows)..................................................................208 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X)................................................................210 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value.......................................................................213 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Windows).....................................................214 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Mac OS X)....................................................216 Printing at full size..........................................................................................219 Printing on Oversized Paper....................................................................................................219 Printing at Full Size (Windows)................................................................................................220 Printing at Full Size (Mac OS X)...............................................................................................222 Borderless Printing at Actual Size............................................................................................225 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows)..........................................................................227 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X)........................................................................229 Contents iii Contents Borderless Printing........................................................................................232 Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size......................................................................232 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows).......................234 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X).....................236 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width................................................239 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows)..............................241 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X)............................243 Borderless Printing at Actual Size............................................................................................246 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows)..........................................................................248 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X)........................................................................250 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes............................................253 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing)..............................................253 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Windows)..............................254 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Mac OS X)............................258 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes....................................................................................261 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Windows)..................................................................262 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Mac OS X).................................................................266 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet...............................................................269 Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other.........................................................................269 Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Windows).......................................................271 Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Mac OS X).....................................................273 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously.......................................................................................275 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Windows).....................................................................276 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Mac OS X)...................................................................278 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet............................................................................................280 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Windows)..........................................................................281 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Mac OS X)........................................................................283 Printing Posters in Sections.....................................................................................................286 Printing Large Posters (Windows)............................................................................................287 Centering originals.........................................................................................289 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls........................................................................................289 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Windows)......................................................................290 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Mac OS X)....................................................................292 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets.....................................................................................295 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Windows)...................................................................296 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Mac OS X).................................................................298 Conserving roll paper.....................................................................................301 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees.......................................................301 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Windows).....................................302 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Mac OS X)....................................304 Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins.......................307 Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Windows).....308 Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Mac OS X)...310 Checking Images Before Printing..................................................................313 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing...................................................................313 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows).................................................315 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X)...............................................317 iv Contents Contents Other useful settings......................................................................................318 Printing With Watermarks.........................................................................................................318 Printing with Watermarks-COPY, FILE COPY, and so on (Windows)......................................319 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation..................................................321 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Windows)................................322 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Mac OS X)..............................324 Using Favorites........................................................................................................................327 Using Favorites (Windows)......................................................................................................328 Using Favorites (Mac OS X).....................................................................................................330 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing...............................................................................................331 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Windows).............................................................................332 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Mac OS X)...........................................................................333 Windows Software 336 Printer Driver..................................................................................................336 Printer Driver Settings (Windows)............................................................................................336 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows)....................................................................338 Confirming Print Settings (Windows)........................................................................................340 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows).................................................342 Using Favorites (Windows)......................................................................................................344 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Windows)....................................346 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from the Operating System Menu (Windows)..........348 Main Sheet (Windows).............................................................................................................350 Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Windows)................................................................353 Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Windows).......................................................................354 View Settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Windows)............................................355 Color Adjustment Sheet: Color (Windows)...............................................................................356 Object Adjustment dialog box: Color........................................................................................358 Matching Sheet (Windows)......................................................................................................359 Color Adjustment Sheet: Monochrome (Windows)...................................................................361 Object Adjustment dialog box: Monochrome............................................................................363 Page Setup Sheet (Windows)..................................................................................................364 Paper Size Options Dialog Box (Windows)..............................................................................367 Layout Sheet (Windows)..........................................................................................................368 Page Options Dialog Box (Windows).......................................................................................370 Special Settings Dialog Box (Windows)...................................................................................371 Favorites Sheet (Windows)......................................................................................................372 Utility Sheet (Windows)............................................................................................................374 Support Sheet (Windows)........................................................................................................375 Settings Summaries Dialog Box (Windows).............................................................................376 Device Settings Sheet (Windows)............................................................................................377 Preview..........................................................................................................378 The Features of Preview..........................................................................................................378 Operating Environment............................................................................................................378 Starting Preview.......................................................................................................................379 Preview Main Window..............................................................................................................380 Dialog Area...............................................................................................................................382 Print on the Center...................................................................................................................384 Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom.........................................................................................385 Contents Contents Priority setting for rotating 90 degrees.....................................................................................386 Printing with Selecting the Layout............................................................................................387 Enlarge/Reduce the screen display..........................................................................................389 Moving a Page.........................................................................................................................389 Using the ruler..........................................................................................................................389 Free Layout....................................................................................................390 The Features of Free Layout....................................................................................................390 Operating Environment............................................................................................................390 Starting Free Layout.................................................................................................................391 Free Layout Main Window........................................................................................................393 Detailed Settings......................................................................................................................394 Preferences Dialog Box............................................................................................................395 Page Options Dialog Box.........................................................................................................397 Zoom Dialog Box......................................................................................................................398 Format Dialog Box....................................................................................................................399 Laying out a Multiple-File Document on One Page..................................................................401 Laying out a Document Created with Multiple Application Programs on One Page.................404 Selecting an Object..................................................................................................................407 Changing the Object Size.........................................................................................................408 Moving an Object.....................................................................................................................409 Rotating an Object....................................................................................................................409 Laying out Objects Automatically.............................................................................................410 Aligning Objects....................................................................................................................... 411 Changing the Object Overlapping Order..................................................................................413 Pasting a Copied or Cut Object................................................................................................415 Folded Duplex Window............................................................................................................416 Prints using Folded Duplex......................................................................................................418 Finished Size Settings Dialog Box...........................................................................................419 Binding Settings Dialog Box.....................................................................................................420 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.....................................................421 The Features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.....................................................421 Operating Environment............................................................................................................421 Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy..................................................................422 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Dialog Box.............................................................424 Hot Folder.................................................................................................................................425 Creating a New Hot Folder.......................................................................................................426 Specifying an Existing Shared Folder as a Hot Folder.............................................................429 Setting the Print Parameters....................................................................................................431 Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows)...........432 Status Monitor................................................................................................434 The Features of imagePROGRAF Status Monitor...................................................................434 Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Status Monitor.......................................................436 Accounting.....................................................................................................437 Accounting Manager................................................................................................................437 Launching the Accounting Manager.........................................................................................437 Accounting Manager Main Window..........................................................................................438 Accounting Manager Basic Procedures...................................................................................441 Configuring Unit Costs in Accounting Manager........................................................................441 vi Contents Contents Setting the Unit Cost for Ink.....................................................................................................442 Setting the Unit Cost for Paper.................................................................................................443 Setting the Unit Cost for Items Other Than Ink and Paper.......................................................444 Configuring Units and Display Settings in Accounting Manager..............................................445 Automatically Acquiring Print Job Logs at Regular Intervals....................................................446 Canceling Regular Print Job Log Acquisition...........................................................................446 Switching Between Displaying Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs.........................447 Exporting Print Job Data as a CSV File...................................................................................447 Showing Job Properties...........................................................................................................448 Showing, Saving and Loading Selected Unit Cost Data..........................................................448 Showing the Total Amount of Ink and Paper Consumed..........................................................448 Digital Photo Front-Access............................................................................449 Digital Photo Front-Access.......................................................................................................449 Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals......................................................450 Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals ................................................................................450 Device Setup Utility........................................................................................452 imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility......................................................................................452 Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility......................................................................452 Configuring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility................................453 Mac OS X Software 454 Printer Driver..................................................................................................454 Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)..........................................................................................454 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X)..................................................................455 Confirming Print Settings (Mac OS X)......................................................................................457 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X)...............................................459 Using Favorites (Mac OS X).....................................................................................................460 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Mac OS X)..................................460 Main Pane (Mac OS X)............................................................................................................461 Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Mac OS X)..............................................................464 Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Mac OS X).....................................................................465 View settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Mac OS X)...........................................466 Color Settings Pane: Color (Mac OS X)...................................................................................467 Color Settings Pane: Monochrome (Mac OS X).......................................................................469 Page Setup Pane (Mac OS X).................................................................................................471 Utility Pane (Mac OS X)...........................................................................................................473 Additional Settings Pane (Mac OS X)......................................................................................474 Support Pane (Mac OS X)........................................................................................................475 Preview..........................................................................................................476 The Features of Preview..........................................................................................................476 Operating Environment............................................................................................................476 Starting Preview.......................................................................................................................477 Preview Main Window..............................................................................................................478 Paper Settings Panel................................................................................................................480 Easy Settings...........................................................................................................................482 Advanced Settings...................................................................................................................484 Output Settings Panel..............................................................................................................485 Contents vii Contents Color Settings Panel.................................................................................................................487 Color Adjustment......................................................................................................................488 Matching...................................................................................................................................490 Driver Matching Mode..............................................................................................................492 ICC Matching Mode..................................................................................................................493 ColorSync.................................................................................................................................494 Preferences Dialog Box............................................................................................................495 Zoom Dialog Box......................................................................................................................495 Go to Page Dialog Box.............................................................................................................495 Print with No Borders...............................................................................................................496 Print on the Center...................................................................................................................497 Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom.........................................................................................498 Print Page Rotated 90 Degrees...............................................................................................499 Display with Fitting to the Width of the Paper...........................................................................500 Display with All.........................................................................................................................501 Display with Actual Size...........................................................................................................502 Moving a Page.........................................................................................................................503 Free Layout....................................................................................................504 The Features of Free Layout....................................................................................................504 Operating Environment............................................................................................................504 Starting Free Layout.................................................................................................................505 Free Layout Main Window........................................................................................................506 Paper Settings Panel................................................................................................................508 Easy Settings...........................................................................................................................510 Advanced Settings...................................................................................................................512 Color Settings Panel.................................................................................................................513 Color Adjustment......................................................................................................................514 Matching...................................................................................................................................516 Driver Matching Mode..............................................................................................................518 ICC Matching Mode..................................................................................................................519 ColorSync.................................................................................................................................520 Preferences Dialog Box............................................................................................................521 Page Setup Dialog Box............................................................................................................523 Zoom Dialog Box......................................................................................................................524 Format Dialog Box....................................................................................................................525 Laying out a Multiple-File Document on One Page..................................................................526 Laying out a Document Created with Multiple Application Programs on One Page.................526 Selecting an Object..................................................................................................................527 Changing the Object Size.........................................................................................................528 Moving an Object.....................................................................................................................529 Rotating an Object....................................................................................................................529 Laying out Objects Automatically.............................................................................................530 Aligning Objects.......................................................................................................................531 Changing the Object Overlapping Order..................................................................................533 Pasting a Copied or Cut Object................................................................................................535 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.....................................................536 The Features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.....................................................536 Operating Environment............................................................................................................536 Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy..................................................................537 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Dialog Box.............................................................538 viii Contents Contents Hot Folder.................................................................................................................................539 Creating a New Hot Folder.......................................................................................................539 Editing a Hot Folder (Setting Print Conditions).........................................................................541 Deleting a Hot Folder...............................................................................................................543 Setting the Print Parameters....................................................................................................544 Paper Settings Panel................................................................................................................544 Easy Settings...........................................................................................................................546 Advanced Settings...................................................................................................................548 Output Settings Panel..............................................................................................................549 Color Settings Panel.................................................................................................................551 Driver Matching Mode..............................................................................................................552 ICC Matching Mode..................................................................................................................553 ColorSync.................................................................................................................................554 Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Mac OS X).........555 Printmonitor...................................................................................................557 The Features of imagePROGRAF Printmonitor.......................................................................557 Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Printmonitor..........................................................558 Network Setting 560 Network Setting.............................................................................................560 Network Environment...............................................................................................................560 Configuring the IP Address on the Printer................................................................................563 Configuring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility................................564 Configuring the IP Address Using the Printer Control Panel....................................................565 Configuring the IP Address Using ARP and PING Commands................................................567 Configuring TCP/IPv6 Network Settings..................................................................................568 Using RemoteUI.......................................................................................................................569 Configuring the Printer's TCP/IP Network Settings..................................................................570 Configuring the Printer's AppleTalk Network Settings..............................................................574 Configuring the Printer's NetWare Network Settings................................................................575 Specifying Printer-Related Information.....................................................................................577 Configuring the Communication Mode Manually......................................................................578 Email Notification When Printing is Finished or Errors Occur..................................................579 Initializing the Network Settings...............................................................................................580 Network Setting (Windows)...........................................................................581 Configuring the Printer Driver Destination (Windows)..............................................................581 Sharing the Printer in Windows................................................................................................582 Configuring the Printer's NetWare Network Settings................................................................584 Specifying the Printer's Frame Type.........................................................................................586 Specifying NetWare Print Services...........................................................................................588 Specifying NetWare Protocols..................................................................................................591 Configuring NetWare Network Settings....................................................................................593 Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility......................................................................594 Configuring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility................................595 Network Setting (Mac OS X)..........................................................................596 Configuring the Printer Driver Destination (Macintosh)............................................................596 Configuring the Printer's AppleTalk Network Settings..............................................................597 Configuring the Destination for AppleTalk Networks (Macintosh).............................................598 Contents ix Contents Configuring the Destination in TCP/IP Networks (Macintosh)..................................................600 Configuring the Destination for Bonjour Network (Macintosh).................................................602 Adjustments for Better Print Quality 603 Adjusting the Printhead..................................................................................603 Adjusting the Printhead............................................................................................................603 Automatic Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.).................................604 Manual Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.).....................................606 Adjusting Line Misalignment (Head Inc. Adj.)...........................................................................608 Troubleshooting Paper Abrasion and Blurry Images (Head Height)......................................... 611 Adjusting the feed amount.............................................................................612 Adjusting the Feed Amount......................................................................................................612 Selecting a Feed Amount Adjustment Method (Feed Priority)..................................................613 Automatic Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality)...........................................................................614 Manual Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality)...............................................................................616 Fine-Tuning the Paper Feed Amount (Adj. Fine Feed).............................................................618 Adjusting Line Length (Adjust Length).....................................................................................619 Adjusting the Vacuum Strength (VacuumStrngth)....................................................................621 Maintenance 622 Ink Tanks........................................................................................................622 Ink Tanks..................................................................................................................................622 Replacing Ink Tanks.................................................................................................................623 Checking Ink Tank Levels.........................................................................................................628 When to Replace Ink Tanks......................................................................................................629 Printheads......................................................................................................630 Printhead..................................................................................................................................630 Checking for Nozzle Clogging..................................................................................................630 Cleaning the Printhead.............................................................................................................632 Replacing the Printhead...........................................................................................................633 Maintenance Cartridge..................................................................................639 Maintenance Cartridge.............................................................................................................639 Replacing the Maintenance Cartridge......................................................................................639 Checking the Remaining Maintenance Cartridge Capacity......................................................644 When to Replace the Maintenance Cartridge..........................................................................645 Cleaning the Printer.......................................................................................646 Cleaning the Printer Exterior....................................................................................................646 Cleaning Inside the Top Cover.................................................................................................647 Cleaning the Printhead.............................................................................................................650 Other Maintenance........................................................................................651 Preparing to Transfer the Printer..............................................................................................651 Updating the Firmware.............................................................................................................654 Contents Contents Troubleshooting 655 Frequently Asked Questions..........................................................................655 Frequently Asked Questions....................................................................................................655 Problems Regarding Paper...........................................................................657 Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot).............................................................................657 Clearing Jammed Roll Paper...................................................................................................659 Clearing a Jammed Sheet........................................................................................................662 Roll Paper Cannot be Inserted into the Paper Feed Slot.........................................................665 Cannot load sheets..................................................................................................................665 Paper is not cut straight............................................................................................................665 Paper is not cut........................................................................................................................665 Depression on the leading edge is left.....................................................................................665 The size of clear film cannot be detected.................................................................................665 Roll Paper is Continuously Ejected..........................................................................................666 Printing does not start....................................................................................667 The Data Reception Lamp on the Control Panel does not light up..........................................667 The printer does not respond even if print jobs are sent..........................................................667 Ink Filling.. is displayed............................................................................................................667 The display screen indicates Agitating.....................................................................................667 The printer stops during a print job................................................................668 An error message is shown on the Display Screen..................................................................668 The printer ejects blank, unprinted paper.................................................................................668 The printer stops when printing a HP-GL/2 job (the carriage stops moving)............................668 Problems with the printing quality..................................................................669 Printing is faint..........................................................................................................................669 Paper rubs against the Printhead.............................................................................................670 The edges of the paper are dirty..............................................................................................671 The surface of the paper is dirty...............................................................................................672 The back side of the paper is dirty...........................................................................................672 Printed colors are inaccurate....................................................................................................673 Banding in different colors occurs............................................................................................674 Colors in printed images are uneven........................................................................................675 Image edges are blurred or white banding occurs...................................................................676 The contrast becomes uneven during printing.........................................................................676 The length of printed images is inaccurate in the feeding direction.........................................677 Images are printed crooked......................................................................................................677 Documents are printed in monochrome...................................................................................677 Line thickness is not uniform....................................................................................................678 Lines are misaligned................................................................................................................678 Problems with the printing quality caused by the type of paper...............................................678 Cannot print over a network...........................................................................679 Cannot connect the printer to the network...............................................................................679 Cannot print over a TCP/IP network.........................................................................................679 Cannot print over a NetWare network......................................................................................680 Cannot print over AppleTalk or Bonjour networks....................................................................680 Contents xi Contents Installation problems......................................................................................681 Removing Installed Printer Drivers...........................................................................................681 HP-GL/2 problems.........................................................................................682 With HP-GL/2, printing is misaligned........................................................................................682 Lines or images are missing in printed HP-GL/2 jobs..............................................................682 Lines are printed too thick or thin in HP-GL/2 print jobs...........................................................682 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed in monochrome (or color)................................................................682 Printed colors of lines are inaccurate during HP-GL/2 printing................................................682 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed 6 mm larger than specified..............................................................683 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed at maximum size, even if a standard size is specified.....................683 HP-GL/2 printing takes a long time..........................................................................................683 Replotting with HP-GL/2 jobs is not possible...........................................................................683 The printer stops when printing a HP-GL/2 job (the carriage stops moving)............................683 Other problems..............................................................................................684 The printer does not go on.......................................................................................................684 If the Printer Makes a Strange Sound......................................................................................685 Messages advising to check the maintenance cartridge are not cleared.................................686 The printer consumes a lot of ink.............................................................................................686 Ink Level Detection...................................................................................................................687 Error Message 689 Messages regarding paper............................................................................689 MediaType Mismatch...............................................................................................................689 The paper is too small..............................................................................................................690 The paper is too small..............................................................................................................691 PaprWidth Mismatch................................................................................................................692 Paper size not detected............................................................................................................693 Insufficient paper for job...........................................................................................................694 This paper cannot be used.......................................................................................................694 Roll printing is selected............................................................................................................694 Roll printing is selected, but sheets are loaded........................................................................695 The roll is empty.......................................................................................................................695 Sheet printing is selected.........................................................................................................696 Regular printing is selected, but a roll is loaded.......................................................................696 Paper jam.................................................................................................................................697 Paper is crooked......................................................................................................................698 Paper not aligned with right guide............................................................................................699 Cannot detect papr...................................................................................................................699 Paper cutting failed...................................................................................................................700 End of paper feed.....................................................................................................................700 Rel lever is in wrong position....................................................................................................701 Borderless printng not possible................................................................................................701 Paper position not suitable for borderless printing...................................................................702 Roll paper is not securely in contact with roll holder.................................................................702 Messages regarding ink.................................................................................703 Ink insufficient...........................................................................................................................703 No ink left.................................................................................................................................703 xii Contents Contents Remaining level of the ink cannot be correctly detected..........................................................703 Unable to detect ink level correctly...........................................................................................703 Close Ink Tank Cover...............................................................................................................703 Ink tank is empty.......................................................................................................................704 Not much ink is left...................................................................................................................704 No ink tank loaded....................................................................................................................704 Wrong ink tank..........................................................................................................................704 Do not pull out ink tank.............................................................................................................704 Messages regarding printing or adjustment...................................................705 Cannot adjust printhead...........................................................................................................705 Cannot adjust paper feed.........................................................................................................705 Check printed document..........................................................................................................706 Messages regarding printheads....................................................................707 Cannot adjust printhead...........................................................................................................707 Wrong printhead.......................................................................................................................707 Printhead error.........................................................................................................................707 No printhead.............................................................................................................................708 Execute printhead cleaning......................................................................................................708 Messages regarding the maintenance cartridge............................................709 Insert the maintenance cartridge..............................................................................................709 Wrong maintenance cartridge..................................................................................................709 Maint. cart. The level is low......................................................................................................709 No Maintenance Cartridge capacity.........................................................................................709 Maintenance cartridge full........................................................................................................709 Maintenance cartridge problem................................................................................................709 Messages regarding HP-GL/2.......................................................................710 This type of paper is not compatible with HP-GL/2..................................................................710 GL2: Wxxxx The memory is full. (xxxx is 0501, 0903, or 0904)...............................................710 GL2: W0502 The parameter is out of range.............................................................................710 GL2: W0504 This command is not supported..........................................................................710 Other Messages............................................................................................ 711 GARO Wxxxx (x represents a number).................................................................................... 711 ERROR Exxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number)............................................................... 711 Hardware error. xxxxxxxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number)............................................ 711 Top cover is open..................................................................................................................... 711 Prepare for parts replacement..................................................................................................712 Parts replacement time has passed.........................................................................................712 Unknown file.............................................................................................................................712 Multi-sensor error.....................................................................................................................712 Error in cutter position..............................................................................................................712 Contents xiii Contents xiv Contents How to use this manual Introduction How to use this manual About This User Manual • Symbols The following symbols are used in this User Manual to indicate safety information and explanations on restrictions or precautions in use. Important Indicates important information that must be followed when using the printer. Be sure to read this information to prevent printer damage or operating errors. Caution Indicates caution items for which operating error poses a risk of injury or damage to equipment or property. To ensure safe use, always follow these precautions. Note Indicates helpful reference information and supplemental information on particular topics. • Button names and user interface elements Key and button names on the control panel and user interface elements in software (such as menus and buttons) are indicated as follows in this User Manual. Control panel buttons Example: Press the OK button. Control panel messages Example: Head Cleaning is displayed. Software interface items (Menus and Buttons) Example: Click OK. Keyboard keys Example: Press the Tab key. • Part names Names of printer parts are indicated as follows in this User Manual. Printer part names Example: Open the Top Cover. • Cross-reference Other pages or manuals that provide related information are indicated as follows in this User Manual. Cross-reference in the same user manual Example: see “Turning the Printer On and Off”. (→P.24) Cross-reference in related manuals Example: See the Paper Reference Guide. Other cross-reference Example: See the printer driver help. Introduction 1 How to use this manual • Figures and software screens • Figures in this User Manual may be different from the actual appearance of the printer in some cases. • Screens depicted in this User Manual for the printer driver or other software may be different from the actual screens because of subsequent updates. • Windows XP screens are used in explanations of Windows operations in this User Manual. • Trademarks • Canon, the Canon logo, and imagePROGRAF are trademarks or registered trademarks of Canon Inc. • Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries. • Macintosh is a registered trademark of Apple Inc. in the United States and other countries. • Other company and product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners. • Copyright © 2009 Canon Inc. • Unauthorized reproduction of this User Manual in whole or part is prohibited. • May we request Thank you for understanding the following points. • The information in this User Manual is subject to change without notice. • We strive to ensure accuracy of information in this User Manual, but if you notice errors or omissions, please contact us. 2 Introduction How to use this manual Searching Topics You can nd information in topics of this User Manual by searching for relevant terms. 1. Enter a term and click the Search button. Note • To search for multiple terms at once, enter a space between each term. Search results are listed at left. Introduction 3 How to use this manual 2. Click a topic you want to read. The terms you searched for will be highlighted in the topic. To review multiple topics at once, select the check box of desired topics and click the Apply button. 4 Introduction How to use this manual HTML Version of the Manual for Printing You can select a group of topics in the table of contents or individual topics in this manual for printing. The following procedure describes how to do this, using the information in Basic Printing Workow as an example. Printing a group of topics in the manual When you access printable HTML versions of the content from section titles in the table of contents, you can specify a group of topics to print. 1. Click a section title in the table of contents. Here, Basic Printing Workow is used as an example. Introduction 5 How to use this manual 2. Click Access to the HTML for printing in the title area. The topics in Basic Printing Workow are displayed together in HTML format, ready for printing. 6 Introduction How to use this manual 3. Clear the sections you will not print and click the Apply button. Printing a group of individual topics in the manual When you access printable HTML versions from subtitles in the table of contents, you can specify a group of topics to print. 1. Click a section title in the table of contents. Here, Basic Printing Workow is used as an example. Introduction 7 How to use this manual 2. Under Basic Printing Workow, click Printing Procedure. 3. Click Access to the HTML for printing in the title area. 8 Introduction How to use this manual The topics in Printing Procedure are displayed together in HTML format, ready for printing. 4. Clear the topics you will not print and click the Apply button. Introduction 9 How to use this manual Printing selected topics Print selected topics as follows. 1. Access the printing dialog box as follows, depending on your computer’s operating system. • Windows In Windows, right-click anywhere in the explanation area except on a gure or a link.In the shortcut menu, click Print to display the Print dialog box. 10 Introduction How to use this manual • Macintosh On a Macintosh computer, click anywhere in the explanation area except on a gure or a link while holding the Ctrl key. In the shortcut menu, click Print Frame to display the Print dialog box. 2. Specify conditions as needed, and then click Print (Windows) or Print (Macintosh). • Windows Introduction 11 How to use this manual • Macintosh Note • To print only individual topics that are displayed, use this method. 12 Introduction Printer parts Printer Parts Printer parts Front a. Roll Cover Open this cover to load rolls. (→P.17) b. Paper Feed Slot When loading paper, insert it here. c. Roll Ledge When loading rolls, rest the Roll Holder here before loading it in the Roll Holder Slot. d. Release Lever When releasing the Paper Retainer, push this lever back. e. Control Panel Use this panel to operate the printer and check the printer status. (→P.20) f. Ink Tank Cover Open this cover to replace an Ink Tank. (→P.18) g. Paper Alignment Line An orange line for alignment of paper. h. Maintenance Cartridge Cover Open this cover to replace the Maintenance Cartridge. i. Maintenance Cartridge Absorbs ink used for maintenance purposes such as head cleaning. (Replace the cartridge when it is full.) Printer Parts 13 Printer parts j. Cutter Unit A round-bladed cutter for automatic roll cutting. k. Cutter Rail The Cutter Unit passes over this rail to cut paper. l. Output Tray All printed documents are ejected from this slot. m.Ejection Guide Guides printed documents as they are ejected. n. Top Cover Open this cover to install the Printhead and remove any jammed paper from inside the printer, as needed. (→P.16) o. Width Guide When loading the sheets , move the guide to match the paper size. p. Stand A stand that holds the printer. Equipped with casters to facilitate moving it. (→P.19) 14 Printer Parts Printer parts Side a. Manual Pocket Store printer manuals in this pocket. b. Ethernet Port Connect an Ethernet cable to this port. The lamp is lit if the Ethernet cable is connected correctly and communication is possible between the computer and printer. c. USB Port Connect a USB cable to this port. The printer is compatible with Hi-Speed USB connections. d. Carrying Handles When carrying the printer, have three people hold it by these handles on the back at both ends. e. Power Supply Connector Connect the power cord to this connector. Printer Parts 15 Printer parts Top Cover (Inside) a. Carriage Moves the Printhead. The carriage serves a key role in printing. (→P.17) b. Carriage Shaft The Carriage slides along this shaft. c. Paper Retainer Important in supplying the paper. This retainer holds paper as it is fed. d. Platen The Printhead moves across the platen to print. Vacuum holes on the platen hold paper in place. e. Borderless Printing Ink Grooves For catching ink outside the edges of paper during borderless printing. f. Linear Scale The linear scale serves a key role in detecting the Carriage position. Be careful not to touch this part when cleaning inside the Top Cover or clearing paper jams. g. Cleaning Brush When cleaning inside the printer under the Top Cover, use this brush to sweep away paper dust on the Platen. 16 Printer Parts Printer parts Roll Cover (Inside) a. Roll Holder Load the roll on this holder. b. Holder Stopper Secure rolls on the Roll Holder with this part. c. Roll Loading Slots Slide the Roll Holder along these slots. d. Roll Holder Slot Load the Roll Holder into this holder slot. Carriage a. Angle Adjustment Lever Use this lever to ne-tune the printer to correct misalignment of printed lines. b. Printhead The printhead is equipped with ink nozzles. The carriage serves a key role in printing. c. Printhead Fixer Lever Locks the Printhead Fixer Cover. d. Printhead Fixer Cover Holds the Printhead in place. Printer Parts 17 Printer parts Ink Tank Cover (Inside) Left Side Right Side a. Ink Tank Lock Lever A lever that locks the Ink Tank in place and protects it. Lift and press down the lever when replacing an Ink Tank. b. Ink Set Label An Ink Tank that can be used in the printer is labeled with a white letter “J” in a black circle on the side. When purchasing an Ink Tank, make sure a “J” is printed on the label. (→P.622) c. Ink Color Label Load an Ink Tank that matches the color and name on this label. d. Ink Lamp (Red) Indicates the state of the Ink Tank as follows when the Ink Tank Cover is opened. • On The Ink Tank is installed correctly. • Off No Ink Tank is installed, or the ink level detection function has been released. • Flashing Slowly Not much ink is left. • Flashing Rapidly There is no ink left. e. Ink Tank Cartridges of ink in various colors. 18 Printer Parts Printer parts Stand a. Accessory Pocket Stores printer accessories. b. Output Stacker Printed documents are ejected into the output tray. c. Locking Caster Lock to immobilize the caster. Before moving the printer, always unlock all four casters. Moving the printer while casters are locked may scratch the casters or the oor. d. Adjustable Stopper Pull out when using the output stacker in the extended position. e. Paper Guide Guides printed documents into the output stacker. Printer Parts 19 Printer parts Control Panel a. Display Screen Shows printer menus, as well as the printer status and messages. b. Data Lamp (green) • Flashing During printing, the Data lamp ashes when the printer is receiving or processing print jobs. Otherwise, this lamp ashes when the print job is paused or the printer is updating the rmware. • Off There are no active print jobs when the Data lamp is off. c. Message Lamp (orange) • On A warning message is displayed. • Flashing An error message is displayed. • Off The printer is off or is operating normally. d. Power button (green) Turns the printer on and off. (→P.24) The Power button is lit when the printer is on or in Sleep mode. e. Stop button Cancels print jobs in progress and ends the ink drying period. f. Navigate button Enables you to check instructions for loading and removing paper or replacing ink tanks or printheads, as well as other operations. (→P.29) g. Arrow buttons • ◄ button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to move to another tab. In menu items requiring numerical input, press this button to move to another digit. • ▲ button Press this button when viewing menus to display the next menu item or setting value. • ► button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to move to another tab. In menu items requiring numerical input, press this button to move to another digit. • ▼ button Press this button when viewing menus to display the next menu item or setting value. 20 Printer Parts Printer parts h. OK button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to display the menu of the tab shown. Pressing this button in menu items of each tab for which is displayed at left will move to the lower level of the menu item, enabling you to execute menu commands or set menu values. Also press this button if the Display Screen indicates to press the OK button. i. Back button Displays the screen before the current screen. j. Menu button Displays the Tab Selection screen. (→P.49) k. Load button Press this button when loading or replacing paper. (→P.106) (→P.136) l. Feed button Pressing this button when rolls are loaded enables you to reposition the paper. (→P.125) m.Cut button Pressing this button when rolls are loaded cuts the paper, if you have specied Automatic or Eject in Cutting Mode in the Control Panel menu. (→P.129) n. Cut Sheet lamp (green) Lit when sheets are selected as the paper source. o. Roll Media lamp (green) Lit when rolls are selected as the paper source. Note • To recover from Sleep mode, any button can be pressed except the Power button. Printer Parts 21 Control Panel Control Panel Control Panel a. Display Screen Shows printer menus, as well as the printer status and messages. b. Data Lamp (green) • Flashing During printing, the Data lamp ashes when the printer is receiving or processing print jobs. Otherwise, this lamp ashes when the print job is paused or the printer is updating the rmware. • Off There are no active print jobs when the Data lamp is off. c. Message Lamp (orange) • On A warning message is displayed. • Flashing An error message is displayed. • Off The printer is off or is operating normally. d. Power button (green) Turns the printer on and off. (→P.24) The Power button is lit when the printer is on or in Sleep mode. e. Stop button Cancels print jobs in progress and ends the ink drying period. f. Navigate button Enables you to check instructions for loading and removing paper or replacing ink tanks or printheads, as well as other operations. (→P.29) 22 Printer Parts Control Panel g. Arrow buttons • ◄ button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to move to another tab. In menu items requiring numerical input, press this button to move to another digit. • ▲ button Press this button when viewing menus to display the next menu item or setting value. • ► button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to move to another tab. In menu items requiring numerical input, press this button to move to another digit. • ▼ button Press this button when viewing menus to display the next menu item or setting value. h. OK button Press this button on the Tab Selection screen to display the menu of the tab shown. Pressing this button in menu items of each tab for which is displayed at left will move to the lower level of the menu item, enabling you to execute menu commands or set menu values. Also press this button if the Display Screen indicates to press the OK button. i. Back button Displays the screen before the current screen. j. Menu button Displays the Tab Selection screen. (→P.49) k. Load button Press this button when loading or replacing paper. (→P.106) (→P.136) l. Feed button Pressing this button when rolls are loaded enables you to reposition the paper. (→P.125) m.Cut button Pressing this button when rolls are loaded cuts the paper, if you have specied Automatic or Eject in Cutting Mode in the Control Panel menu. (→P.129) n. Cut Sheet lamp (green) Lit when sheets are selected as the paper source. o. Roll Media lamp (green) Lit when rolls are selected as the paper source. Note • To recover from Sleep mode, any button can be pressed except the Power button. Printer Parts 23 Control Panel Turning the Printer On and Off Turning the printer on 1. Press the Power button to turn on the printer. The printer will now start up. After the Display Screen shows the Canon logo, Starting up... Please wait. is displayed. 2. The Power Lamp is lit when the printer nishes starting up, and the printer is now in Standby. The printer will not go into Standby in the following situations. Take the appropriate action. • The Top Cover is open Close the Top Cover. • The Ink Tank Cover is open Close the Ink Tank Cover. • The Printhead is not installed see “Replacing the Printhead”. (→P.633) • An Ink Tank is not installed see “Replacing Ink Tanks”. (→P.623) • If “ERROR” is shown on the Display Screen (See "Error messages.") • The Power Lamp and Message Lamp are not lit (even once), and nothing appears on the Display Screen Make sure the printer is plugged in correctly. Check the connection at the plug and electrical outlet. • No paper is loaded Load paper. (→P.78) (→P.81) Important • Starting the printer when it is connected via the USB cable to a Macintosh computer that is off may cause the computer to start up at the same time. To prevent this, disconnect the USB cable before starting the printer. Connecting the printer to the computer via a USB hub may solve this issue. 24 Printer Parts Control Panel Turning the printer off Important • Never disconnect the printer’s power supply or unplug it during a print job. This may damage the printer. 1. Make sure no print jobs are in progress. If the Message Lamp is ashing, check the message on the Display Screen and take action as necessary. (See "Error Messages.") If the Data Lamp is ashing, the printer is receiving a print job. Turn off the printer only after printing is nished. 2. Hold down the Power button for more than a second. After Shut Down.. Please Wait.. is shown on the Display Screen, the printer shuts off. Printer Parts 25 Control Panel Control Panel Display After the printer starts up, the Tab Selection screen is displayed. Each of the four tabs presents status, menus, and error information related to the particular tab. Types of tabs The Tab Selection screen presents four tabs. Each tab is represented by an icon in the top row. Press the ◄ or ► button to access other tabs. Paper tab A tab indicating status and showing menus related to paper. Pressing the OK button when this tab is highlighted will display the Paper Menu. • Top line displayed The paper icon is highlighted. • Middle line displayed Indicates the printer status and shows menu names. • Bottom line displayed The rst and second lines display the paper type and size. Ink tab A tab indicating status and showing menus related to ink. Pressing the OK button when this tab is highlighted will display the Ink Menu. • Top line displayed The ink icon is highlighted. • Middle line displayed Indicates the printer status and shows menu names. • Bottom line displayed Here, the remaining ink level is indicated. (→P.628) Job tab A tab indicating status and showing menus related to print jobs. Pressing the OK button when this tab is highlighted will display the Job Menu menu. • Top line displayed The job icon is highlighted. • Middle line displayed Indicates the printer status and shows menu names. Settings/Adj. tab A tab indicating status and showing menus related to settings and adjustment. Pressing the OK button when this tab is highlighted will display the Set./Adj. Menu. • Top line displayed The settings/adjustment icon is highlighted. • Middle line displayed Indicates the printer status and shows menu names. • Bottom line displayed Indicates the remaining maintenance cartridge capacity. 26 Printer Parts Control Panel Printer status and modes Printer status is classied according to the following ve modes. Standby The printer is ready to receive jobs sent from the computer. Jobs sent from the computer are printed immediately. Printing Paused Printing is paused on the printer. Any jobs sent from the computer are held without being printed. Printing Printing is in progress on the printer. Jobs sent from the computer are printed after the current job. The time left until printing is nished is indicated in the upper-right corner of the screen. (Values exceeding 10 hours are not shown.) Sleep The printer is in power-saving mode. The printer automatically enters Sleep mode to conserve power when idle for a specic period (by default, ve minutes), that is, if no print jobs are received or buttons are pressed while all covers are closed. You can specify the period before the printer enters Sleep mode in the Sleep Timer menu. (→P.49) After entering Sleep mode from Standby mode, the printer automatically recovers if print jobs are received, and the jobs are printed. Error The printer requires your attention. Any jobs sent from the computer cannot be processed. The tab related to the error is displayed. For information about the display in the case of multiple errors, see “Error message mode transition”. Printer Parts 27 Control Panel Mode transition • Mode display The printer mode is indicated as follows. *1: The printer automatically enters Sleep mode when idle for a specic period (by default, ve minutes), that is, if no print jobs are received or buttons are pressed while all covers are closed. However, it does not enter Sleep mode while error messages are displayed. *2: In Sleep mode, any button can be pressed except the Power button to recover from Sleep mode. Sleep mode is also terminated if a print job is received or a command is issued from RemoteUI. • Error display Mode transition during error display is as follows. If multiple errors occur, tabs related to errors other than the error currently shown ash. Press the ◄ or ► button to access other tabs and check those errors. If multiple errors occur that are related to the Job tab and Settings/Adj. tab, each error message is displayed for 4 seconds on each tab before another message is shown. 28 Printer Parts Control Panel How to View Instructions With Navigate You can refer to instructions for loading paper, replacing ink tanks, and performing other operations on the printer control panel. 1. 2. 3. Press the Navigate button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired navigation menu. Press ▲ or ▼ to select View Op. Guide, and then press the OK button. Instructions are now displayed. ■Example: Loading sheets Printer Parts 29 Control Panel Printer Menu Operations The printer menu is classied into menu items available when no print job is in progress and menu items only available during printing. • Menu operations when no print job is in progress (→P.30) • Menu operations during printing (→P.31) Menu operations when no print job is in progress To view available menus organized on tabs, select a tab on the Tab Selection screen and press the OK button. Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, pressing OK will not display menus. Menus can be selected after you resolve the problem. The following operations are available from the menu. • Paper Menu Paper menu settings • Ink Menu Ink menu operations • Job Menu Menu operations to manage print jobs • Set./Adj. Menu Menu operations for printer adjustment and maintenance Settings related to HP-GL2 jobs For a description of specic menu items available, see “Menu Settings”. (→P.49) For instructions on selecting menu items, see “Menu Operations”. (→P.32) Note • By default, menu settings apply to all print jobs. However, for settings that are also available in the printer driver, the values specied in the printer driver take priority. 30 Printer Parts Control Panel Menu operations during printing To display menus during printing, select a tab on the Tab Selection screen on the Control Panel, and then press the OK button. Other menus are available after printing is nished. Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, pressing OK will not display menus. Menus can be selected after you resolve the problem. The following operations are available from the menu during printing. • Ink Menu Ink menu operations • Job Menu Menu operations to manage print jobs • Set./Adj. Menu Fine-tuning paper feeding Display of printer-related information For a description of specic menu items available during printing, see “Menu Settings (During Printing)”. (→P.60) For instructions on selecting menu items during printing, see “Menu Operations”. (→P.32) Printer Parts 31 Control Panel Menu Operations To view available menus organized on tabs, select a tab on the Tab Selection screen and press the OK button. For details, see “Menu Settings”. (→P.49) • Menus (when the Ink tab is selected and the OK button is pressed) Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, pressing OK will not display menus. Menus can be selected after you resolve the problem. Simply press buttons on the Control Panel to access menus on various tabs from the Tab Selection screen and set or execute Menu items. The following section describes menu operations and how they are presented in this User Manual. • • • • Accessing menus (→P.33) Specifying menu items (→P.34) Specifying numerical values (→P.34) Executing menu commands (→P.34) 32 Printer Parts Control Panel Accessing menus Printer menus are grouped by function. Menus are displayed with the upper line selected. You can use the buttons on the Control Panel to access each menu. • Press Back to access a higher menu in the menu list, and press OK to access a lower one. If not all menu items are displayed, hold down ▲ or ▼ to scroll through higher and lower menu items. Items you select are highlighted. The scroll bar at right indicates the current position in the overall menu. • Lower menus are available if is displayed at right next to the second and subsequent rows. To access the lower menus, select the menu and press the OK button. Printer Parts 33 Control Panel Specifying menu items Menu items can be set as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired setting, and then press the OK button. After two seconds, the display reverts to the upper level menu. Note • If a conrmation message is displayed regarding the setting you entered, press the OK button. The setting is applied, and the printer is now in Standby. Specifying numerical values Follow these steps to enter numbers. In this example, network settings items are entered. 1. Press the ◄ or ► button to move to the next eld for input. 2. Press the ▲ or ▼ button to enter the value. Note • Hold down ▲ or ▼ to increase or decrease the value continuously. 3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 to complete the settings, and then press the OK button. Note • If a conrmation message is displayed regarding the setting you entered, press the OK button. The setting is applied, and the printer is now in Standby. Executing menu commands Menu commands can be executed as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the action to execute, and then press the OK button. The menu command is now executed. 34 Printer Parts Control Panel Menu Structure The menu structure is organized by tabs, as follows. Values at right indicated by an asterisk are the defaults. • • • • Paper Menu (→P.35) Ink Menu (→P.37) Job Menu (→P.38) Set./Adj. Menu (→P.39) For instructions on menu operations, see “Menu Operations”. (→P.32) For details on menu items, see “Menu Settings”. (→P.49) Paper Menu First Level Load Paper Second Level Third Level Roll Paper (The type of paper is displayed here.) (*1) Cut Sheet (The type of paper is displayed here.) (*1) Fourth Level Eject Paper Chg. Paper Type (*1) Roll Paper Cut Sheet Chg. Paper Size Sheet Size (The size of paper is displayed here.) (*2) Roll Length (*3) Roll Width (*4) ManageRemainRoll Off * On Paper Details (The type of paper is displayed here.) (*1) Head Height Automatic * Highest High Standard Low Lowest Super Low Skew Check Lv. High Accuracy Standard * Loose Off Cutting Mode Automatic Eject Manual Cut Speed Fast Printer Parts 35 Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Standard Slow Trim Edge First Automatic Off On CutDustReduct. Off On VacuumStrngth Automatic * Strongest Strong Standard Weak Weakest Scan Wait Time Off 1 sec. 3 sec. 5 sec. 7 sec. 9 sec. Roll DryingTime Off 30 sec. 1 min. 3 min. 5 min. 10 min. 30 min. 60 min. NearEnd RollMrgn 3mm 20mm NearEnd Sht Mrgn 3mm 20mm Bordless Margin Automatic Fixed Width Detection Off On * 36 Printer Parts Control Panel First Level Third Level Second Level Fourth Level Return Defaults Paper Details Keep Paper Type Off * On *1: For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Types of paper in the printer driver and related software (as well as on the Control Panel) are updated when you install the printer driver from the User Software CD-ROM or if you update paper information with the Media Conguration Tool. (See the Media Conguration Tool Guide (Windows) or Media Conguration Tool Guide (Macintosh).) *2: For information on the sizes of paper the printer supports, see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) *3: Available only if ManageRemainRoll is On. *4: Available only if Width Detection is Off. Ink Menu First Level Rep. Ink Tank Head Cleaning A Printer Parts 37 Control Panel Job Menu First Level Job Log Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level (Choose from Document Name information about the latest three print jobs.) User Name Page Count Job Status OK CANCELED Print Start Time yyyy/mm/dd hh:mm:ss Print End Time yyyy/mm/dd hh:mm:ss Print Time xxxsec. Print Size xxxxxxxxsq.mm Media Type Interface USB Network Ink Consumed Print Job Log Pause Print Off * On 38 Printer Parts (The ink color is displayed here.) xxx.xxx ml Control Panel Set./Adj. Menu First Level Test Print Second Level Nozzle Check Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level Status Print Interface Print GL2 Set Print Paper Details Print Job Log Menu Map Color Palette Adjust Printer Head Posi. Auto Adj. (Standard) Auto (Advanced) Manual (*1) Head Inc. Adj. Feed Priority Adj. Priority Automatic * Print Quality Print Length Adj. Auto Quality (*2) (Genuine Ppr) Auto (Other Paper) Manual Adjust Adjustment A:High Length (*3) Print B:Standard/ Draft Change Settings A:High Printer Parts 39 Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level B:Standard/ Draft Adj. Fine Feed (*2) Maintenance Head Cleaning Head Cleaning A Head Cleaning B Nozzle Check Replace P.head Repl. maint cart Head Info Product Name: s/n: Days elapsed: Count [Mdot]: GL2 Replot GL2 BufferClear GL2 Settings Quality Manager Color Mode Monochrome Color (CAD) 1 * Color (CAD) 2 Color (CAD) 3 Color (CAD) 4 Color (CAD) 5 Print Quality Fast Standard * High 40 Printer Parts Seventh Level Eighth Level Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Input Resolution Fourth Level 600dpi * Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level 300dpi Print Off * (Economy) On Paper Manager Paper Source Automatic * Roll Paper Cut Sheet Margin 3mm (Standard) * 5mm Conserve Paper Off * On Auto Rotate Off * On Line & Pen Enable Manager merge Off * On Pen Setup Select Palette Software * Palette A Palette B Factory Dene Palette Palette A (Select the pen number) Width (Indicates the value of Width) Color 0-255 Line Attributes No Setting Circle Setting Printer Parts 41 Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Reset Palette Fifth Level Sixth Level Palette B (Select the pen number) Factory (Select the pen number) All Palette Palette A Palette B Smoothing Software * Smooth Thicken FineLines Off * On Adjust FaintLines Off On * Processing Warning Option Off * On PageSize Process1 Off * On PageSize Process2 Off * On GL2 Set Print Interface Setup EOP Timer 10 sec. (*8) 30 sec. 1 min. 2 min. 5 min. 10 min. * 42 Printer Parts Seventh Level (Indicates Width, Color, and Line Attributes) (Indicates Width, Color, and Line Attributes) Eighth Level (Specify the values of Width, Color, and Line Attributes) Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level 30 min. 60 min. TCP/IP (*8) IPv4 IPv4 Mode Automatic Manual * Protocol (*4) DHCP On Off * BOOTP On Off * RARP On Off * IPv4 Settings (*9) IPv6 IPv6 Support IP Address xxx.xxx.xxx. xxx Subnet Mask xxx.xxx.xxx. xxx Default G/W xxx.xxx.xxx. xxx On Off * IPv6 Stless On * Addrs Off DHCPv6 On Off * NetWare (*8) NetWare On Off * Frame Type (*5) Auto Detect Ethernet 2 Ethernet 802.2 * Ethernet 802.3 Ethernet SNAP Printer Parts 43 Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Print Service (*5) Fourth Level Bindery PServer RPrinter NDS PServer * NPrinter AppleTalk (*8) On Off * Ethernet Driver (*8) Auto Detect On * Off Comm. Mode (*6) Half Duplex * Full Duplex Ethernet Type (*6) 10 Base-T * 100 Base-TX 1000 Base-T Spanning Tree Not Use * Use MAC Address Interface Print (*8) Return Defaults (*8) System Setup Sleep Timer 5 min. * 10 min. 15 min. 20 min. 30 min. 40 min. 50 min. 44 Printer Parts xxxxxxxxx xxx Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level 60 min. 240 min. Buzzer Off On * Contrast Adj. -4, -3, -2, -1, 0*, +1, +2, +3, +4 Date & Time (*8) Date yyyy/mm/ dd (*7) Time hh:mm Date yyyy/mm/ Format (*8) dd * dd/mm/ yyyy mm/dd/ yyyy Language * Time Zone (*8) 0:London (GMT) +1:Paris, Rome +2:Athens, Cairo +3:Moscow +4:Eerevan, Baku Printer Parts 45 Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level +5: Islamabad +6:Dacca +7:Bangkok +8:Hong Kong +9:Tokyo, Seoul +10: Canberra +11New Caledonia +12: Wellington -12: Eniwetok -11:Midway is. -10:Hawaii (AHST) -9:Alaska (AKST) -8:Oregon (PST) -7:Arizona (MST) -6:Texas (CST) -5:NewYork (EST) -4:Santiago -3:Buenos Aires -2: -1:Cape Verde Length Unit meter * feet/inch Detect Mismatch 46 Printer Parts Pause Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level Control Panel First Level Second Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Eighth Level Warning None * Paper Size Roll Basis Selection 1 ISO A3 (297mm) * 300mm Roll Roll Selection 2 10in. (254mm) * JIS B4 (257mm) Keep Off * Paper Size On TrimEdge Reload Automatic Off * On Rep.P.head Off Print On * Nozzle Check Frequency Standard * 1 page Warning Off * On Use RemoteUI (*8) On * Off Reset PaprSetngs (*8) Prep.Move Printer Admin. Menu (*8) Change Password (*9) Init.Admin. Pswd (*9) Printer Parts 47 Control Panel Second Level Printer Info Paper Info First Level Third Level Fourth Level Fifth Level Sixth Level Seventh Level Ink Info Head Info System Info Error Log Other Counter *1: *2: *3: *4: *5: *6: *7: *8: *9: Available after you have used Auto(Advanced) in Head Posi. Adj. once. Available if Adj. Priority is Automatic or Print Quality. Available if Adj. Priority is Automatic or Print Length. Not displayed if IPv4 Mode is Manual. Not displayed if NetWare is Off. Not displayed if Auto Detect is On. Follows the setting in Date Format. Viewing and conguration is possible for administrators, and only viewing for other users. Viewing and conguration is possible for administrators only. 48 Printer Parts Eighth Level Control Panel Menu Settings Menu items are as follows. For instructions on selecting menu items, see “Menu Operations”. (→P.32) For details on menu levels and values, see “Menu Structure”. (→P.35) Paper Menu Setting Item Description, Instructions Load Paper Select sheets or rolls and load the paper. Eject Paper Choose this item before removing loaded paper. Chg. Paper Type (*1) Change the type of paper loaded. (→P.110) Chg. Paper Size Change the size of paper loaded. (→P.112) (→P.100) ManageRemainRoll Choose On to print a barcode at the end of a roll before you remove it. The printed barcode can be used in managing the amount of roll paper left. Choose Off if you prefer not to print the barcode. (→P.126) Paper Details (The type of paper is displayed here.)(*1) Head Height Adjust the Printhead height. (→P.611) Skew Check Lv. If you print on Japanese paper (washi) or other handmade paper that has an irregular width, choose Loose for a higher skew detection threshold, or choose Off to disable skew detection. However, if paper is loaded askew when detection is Off, note that paper jams or Platen soiling may occur. Cutting Mode Specify whether or not to cut with the standard round-bladed cutter. Choose Automatic to have the roll cut automatically after printing. If you choose Manual, the paper will not be cut after printing. Instead, a line will be printed at the cut position. Choose Eject if you prefer not to have documents dropped immediately after printing, as when waiting for ink to dry. Cut Speed Choose the cutting speed. If you use adhesive paper, choosing Slow helps prevent adhesive from sticking to the cutter and keeps the cutter sharp. Trim Edge First If a roll is loaded, the end of the paper will be cut. CutDustReduct. If you choose On, a line will be printed at the cut position when paper cutting is selected. This option reduces the amount of debris given off after cutting. It also helps prevent adhesive from sticking to the cutter and keeps the cutter sharp if you use adhesive paper. (→P.134) Printer Parts 49 Control Panel Setting Item Paper Details (The type of paper is displayed here.)(*1) Description, Instructions VacuumStrngth Specify the level of suction that holds paper against the Platen. (→P.621) Scan Wait Time Specify the time to wait for the ink to dry between each scan in bidirectional printing, in consideration of how quickly the ink dries. Note that printing will take longer if you specify a wait time. Roll DryingTime Specify the time to wait for the ink to dry for each sheet. NearEnd RollMrgn Specify the minimum margin at the leading edge of roll paper to ensure better printing quality at the leading edge. Note that if you choose 3mm, it may lower the printing quality at the leading edge and affect feeding accuracy. The printed surface may be scratched, and ink may adhere to the leading edge. It may also cause the Platen to become soiled. NearEnd Sht Mrgn Specify a margin at the leading edge of sheets to ensure better printing quality at the leading edge. Note that if you choose 3mm, it may lower the printing quality at the leading edge and affect feeding accuracy. The printed surface may be scratched, and ink may adhere to the leading edge. Bordless Margin Adjust the margin during borderless printing. Choose Automatic to have the printer automatically detect the paper width and congure the margin settings for borderless printing. If margins are mistakenly created when Automatic is selected, choose Fixed. In this case, the paper width is not detected automatically, and the document is printed without borders, using the margin settings required by the printer. Width Detection Specify this option to print inside boundaries or in other cases when specifying a particular starting position for printing. (→P.113) Paper width and skew are not detected if you select Off. If paper is loaded askew, note that paper jams or Platen soiling may occur. Return Defaults Choose OK to restore Paper Details to the default values. Paper Details Print the paper settings as specied in Paper Details. Keep Paper Type Select On when printing on a particular type of paper regularly. (→P.110) *1: For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) The types of paper indicated in the printer driver and related software (as well as on the Control Panel) are updated when you install the printer driver from the User Software CD-ROM or if you update paper information by using the Media Conguration Tool. (See Media Conguration Tool Guide (Windows) or Media Conguration Tool Guide (Macintosh).) 50 Printer Parts Control Panel Ink Menu Setting Item Description, Instructions Rep. Ink Tank Replace the Ink Tank at this point. Follow the instructions displayed to complete the required procedure. (→P.623) Head Cleaning A Printhead cleaning options. (→P.632) Execute Head Cleaning A if printing is faint, oddly colored, or contains foreign substances. Job Menu Setting Item Job Log Description, Instructions (Choose from Document information Name about the last User Name three print jobs.) Page Count Job Status Indicates the document name in the last print job. Indicates the name of the user who sent the print job. Indicates the number of pages in the job. Indicates the printing results. Print Start Time Indicates when the print job was started. Print End Time Indicates when the print job was nished. Print Time Indicates the time required to print the job. Print Size Indicates the paper size in the print job. Media Type Indicates the type of paper in the print job. Interface Indicates the interface used for the print job. Ink Consumed Indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page.(*1) Print Job Log Print a record of print jobs, including the paper type and size, amount of ink consumed, and so on. Ink consumption indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page.(*1) Pause Print Choose On to stop printing. *1: Indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page. Actual ink consumption may be different. The average margin of error for estimates calculated according to Canon measurement conditions for ink costs is ±15%. Canon does not guarantee the accuracy of these estimates. Estimates may vary depending on conditions of use. Calculation of these estimates does not include ink consumed when cleaning printheads by forceful ejection of ink. Printer Parts 51 Control Panel Set./Adj. Menu Setting Item Test Print Adjust Printer Nozzle Check Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. Status Print Print information about the printer. Interface Print Print interface settings information. GL2 Set Print Print GL2 settings information. Paper Details Print the paper settings as specied in Paper Details. Print Job Log Print a record of print jobs, including the paper type and size, amount of ink consumed, and so on. Ink consumption indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page.(*1) Menu Map Print the menu structure. Color Palette Print the GL2 color palette. Head Posi. Adj. Auto(Standard) The printer prints and reads a test pattern for the automatic adjustment of Printhead alignment relative to the printing direction. (→P.604) Auto(Advanced) The printer prints and reads a test pattern for the automatic adjustment of Printhead alignment relative to the printing direction and spacing between nozzles and colors. (→P.604) Manual Print a test pattern for adjustment of Printhead alignment relative to the printing direction. Enter the adjustment value manually based on the resulting pattern. (→P.606) Head Inc. Adj. Feed Priority Adj. Priority Print a test pattern for adjustment of the Printhead orientation. (→P.608) Automatic Print Quality Print Length Adj. Quality 52 Printer Parts Description, Instructions Auto(GenuinePpr) Specify exact paper feeding, if desired. Normally, select Automatic. Choose Print Quality for attractive printing. Choosing Print Quality also makes banding less noticeable. Choose Print Length if you prefer to feed the paper an exact amount. However, note that slight banding may occur in the direction of carriage scanning when Print Length is selected. Specify this mode with paper identied in the Paper Reference Guide. The printer prints and reads a test pattern for automatic adjustment of the feed amount. (→P.614) Control Panel Setting Item Adjust Printer Feed Priority Adj. Quality Adjust Length Description, Instructions Auto(OtherPaper) Specify this mode with paper not in the Paper Reference Guide. The printer prints and reads a test pattern for automatic adjustment of the feed amount. Note that this function takes more time and consumes more ink than Auto(GenuinePpr). (→P.614) Manual Use this mode with highly transparent media or other paper for which Auto(GenuinePpr) or Auto(OtherPaper) cannot be used. Print a test pattern for adjustment of the feed amount based on the type of paper. (→P.616) Adjustment Print A:High Print a test pattern for particular types of paper to compensate for paper stretching or shrinkage, after B: which you enter the amount of adjustment. Standard/ (→P.619) Draft Change A:High Settings B: Standard/ Draft Maintenance Displayed when you have selected Feed Priority > Adj. Priority > Print Length. Adjustment relative to the amount of stretching or shrinkage of the current paper. Enter either the adjustment results from AdjustmentPrint or the discrepancy that you measured (as a percentage). For paper that tends to stretch, increase the feed amount by choosing a higher adjustment value. For paper that tends to shrink, decrease the feed amount by choosing a lower adjustment value. Adj. Fine Feed Displayed when you have selected Feed Priority > Adj. Priority > Automatic or Print Quality. Fine-tune the feed amount manually during printing. (→P.618) Head Cleaning Clean the Printhead. (→P.632) Choose Head Cleaning A if printing is faint, oddly colored, or contains foreign substances. Choose Head Cleaning B if no ink is printed at all, or if printing is not improved by Head Cleaning A. Nozzle Check Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. Replace P.head When replacing the Printhead, choose Yes and follow the instructions on the screen. (→P.633) Not displayed during a warning message that the remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity is low. Repl. maint cart When replacing the Maintenance Cartridge, choose Yes and follow the instructions on the screen. (→P.639) Head Info Indicates information about the printhead. GL2 Replot Print the previous GL2 print job again. Printer Parts 53 Control Panel Setting Item GL2 BufferClear Clear the print data in the replot buffer. GL2 Quality Color Settings Manager Mode Monochrome Print in monochrome. Color (CAD) 1 Print in standard colors. Color (CAD) 2 Print in brighter colors. Color (CAD) 3 Print emulating the following printers, in colors resembling colors produced by these printers: Canon iPF500, iPF600, iPF700, iPF510, iPF610, iPF710, iPF605, iPF720, iPF810, and iPF820.(*2) Color (CAD) 4 Print emulating the HP Designjet 500/800, in colors resembling colors produced by these printers.(*2) Color (CAD) 5 Print emulating the HP Designjet 1000, in colors resembling colors produced by this printer.(*2) Print Quality Choose the print quality. Input Resolution Choose the printer input resolution, 600dpi or 300dpi. Print (Economy) Although printing quality is diminished, less ink is consumed than in regular printing. Select On to conserve ink. Paper Paper Source Manager Margin Choose the source of paper for HP-GL/2 printing. Specify the margin around paper. The margin for the trailing edge of sheets is 23 mm (0.9 in). However, if you have specied the leading margin in Paper Details, the value in Paper Details has priority. Conserve Paper Conserves paper when printing. Auto Rotate If the long side of an original is shorter than the roll width, the original is automatically rotated 90 degrees to conserve paper. Similarly, if the long side of an original in landscape orientation is longer than the roll width and the short side is shorter than the roll width, the original is repositioned to t on the paper. HP RTL print jobs are not rotated. Because HP RTL images are not rotated even if the paper is rotated 90 degrees, images may be cut off or the blank paper may be ejected. In this case, set Auto Rotate to Off. Line Enable merge & Pen Manager Pen Setup 54 Printer Parts Description, Instructions Select Palette Specify whether to merge or print over colors where lines overlap. Choose Off to print the second line over the rst. Choose On to merge all overlapping colors. As pen values, choose Software, Palette A, Palette B, or Factory. Choose Software to print according to software settings. Choose Palette A or Palette B to print using the value specied in Dene Palette. Control Panel Setting Item GL2 Line Pen Settings & Pen Setup Manager Dene Palette Description, Instructions Specify the Width, Color, and Line Attributes in the palette Pen no.. Choose Factory to conrm the values when Factory is selected in Select Palette. In Line Attributes, choose No Setting or Circle Setting as the processing for the ends and junctions of lines. • If you choose No Setting • If you choose Circle Setting Reset Palette Smoothing Restore Dene Palette to the default palette settings. Choose whether to print arcs as smooth curved lines or as multiple connected line segments. • If you choose Software Operation is determined by the application. If nothing is specied by the application, the result is as shown in the gure. Note: By default, this is a 72-sided gure • If you choose Smooth ThickenFineLines Select On to print ne lines more distinctly. AdjustFaintLines If ne lines are printed in colors that do not match the colors of other shapes, selecting Off may help produce the expected results. However, lines in some colors may appear broken. Process- Warning ing Option PageSizeProcess1 Select On to have any GL2-related warnings displayed. Normally, the area available for printing excludes a margin required by the printer, and images are positioned accordingly. Selecting On in this setting eliminates any misalignment of the printing position if the image itself includes a border. Printer Parts 55 Control Panel Setting Item Description, Instructions GL2 Process- PageSizeProcess2 Settings ing Option Selecting On will determine the paper size based on the image rendering area. GL2 Set Print Print GL2 settings information. Interface EOP Timer Setup TCP/IP IPv4 Specify the timeout period before cancellation of print jobs that cannot be received by the printer. IPv4 Mode Choose whether the printer IP address is congured automatically or a static IP address is entered manually. Protocol DHCP Specify the protocol used to congure the IP address automatically. BOOTP RARP IPv4 IP Settings Address Subnet Mask Specify the printer network information when using a static IP address. Enter the IP address assigned to the printer, as well as the network subnet mask and default gateway. Default G/W IPv6 IPv6 Support Specify whether to connect via IPv6. IPv6 StlessAddrs Specify whether a IPv6 stateless address is used. DHCPv6 Specify whether DHCPv6 settings are used. NetWare NetWare 56 Printer Parts Specify the NetWare protocol. To apply your changes, choose Register Setting. Frame Type Specify the frame type to use. Print Service Choose the print service. AppleTalk Specify whether to use the AppleTalk protocol. To apply your changes, choose Register Setting. Ethernet Auto Detect Driver Specify the communication method. To apply your changes, choose Register Setting. Choose On for automatic conguration of the LAN communication protocol. Choose Off to use settings values of Comm.Mode and Ethernet Type. Comm.Mode Choose the LAN communication method. Ethernet Type Choose the LAN transfer rate. Spanning Tree Choose whether spanning-tree packets are supported over the LAN. MAC Address Indicates the MAC address. Interface Print Print interface settings information. Return Defaults Choose OK to restore Interface Setup settings to the default values. Control Panel Setting Item System Setup Description, Instructions Sleep Timer Specify the period before the printer enters sleep mode. Buzzer Choose On for the buzzer to sound in case of errors. Contrast Adj. Adjust the Display Screen contrast level. Date & Time Date Set the current date. Time Set the current time. Available only if the Date setting is specied. Date Format Specify the date format. Language Specify the language used on the Display Screen. Time Zone Specify the time zone. Time zone options indicate a main city in this time zone and the difference from Greenwich Mean Time. Length Unit Choose the unit of measurement when roll length is displayed. Change the unit displayed for the remaining amount of roll paper. Detect Mismatch Specify printing behavior if the type and size of paper specied in the printer menu does not match the type and size in the printer driver. Choose Pause to have printing paused under these circumstances. Choose Warning to continue printing after notication. Choose None to continue printing without notication. Paper Size Basis Roll Selection 1 If roll size detection is activated, choose whether ISO A3 (297mm) or 300mm Roll is applied when a roll of an intermediate width is detected. Roll Selection 2 If roll size detection is activated, choose whether 10in. (254mm) or JIS B4 (257mm) is applied when a roll of an intermediate width is detected. Keep Paper Size Choose On to use the paper size setting as the basis for printing instead of other settings. The margin setting of the printer menu will be used instead of the margin setting of the printer driver if the latter is smaller, which may prevent text or images in the margin from being printed. Printer Parts 57 Control Panel Setting Item System Setup Description, Instructions Keep Paper Size Choose Off to give priority to margin settings. The larger value is used if the margin specied in the printer driver does not match the margin in the printer menu TrimEdge Reload Specify whether to trim the leading edge of the currently retracted roll when the roll is advanced. Cut the edge if you are concerned about any marks left on the roll when the roll is left in the retracted position. Specify On to have rolls cut when printing begins after Sleep mode or when the power is restored. Selecting Automatic will trim the edge when the roll has been in the retracted position for two days or more. Rep.P.head Print Choose On to have the printer automatically execute the Advanced Adj. operations after you replace the Printhead. (→P.604) Nozzle Check In Frequency, specify the timing for automatic checks of nozzle clogging. Choose Standard to have the printer adjust the timing for checks based on the frequency of nozzle use. Choose 1 page to check once per page. Select Warning > On to display warnings if the nozzles clog during printing. Use RemoteUI Choosing Off prohibits access from RemoteUI. Settings can only be congured from the control panel. Reset PaprSetngs Restores settings that you have changed with Media Conguration Tool to the default values. Prep.MovePrinter Select this option when transferring the printer to another location. Follow the instructions displayed to complete the required procedure. (→P.651) Not displayed during a warning message that the remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity is low. Admin. Menu By setting a password, you can restrict menu display and conguration as follows. You can input between 0 and 9999999. • Viewing and conguration by administrators only IPv4 Settings Change Password Init.Admin.Pswd 58 Printer Parts Change Password Control Panel Setting Item Admin. Menu Printer Info Change Password Description, Instructions • Viewing and conguration by administrators, and only viewing by other users Interface Setup settings (except IPv4 Settings) Date & Time Date Format Time Zone Use RemoteUI Reset PaprSetngs Init.Admin.Pswd Choose OK to restore the Admin. Menu password to the default values. Paper Info Indicates the current paper size, type, and related printer settings. Ink Info Indicates ink levels and maintenance cartridge capacity. Head Info Indicates the model name, serial number, number of days used, and dot count of the current printhead. System Info Indicates the rmware version, serial number, and interface information. Error Log Indicates the most recent error messages (up to ve). Other Counter Indicates the total printing volume of the printer. *1: Indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page. Actual ink consumption may be different. The average margin of error for estimates calculated according to Canon measurement conditions for ink costs is ±15%. Canon does not guarantee the accuracy of these estimates. Estimates may vary depending on conditions of use. Calculation of these estimates does not include ink consumed when cleaning printheads by forceful ejection of ink. *2: It is not possible to match the colors and image quality produced by the specied printer exactly. Printer Parts 59 Control Panel Menu Settings (During Printing) Menu items are described in the following tables. For instructions on selecting menu items, see “Menu Operations”. (→P.32) For details on menu levels and values, see “Menu Structure”. (→P.35) Ink Menu Setting Item Description, Instructions Rep. Ink Tank Replace the Ink Tank at this point. Follow the instructions displayed to complete the required procedure. (→P.623) Head Cleaning A Clean the Printhead. (→P.632) Execute Head Cleaning A if printing is faint, oddly colored, or contains foreign substances. Job Menu Setting Item Job Log (Choose from information about the last three print jobs.) Description, Instructions Document Name Indicates the document name in the last print job. User Name Indicates the name of the user who sent the print job. Page Count Indicates the number of pages in the job. Job Status Indicates the printing results. Print Start Time Indicates when the print job was started. Print End Time Indicates when the print job was nished. Print Time Indicates the time required to print the job. Print Size Indicates the paper size in the print job. Media Type Indicates the type of paper in the print job. Interface Indicates the interface used for the print job. Ink Consumed Indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page.(*1) Print Job Log Print a record of print jobs, including the paper type and size, amount of ink consumed, and so on. Ink consumption indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page.(*1) Pause Print Choose On to stop printing. *1: Indicates a rough estimate of how much ink was consumed per page. Actual ink consumption may be different. The average margin of error for estimates calculated according to Canon measurement conditions for ink costs is ±15%. Canon does not guarantee the accuracy of these estimates. Estimates may vary depending on conditions of use. Calculation of these estimates does not include ink consumed when cleaning printheads by forceful ejection of ink. 60 Printer Parts Control Panel Set./Adj. Menu Setting Item Adj. Fine Feed Printer Info Description, Instructions Displayed when you have selected Feed Priority > Adj. Priority > Automatic or Print Quality. Fine-tune the feed amount manually. Paper Info Indicates the current paper size, type, and related printer settings. Ink Info Indicates ink levels and maintenance cartridge capacity. Head Info Indicates the model name, serial number, number of days used, and dot count of the current printhead. System Info Indicates the rmware version, serial number, and interface information. Error Log Indicates the most recent error messages (up to ve). Other Counter Indicates the total printing volume of the printer. Printer Parts 61 Control Panel Status Print You can print a Status Print report indicating the current status of the printer. With Status Print, information is printed regarding the printer rmware version, various settings, and the status of consumables. Printing Status Print reports 1. Load paper. If using sheets, load paper of A4/Letter size. You will need at least two sheets. 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Test Print, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Status Print, and then press the OK button. Checking the information in Status Print reports The following information is included in Status Print reports. Canon imagePROGRAF iPFxxxx Status Print Printer model Firm Firmware Version Boot Boot ROM Version MIT(DBF) MIT Database Format Version MIT(DB) MIT Database Version S/N Printer serial number Date Indicates when the status print report was printed. Paper Menu Information on the loaded paper. Roll Media Type Cut Sheet Type ManageRemainRoll Keep Paper Type 62 Printer Parts Control Panel Ink Menu Ink-related information. MC Maintenance Cartridge capacity (%) C, M, Y, MBK, MBK2, BK Ink levels. The remaining ink is displayed in a ve-level scale. Set./Adj. Menu System settings. System Setup Sleep Timer Printer system settings, as well as settings regarding warnings and errors. Buzzer Contrast Adj. Date Format Language Time Zone Length Unit Detect Mismatch Paper Size Basis Roll Selection 1 Roll Selection 2 Keep Paper Size Current paper-related settings. TrimEdge Reload Rep.P.head Print Nozzle Check Settings after a test pattern was printed following head replacement. Timing Warning Use RemoteUI Printer Info Error Log HEAD LOT NUMBER Nozzle-check settings. Settings used by RemoteUI. The past ve error codes. Printhead lot number. LOT PARTS STATUS COUNTER xx Utilization status of replacement parts that require servicing. Printer Parts 63 Control Panel COUNTER CUTTER MEDIA LIFE TTL LIFE ROLL LIFE CUTSHEET MEDIA 1-7,OTHER NAME TTL ROLL CUTSHEET AFTER INSTALLATION 64 Printer Parts Utilization status of the cutter, media, and other items (indicating how much they have been used). Control Panel Printing Interface Setting Reports You can print an Interface Print report indicating the current interface settings values of the printer. Interface Print reports indicate settings values for TCP/IP, NetWare, and other settings. Printing Interface Print reports 1. Load the paper. If using sheets, load paper A4/Letter-sized, you will need at least three sheets. 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Test Print, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Print, and then press the OK button. Conrming Interface Print information The following information is included in the Interface Print report. Canon imagePROGRAF iPFxxxx Interface Print Printer model Firm Firmware Version Boot Boot ROM Version MIT(DBF) MIT Database Format Version MIT(DB) MIT Database Version S/N Printer serial number Date The date when the interface setup print report was printed. Printer Parts 65 Control Panel EOP Timer TCP/IPv4 Sets the elapsed time between receiving last data and canceling printing. Frame Type Use DHCP Use BOOTP Use RARP Enable DNS Dynamic Update Use Zeroconf Function IP Address Subnet Mask Gateway Address LPD Printing IPP Printing IPP Printer URI RAW Printing Raw Mode Bi-direction FTP Printing Use Discovery Scope SMTP Server Address Primary DNS Server Address Secondary DNS Server Address DNS Host Name DNS Domain Name MulticastDNS ServiceName SNMPv1 SNMPv3 66 Printer Parts IPv4 settings values. Control Panel TCP/IPv6 Use IPv6 Use DHCPv6 IPv6 settings values. Stateful Address Prex Length Primary DNS Server Address Secondary DNS Server Address Use a stateless address Stateless Address 1 Prex Length 1 Stateless Address 2 Prex Length 2 Stateless Address 3 Prex Length 3 Stateless Address 4 Prex Length 4 Stateless Address 5 Prex Length 5 Stateless Address 6 Prex Length 6 Use a link-local Address Link-Local Address Prex Length Use a manual address IP Address Prex Length Default Router Address Prex Length Primary DNS Server Address Secondary DNS Server Address Use the same host name DNS Host Name and domain name as IPv4 DNS Domain Name Perform dynamic updating of stateful addresses Dynamically update the stateless address Dynamically update the manual address Printer Parts 67 Control Panel NetWare Frame Type NetWare settings values. IPX External Network Number Node Number Print Application Bindery Pserver(*1) File Server Name Print Server Name Print Server Password Polling Interval RPrinter(*1) Print Server Name Printer Number NDS Pserver(*1) Tree Name Context Name Print Server Name Print Server Password Polling Interval Nprinter(*1) Print Server Name Printer Number AppleTalk Phase Type Name AppleTalk settings values. Network Number Zone Network Interface Physical Interface Transmission Rate MAC Address Auto Detect Communication Ethernet Type Spanning Tree Use the Jumbo Frame Function *1: Only items congured in Print Application are printed. 68 Printer Parts Settings values regarding the communication path used for sending and receiving messages. Control Panel Checking Instructions During Printer Operations You can refer to instructions on the printer control panel when loading paper, replacing ink tanks, or performing other operations. How to view instructions Once you complete an action described in the instructions, the printer detects the action and switches to the next instruction screen. In the case of actions the printer cannot detect, instruction screens are switched every four seconds, and the sequence of operations is shown repeatedly. When all actions in the sequence are nished, the instruction screen for the next step is displayed. ■Example: Ink tank replacement Note • During a continuous display of instructions, you can press the ◄ button to pause the instructions on the current screen. Press the ◄ or ► button to display the previous or next screens. If you do not press the ◄ or ► button within 30 seconds, continuous display is resumed. Press the OK button to display the instruction screen for the next step. Printer Parts 69 Optional accessories Optional accessories Roll Holder Set Load a roll on the roll holder and then load the holder in the printer. The Roll Holder in the Roll Holder Set RH2-33 is for use with both 2-inch and 3-inch paper cores. Use the correct attachment for the particular paper core. (→P.103) • Roll Holder Set RH2-33 • Roll Holder (for 2- and 3-inch paper cores) • Attachments Using the 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment Using the 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment L R 70 Printer Parts Printer Specications Printer Specications Specications Important • This information is subject to change as the printer is updated. • The following values may vary depending on the operating environment. Printer Power supply Power consumption 100-120 V AC (50/60 Hz), 220-240 V AC (50/60 Hz) During operation 140 W max. Sleep mode 100-120 V: 5 W max. 220-240 V: 6 W max. Off 1 W max. (*1) During operation (sound pressure level/LWAd) Approx. 50 dB (A) (6.6 bels) Standby 35 dB (A) max. Temperature 15-30°C (59-86°F) Humidity 10-80%, non-condensing Dimensions (W × D × H) Printer and Stand (with Output Stacker open) 1,304×870×1,062 mm (51.3×34.3×41.8 in) Weight Printer and Stand (not including the Printhead and ink tanks) Approx. 62.9 kg (138.7 lb) Space for installation (W × D × H) Printer only 1,704×1,470×1,362 mm (67.1×57.9×53.6 in) Operating noise (*2) Operating environment Applicable standards International Energy Star Program, Law on Promoting Green Purchasing, Eco Mark, GPN, RoHS, Eco Declaration, WEEE, U.S. presidential directives *1: The printer uses a trace amount of power even when turned off. To stop all power consumption, turn off the printer and unplug the power cord. *2: Calculation based on ISO 7779. Operating conditions: On the Main sheet of the printer driver, Media Type > Plain Paper, Advanced Settings > Print Priority > Line Drawing/Text, and Print Quality > Standard. Printing performance Print method Bubblejet Maximum resolution 2400 dpi horizontally (*1) × 1200 dpi vertically Printhead PF-04 Number of nozzles MBK: 5,120; others: 2,560 per color *1: Prints with a minimum 1/2400 inch dot pitch between ink droplets. Printer Parts 71 Printer Specications Interface USB 2.0 (*1) Ethernet Format Internal port Mode Full-speed (12 Mbps), high-speed (480 Mbps), bulk transfer Connector Series B (4-pin) Format Internal port Specication IEEE 802.3 10Base-T, IEEE 802.3u 100Base-TX/Auto-Negotiation, IEEE 802.3ab1000Base-T/Auto-Negotiation, IEEE 802.3x Full Duplex Protocols IPX/SPX (Netware 4.2, 5.1, 6.0), SNMP, TCP/IP, AppleTalk, HTTP *1: Use in USB 2.0 High Speed mode requires the following environment: • Computer: USB 2.0 High-Speed-compatible • Operating system: Windows Vista/Windows Server 2008/Windows Server 2003/Windows XP/ Windows 2000 or Mac OS X ver. 10.3.9 or later • USB 2.0 driver: Microsoft USB 2.0 driver (available from Windows Update or the Service Pack.) • USB cable: Certied USB 2.0 cable Ink Ink Tank MBK Ink Tank (Matte Black Ink, or black ink for matte paper) Pigment ink PFI-102MBK BK Ink Tank (Black Ink) Dye ink PFI-102BK C Ink Tank (Cyan Ink) Dye ink PFI-102C M Ink Tank (Magenta Ink) Dye ink PFI-104M Y Ink Tank (Yellow Ink) Dye ink PFI-102Y Capacity *1: The provided Starter Ink Tanks contain 90 ml (3.0 oz) each. 72 Printer Parts 130 ml (4.4 oz) per color (*1) Printer Specications Paper (*1) Paper width Rolls 254.0-914.4 mm (10-36 in) Sheets 203.2-917.0 mm (8-36.1 in) Length of one page Rolls Thickness Paper Size Print area 203.2(*2)-18,000 mm (8-708.7 in) Sheets 279.4-1,600 mm (11-63 in) Rolls 0.07-0.8 mm (0.0028-0.031 in) Sheets 0.07-0.8 mm (0.0028-0.031 in) Roll width 36-in. Roll (914.4mm), ISO A0/A1 Roll (841.0mm), 30-in. Roll (762.0mm), JIS B1/B2 Roll (728.0mm), 24-in. Roll (609.6mm), ISO A1/A2 Roll (594.0mm), JIS B2/B3 Roll (515.0mm), 17-in. Roll (431.8mm), ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm), 16-in. Roll (406.4mm), 14-in. Roll (355.6mm), 300mm Roll (300.0mm), ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm), JIS B4 Roll (257.0mm), and 10-in. Roll (254.0mm) Sheets ISO A0, ISO A1, ISO A2+, ISO A2, ISO A3+, ISO A3, ISO A4, ISO B1, ISO B2, ISO B3, ISO B4, JIS B1, JIS B2, JIS B3, JIS B4, 34"x44" (ANSI E), 28"x40" (ANSI F), 22"x34"(ANSI D), 17"x22"(ANSI C), 13"x19" (Super B), 11"x17" (Ledger), Legal (8.5"x14"), Letter (8.5"x11"), 36"x48" (ARCH E), 30"x42" (ARCH E1), 26"x38" (ARCH E2), 27"x39" (ARCH E3), 24"x36" (ARCH D), 18"x24" (ARCH C), 12"x18" (ARCH B), 9"x12" (ARCH A), DIN C0, DIN C1, DIN C2, DIN C3, DIN C4, 20"x24", 18"x22", 14"x17", 12"x16", 10"x12", 10"x15", US Photo 16"x20", Poster 20"x30", Poster 30"x40", 13"x22", and Poster 300x900mm Normal size Printable area • Rolls 3 mm (0.12 in) from each side • Sheets 3 mm (0.12 in) from the top, 23 mm (0.91 in) from the bottom, and 3mm (0.12 in) from the left and right sides For information on the recommended print area, see “Print Area”. (→P.75) Borderless printing (*3) Printable area (rolls) 0 mm from the top, 0 from the bottom, and 0 mm from the left and right sides Supported width for borderless printing 36-in. Roll (914.4mm), ISO A0/A1 Roll (841.0mm), JIS B1/B2 Roll (728.0mm), 24-in. Roll (609.6mm), ISO A1/A2 Roll (594.0mm), JIS B2/B3 Roll (515.0mm), 17-in. Roll (431.8mm), ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm), 14-in. Roll (355.6mm), 300mm Roll (300.0mm), ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm), JIS B4 Roll (257.0mm), and 10-in. Roll (254.0mm) *1: For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide (→P.95) *2: When supplying paper, use a roll approximately 1,000 mm (1,093.6 yd) or longer. *3: Printing may not be possible in some cases, depending on the type and size of paper. Printer Parts 73 Printer Specications Output stacker capacity, in sheets Regular position 1 Extended position (*1) 20 *1: For information on types of paper you can use with the stacker in Extended position, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Options Roll Holder Set 74 Printer Parts RH2-33 Printer Specications Print Area A margin required by the printer is added with respect to the size of paper loaded in the printer. Except in borderless printing, the actual printing area corresponds to the paper size minus the space for this margin. Note • • • • Printable Area: The area that can be printed. There is no margin (that is, a margin of 0 mm) during borderless printing on rolls. Recommended Print Area: We recommend printing within this area. To print so that your original matches the print area exactly, use an oversized paper size that includes the required margin. (→P.219) Margins of Printable Area Top Edge Bottom Edge Sides Sheets Rolls 3 mm (0.12 in) 20 mm (0.79 in) 0/3 mm (0/0.12 0/3 mm (0/0.12 0/3 mm (0/0.12 in) in) in) 20 mm (0.79 in) 3 mm (0.12 in) 23 mm (0.91 in) Margins of Recommended Print Area Top Edge Bottom Edge Sides 23 mm (0.91 in) 5 mm (0.20 in) 5 mm (0.20 in) 5 mm (0.20 in) Sheets • Printable Area a margin of 3 mm (0.12 in) on top, 23 mm (0.91 in) on bottom, and 3 mm (0.12 in) on left and right sides is required. • Recommended Print Area A margin of 20 mm (0.79 in) on top, 23 mm (0.91 in) on bottom, and 5 mm (0.20 in) on left and right sides is required. Rolls • Printable Area A margin of 3 mm (0.12 in) on all sides is required. During borderless printing, the margin on all sides is 0 mm. For information on paper compatible with borderless printing, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Recommended Print Area A margin of 20 mm (0.79 in) on top, 5 mm (0.20 in) on bottom, and 5 mm (0.20 in) on left and right sides is required. Printer Parts 75 Printing procedure Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure Printing Options Using Rolls and Sheets The printer supports both rolls and sheets. This section introduces the main features of each, as well as the main printing methods available. Select rolls or sheets to suit your particular printing application. Note • For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • A variety of other ways to print are available besides those introduced here. Choose the printing method that suits your particular printing application, referring to "Working With Various Print Jobs" and "Enhanced Printing Options" from the table of contents. Roll printing Media in spooled rolls is generally called Roll Media. Rolls are loaded on the Roll Holder, which are in turn loaded in the printer. Rolls can be used to print large photos or create posters or banners that cannot be printed on regular sheets. • Large-format printing Easily print vertical or horizontal banners from familiar applications such as Microsoft Ofce applications. (→P.253) • Borderless printing Print without a margin (border) around posters or photos. (→P.232) (→P.239) (→P.225) • Banner printing You can print multiple pages as a single continuous image, without margins between pages. (→P.275) • 90-degree rotation before printing Originals in portrait orientation are rotated 90 degrees when possible to use paper more efciently. (→P.301) • Enlarged/reduced printing You can freely adjust the size of originals by enlarging or reducing originals before printing. (→P.201) (→P.207) (→P.213) • Free Layout function Print multiple documents from multiple applications (such as word-processing programs, spreadsheet programs, and so on) next to each other. (→P.269) 76 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure Sheet printing Sheets refer to individual sheets of paper. Insert the sheet between the Platen and the Paper Retainer. • Enlarged/reduced printing You can freely adjust the size of originals by enlarging or reducing originals before printing. (→P.201) (→P.213) • Free Layout function Print multiple documents from multiple applications (such as word-processing programs, spreadsheet programs, and so on) next to each other. (→P.269) Basic Printing Workow 77 Printing procedure Loading and Printing on Rolls These are the basic steps for loading and printing on rolls. Follow these steps to load and print on rolls. Note • For details on supported sizes and types of rolls, see “Paper Sizes” or the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.100) (→P.95) • If you prefer to wait for the ink to dry after printing and simply eject the document, you can deactivate automatic cutting and cut the paper manually. (→P.129) 1. Turn the printer on. (→P.24) 2. Load the roll on the Roll Holder. (→P.103) 78 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure 3. Load the roll in the printer. (→P.106) 4. Select the type of paper. (→P.110) Note • If no barcode has been printed on the roll and you have set ManageRemainRoll to On, specify the roll length after the type of paper. (→P.112) Basic Printing Workow 79 Printing procedure 5. Complete settings in the printer driver for the type of paper and other details. • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) (→P.86) • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) (→P.88) 6. Send the print job. • Printing in Windows (→P.83) • Printing in Mac OS X (→P.84) The printer now starts printing the print job. 80 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure Loading and Printing on Sheets These are the basic steps for loading sheets and then printing. Follow the steps below to load and print on sheets. Note • For details on supported types and sizes of paper, see “Paper Sizes” or the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.100) (→P.95) 1. Turn the printer on. (→P.24) 2. Complete settings in the printer driver for the type of paper and other details. • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) (→P.86) • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) (→P.88) 3. Send the print job. • Printing in Windows (→P.83) • Printing in Mac OS X (→P.84) Basic Printing Workow 81 Printing procedure 4. Load the sheet. (→P.136) The printer now starts printing the print job. 82 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure Printing in Windows Print from the application menu. Important • The Windows printer driver can be used in the following versions of Windows. • Windows 2000 (Professional or Server) • Windows XP (Home Edition or Professional) • Windows Server 2003 (Standard Edition) • Windows Vista • Windows Server 2008 • We recommend exiting unnecessary applications before printing. Running several applications while printing may interrupt the transfer of print data and affect printing quality. 1. In the source application, select Print from the File menu to display the dialog box for printing conditions. 2. After conrming that the printer is selected in the dialog box, click Print or OK to start printing. Note • The appearance of the dialog box varies depending on the software application. In most cases, the dialog box includes basic printing options and enables you to choose the printer, specify the range of pages, number of copies, and so on. Example: Print dialog box displayed by the application Note • If another printer is selected, select the printer you want to use under Select Printer or in the dialog box displayed after clicking Printer. Settings for many printing methods (including enlarged or reduced printing, borderless printing, and so on) are displayed in the printer driver dialog box. There are two ways to access the printer driver dialog box, as follows. • From the application (→P.346) • From the operating system menu (→P.348) Basic Printing Workow 83 Printing procedure Printing in Mac OS X Print from the application menu after registering the printer. Important • The Macintosh printer driver can be used in the following versions of Mac OS. • Mac OS X 10.3.9-10.5 • We recommend exiting unnecessary applications before printing. Running several applications while printing may interrupt the transfer of print data and affect printing quality. Registering the printer Before printing, you must register the printer in imagePROGRAF PrinterSetup.app. For instructions on registering the printer, see “Conguring the Printer Driver Destination (Macintosh)”. (→P.596) Important • During this setup process, the printer will not be listed among available printers if it is off or disconnected. • By default, the AppleTalk protocol is disabled on the printer. In Mac OS X 10.4 and earlier, you must enable AppleTalk protocol on the printer before using the printer in an AppleTalk network. For instructions on activating AppleTalk protocol, see “Conguring the Destination for AppleTalk Networks (Macintosh)”. (→P.598) Printing from the source application 1. In the source application, select Print from the File menu to display the dialog box for printing conditions. Note • This dialog box includes basic printing options and enables you to choose the printer, specify the range of pages, number of copies, and so on. 2. Select the printer in the Printer list. 84 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure 3. Click Print to start printing. As shown in the following illustration, you can switch to other panes in this dialog box to complete settings for various methods of printing, including enlarged and reduced printing, borderless printing, and so on. Basic Printing Workow 85 Printing procedure Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. Important • Always specify the same type and size of paper in the printer menu and printer driver. If the type and size do not match, an error message will be displayed and printing is not possible. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Note • Click the B Get Information button to display the Paper Information on Printer dialog box. On the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, you can obtain information on the paper in the printer and congure printer driver settings for the feed source and type of paper. 5. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 86 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure 6. 7. 8. In the A Page Size list, select the size of the original as specied in the application. In the L Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Roll Paper in L Paper Source, select the width of the loaded roll in M Roll Paper Width. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) Basic Printing Workow 87 Printing procedure Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the F Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. 88 Basic Printing Workow Printing procedure 7. Access the Page Setup pane. 8. 9. In the A Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Manual in A Paper Source, make sure the size as selected in Page Setup is displayed in C Page Size. If you have selected Roll Paper in A Paper Source, make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width. Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) Basic Printing Workow 89 Canceling print jobs Canceling print jobs Canceling Print Jobs from the Control Panel To cancel printing or reception of print jobs, press the Stop button on the Control Panel. When you press the Stop button during printing, printer operation varies depending on the current status. • If you press the Stop button before printing starts Pressing the Stop button before printing starts will display a conrmation message. To cancel the print job, select Yes. • If you press the Stop button during printing Pressing the Stop button during printing will display a conrmation message. To cancel the print job immediately, select Yes. 90 Basic Printing Workow Canceling print jobs Canceling Print Jobs from Windows In the printer window, you can cancel jobs that are being sent to the printer. Using imagePROGRAF Status Monitor, you can cancel print jobs that have already been received by the printer or that are currently being printed. 1. Click the printer icon in the taskbar to display the printer window. Note • You can also display this window by double-clicking the printer icon in the Printers and Faxes (or Printers) folder, accessible through the Windows start menu. 2. Right-click the job to cancel and select Cancel. 3. If the job to cancel is not shown in the printer window (that is, if the print data has already been received by the printer), double-click the taskbar icon to display imagePROGRAF Status Monitor. 4. On the Printer Status sheet, click Cancel Job. Basic Printing Workow 91 Canceling print jobs Canceling Print Jobs from Mac OS X In the printer window, you can cancel jobs that are being sent to the printer. Otherwise, you can cancel jobs from imagePROGRAF Printmonitor if they have been received by the printer or are currently being printed. Note • Print jobs are shown in the printer window while they are being sent from the computer. After transmission, jobs are not displayed even during printing. • Print jobs are displayed in the imagePROGRAF Printmonitor window from the moment the printer starts receiving the print data until the moment printing is nished. They are not displayed before print data is sent to the printer, even if the computer has started preparing the print data. 1. 2. Click the printer icon in the Dock to display the printer window. 3. If there are no jobs in the printer window that can be canceled, (that is, if the print data has Click Stop Jobs to stop printing. already been sent to the printer), click Utility to display imagePROGRAF Printmonitor. 92 Basic Printing Workow Canceling print jobs 4. Select the print job to cancel and click to delete the print job. The job sent to the printer is canceled. 5. Exit imagePROGRAF Printmonitor. In the printer window, click Start Jobs. Important • Always follow these steps if you cancel print jobs from imagePROGRAF Printmonitor. If you do not restart job processing, the next job cannot be printed. Basic Printing Workow 93 Pausing Printing Pausing Printing Pausing Printing During printing, if you set Pause Print in the Control Panel menu to On, printing is stopped at that point and the printer enters a state in which printing is paused. (→P.26) Printing from the job queue is not possible in this state. To restore normal operation after this state, set Pause Print to Off. Note • In the following cases, the status is cleared even if you do not set Pause Print to Off, and printing from the job queue resumes. • When paper is advanced • When you execute Chg. Paper Type in the Paper Menu 1. During printing, on the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Job tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Job Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Pause Print, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On or Off, and then press the OK button. 94 Basic Printing Workow Paper Handling Paper Paper Types of Paper For information on the types of paper the printer supports (such as plain paper, coated paper, glossy photo paper, proong paper, and CAD paper), refer to the Paper Reference Guide. The Paper Reference Guide identies types of paper and gives specications, printer driver settings, and tips on handling paper. (See Paper Reference Guide.) By downloading the latest version of the Media Conguration Tool from the imagePROGRAF website, you can make sure the paper information indicated in the Paper Reference Guide, on the printer Control Panel, and in the printer driver is up to date. Accessing the Paper Reference Guide from imagePROGRAF Support Information The Paper Reference Guide can also be accessed from imagePROGRAF Support Information. Follow these instructions, as appropriate for your operating system. • Windows 1. Double-click the iPFxxxx Support desktop icon. (iPFxxxx indicates the printer model.) The imagePROGRAF Support Information window is displayed. 2. Click the Paper Reference Guide button. Handling Paper 95 Paper The Paper Reference Guide is displayed. • Mac OS X 1. Click the iPF Support icon in the Dock. The imagePROGRAF Support Information window is displayed. 2. Click the Paper Reference Guide button. 96 Handling Paper Paper The Paper Reference Guide is displayed. Handling Paper 97 Paper Updating paper information To update the paper information in the Paper Reference Guide and on the printer, download the latest version of the Media Conguration Tool from the imagePROGRAF website. For information about the Media Conguration Tool, see Media Conguration Tool (Windows) or Media Conguration Tool (Macintosh). The imagePROGRAF website is accessible from imagePROGRAF Support Information. Important • When you use the Media Conguration Tool to update information about paper, the types of paper on the printer Control Panel, in the printer driver, and in related software are updated. • Windows 1. Double-click the iPFxxxx Support desktop icon. (iPFxxxx indicates the printer model.) The imagePROGRAF Support Information window is displayed. 2. Click Visit the imagePROGRAF webpage. The default browser on your computer is started and the imagePROGRAF webpage is displayed. 98 Handling Paper Paper • Mac OS X 1. Click the iPF Support icon in the Dock. The imagePROGRAF Support Information window is displayed. 2. Click Visit the imagePROGRAF webpage. The default browser on your computer is started and the imagePROGRAF webpage is displayed. Handling Paper 99 Paper Paper Sizes Rolls Rolls that meet the following conditions are supported. • Outer diameter: Up to 150 mm (6 in) • Inner diameter of paper core: 2 or 3 inches • Printing side out 914.4 mm (36.00 in) Roll Paper Width Setting in Printer Driver 36-in. Roll (914.4mm) Yes 841.0 mm (33.11 in) ISO A0/A1 Roll (841.0mm) Yes 762.0 mm (30.00 in) 30-in. Roll (762.0mm) No 728.0 mm (28.66 in) JIS B1/B2 Roll (728.0mm) Yes 609.6 mm (24.00 in) 24-in. Roll (609.6mm) Yes 594.0 mm (23.39 in) ISO A1/A2 Roll (594.0mm) Yes 515.0 mm (20.28 in) JIS B2/B3 Roll (515.0mm) Yes 431.8 mm (17.00 in) 17-in. Roll (431.8mm) Yes 420.0 mm (16.54 in) ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm) Yes 406.4 mm (16.00 in) 16-in. Roll (406.4mm) No 355.6 mm (14.00 in) 14-in. Roll (355.6mm) Yes 300.0 mm (11.81 in) 300mm Roll (300.0mm) Yes 297.0 mm (11.69 in) ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm) Yes 257.0 mm (10.12 in) JIS B4 Roll (257.0mm) Yes 254.0 mm (10.00 in) 10-in. Roll (254.0mm) Yes Roll Width Borderless Printing (*1) *1: For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) 100 Handling Paper Paper Sheets Sheets of the following sizes are supported. Paper Sizes Dimensions ISO A0 841.0 × 1189.0 mm (33.11 × 46.81 in) ISO A1 594.0 × 841.0 mm (23.39 × 33.11 in) ISO A2+ 431.8 × 609.6 mm (17.00 × 24.00 in) ISO A2 420.0 × 594.0 mm (16.54 × 23.39 in) ISO A3+ 329.0 × 483.0 mm (12.95 × 19.02 in) ISO A3 297.0 × 420.0 mm (11.69 × 16.54 in) ISO A4 210.0 × 297.0 mm (8.27 × 11.69 in) ISO B1 707.0 × 1000.0 mm (27.83 × 39.37 in) ISO B2 500.0 × 707.0 mm (19.69 × 27.83 in) ISO B3 353.0 × 500.0 mm (13.90 × 19.69 in) ISO B4 250.0 × 353.0 mm (9.84 × 13.90 in) JIS B1 728.0 × 1030.0 mm (28.66 × 40.55 in) JIS B2 515.0 × 728.0 mm (20.28 × 28.66 in) JIS B3 364.0 × 515.0 mm (14.33 × 20.28 in) JIS B4 257.0 × 364.0 mm (10.12 × 14.33 in) 34"x44"(ANSI E) 863.6 × 1117.6 mm (34.00 × 44.00 in) 28"x40"(ANSI F) 711.2 × 1016.0 mm (28.00 × 40.00 in) 22"x34"(ANSI D) 558.8 × 863.6 mm (22.00 × 34.00 in) 17"x22"(ANSI C) 431.8 × 558.8 mm (17.00 × 22.00 in) 11"x17"(Ledger) 279.4 × 431.8 mm (11.00 × 17.00 in) 13"x19"(Super B) 330.2 × 482.6 mm (13.00 × 19.00 in) Letter(8.5"x11") 215.9 × 279.4 mm (8.50 × 11.00 in) Legal(8.5"x14") 215.9 × 355.6 mm (8.50 × 14.00 in) 36"x48"(ARCH E) 914.4 × 1219.2 mm (36.00 × 48.00 in) 30"x42"(ARCH E1) 762.0 × 1066.8 mm (30.00 × 42.00 in) 26"x38"(ARCH E2) 660.4 × 965.2 mm (26.00 × 38.00 in) 27"x39"(ARCH E3) 685.8 × 990.6 mm (27.00 × 39.00 in) 24"x36"(ARCH D) 609.6 × 914.4 mm (24.00 × 36.00 in) 18"x24"(ARCH C) 457.2 × 609.6 mm (18.00 × 24.00 in) 12"x18"(ARCH B) 304.8 × 457.2 mm (12.00 × 18.00 in) 9"x12"(ARCH A) 228.6 × 304.8 mm (9.00 × 12.00 in) DIN C0 917.0 × 1296.0 mm (36.10 × 51.02 in) DIN C1 648.0 × 917.0 mm (25.51 × 36.10 in) DIN C2 458.0 × 648.0 mm (18.03 × 25.51 in) Handling Paper 101 Paper Paper Sizes Dimensions DIN C3 324.0 × 458.0 mm (12.76 × 18.03 in) DIN C4 229.0 × 324.0 mm (9.02 × 12.76 in) 20"x24" 508.0 × 609.6 mm (20.00 × 24.00 in) 18"x22" 457.2 × 558.8 mm (18.00 × 22.00 in) 14"x17" 355.6 × 431.8 mm (14.00 × 17.00 in) 12"x16" 304.8 × 406.4 mm (12.00 × 16.00 in) 10"x12" 254.0 × 304.8 mm (10.00 × 12.00 in) 10"x15" 254.0 × 381.0 mm (10.00 × 15.00 in) US Photo 16"x20" 406.4 × 508.0 mm (16.00 × 20.00 in) Poster 20"x30" 508.0 × 762.0 mm (20.00 × 30.00 in) Poster 30"x40" 762.0 × 1016.0 mm (30.00 × 40.00 in) 13"x22" 329.0 × 558.0 mm (12.95 × 21.97 in) Poster 300x900mm 300.0 × 900.0 mm (11.81 × 35.43 in) Custom Paper Size 203.2 x 203.2 mm (8.00 x 8.00 in) to 917.0 x 1600.0 mm (36.10 x 62.99 in) Note • For details on non-standard paper sizes, see “Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes”. (→P.261) • Borderless printing is not supported on sheets. 102 Handling Paper Handling rolls Handling rolls Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls When printing on rolls, attach the Roll Holder to the roll. Rolls have a two- or three-inch paper core. Use the correct attachment for the paper core. The printer comes equipped with the 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment installed. Using Rolls with a 2-Inch Paper Core Using Rolls with a 3-Inch Paper Core Holder Stopper (Left Side) Roll Holder (Right Side) Holder Stopper (Left Side) Roll Holder (Right Side) 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment L No Attachment Needed 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment R Caution • Set the roll on a table or other at surface so that it does not roll or fall. Rolls are heavy, and dropping a roll may cause injury. Important • When handling the roll, be careful not to soil the printing surface. This may affect the printing quality. We recommend wearing clean cloth gloves when handling rolls to protect the printing surface. • Use scissors or a cutting tool to cut the edge of the roll paper if it is uneven, dirty, or has tape residue. Otherwise, it may cause feeding problems and affect the printing quality. Be careful not to cut through any barcodes printed on the roll. • Align the edges of the paper on both ends of the roll. Misalignment may cause feeding problems. Note • For details on supported sizes and types of rolls, see “Paper Sizes” or the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.100) (→P.95) • To view instructions as you attach the Roll Holder, press the Navigate button. (→P.29) Handling Paper 103 Handling rolls 1. Lift the Holder Stopper lever (a) from the shaft side to unlock it. Holding the Holder Stopper at the position indicated (b), remove it from the Roll Holder. 2. Insert the respective attachments for the roll paper core on the Roll Holder and Holder Stopper. • Using rolls with a 2-inch paper core Holder Stopper (Left Side) Align the tips (a) of the 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment with the holes (b) of the Holder Stopper and insert it rmly. Roll Holder (Right Side) No attachment is needed. • Using rolls with a 3-inch paper core Holder Stopper (Left Side) Align the tips (a) of the 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment L with the holes (b) of the Holder Stopper and insert it rmly. 104 Handling Paper Roll Holder (Right Side) Align the tips (a) of 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment R with the holes (b) of the Roll Holder and insert it rmly. Handling rolls 3. With the edge of the roll paper facing forward as shown, insert the Roll Holder from the right of the roll. Insert it rmly until the roll touches the ange (a) of the Roll Holder, leaving no gap. 4. Insert the Holder Stopper from the left in the Roll Holder as shown. Holding it at the position shown (b), push it rmly in until the ange (a) of the Holder Stopper touches the roll. Lock the Holder Stopper lever (c) by pushing it down toward the shaft side. Handling Paper 105 Handling rolls Loading Rolls in the Printer Follow these steps to load rolls in the printer. Note • Before loading rolls, make sure the printer is clean inside the Top Cover and around the Ejection Guide. If these areas are dirty, we recommend cleaning them in advance. (→P.647) 1. Press the Load button. 2. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Load Roll Paper, and then press the OK button. Note • If any paper has been advanced that will not be used, a message is shown requesting you to remove it. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. Remove the paper and go to the next step. 3. Positioning your hands as shown, open the Roll Cover. 106 Handling Paper Handling rolls 4. Holding the Roll Holder ange (a), rest the Roll Holder shaft on the Roll Ledge (b). At this time, position the holder so that the “R” label (c) on the Roll Holder ange is aligned with the “R” label (d) on the printer . 5. Holding the Roll Holder ange (a), guide the holder along the Roll Loading Slots (b) on both ends, keeping the holder level as you load it in the Roll Holder Slot. Caution • Do not force the Roll Holder into the printer with the right and left ends reversed. This may damage the printer and Roll Holder. • Do not release the anges until the holder is loaded in the Roll Holder Slot. • Be careful not to pinch your ngers between the Roll Loading Slots (b) and the Roll Holder shaft (c) when loading rolls. Handling Paper 107 Handling rolls 6. Advance the roll to insert the leading edge in the Paper Feed Slot (a) until you hear a tone. Important • Be careful not to soil the printing surface of roll paper as you insert it in the slot. This may affect the printing quality. We recommend wearing clean cloth gloves when handling rolls to protect the printing surface. • If the paper is wrinkled or warped, straighten it out before loading it. • Load paper straight so it is not fed askew. 7. Once paper feeding starts, you will need to do the following, based on the ManageRemainRoll setting and the barcode printed on rolls. (→P.126) ManageRemainRoll Off Barcodes Printed Not printed On Printer Operation After the Paper is Fed A menu for selection of the type of paper is automatically shown on the Display Screen. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Printed The type and amount of paper left is automatically detected based on the barcode printed on the roll. There is no need to specify the type and length of the paper. Not printed A menu for selection of the paper type and length is automatically shown on the Display Screen. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type and length of paper loaded, and then press the OK button. Note • For details on types of paper to select, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) 108 Handling Paper Handling rolls 8. Holding it at the positions indicated, close the Roll Cover. Note • Cut the edge of the roll after the paper is advanced if it is soiled or if there are cuts from scissors or the blade after removing creased edges. (→P.129) Handling Paper 109 Handling rolls Changing the Type of Paper Follow these steps to change the type of paper specied on the printer after you have loaded paper. If you will continue using this type of paper later, selecting Keep Paper Type > On will save the time and effort of conguring the media type setting when you load the paper again. The current media type settings before you select On will be automatically selected at that time. (→P.111) Important • For best printing results, the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper. Be sure to select the type of paper to use correctly before printing. • Because the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper, the margins and the size of printed images may vary depending on the type of paper used. If margins and the size of images are not as you expected, adjust the paper feed amount. (→P.612) Changing the Type of Paper Note • After you load a roll, the printer automatically shows a menu for selection of the type of paper on the Display Screen. Select the type of paper and press the OK button. If no barcode has been printed on the roll and you have set ManageRemainRoll to On, specify the roll length after the type of paper. (→P.112) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Chg. Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded (Roll Paper or Cut Sheet), and then press the OK button. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded in the printer, and then press the OK button. Note • For details on types of paper, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) By default, Plain Paper is selected. • If you move the Release Lever, the setting automatically reverts to the previously selected paper. • Be sure to select the correct paper type. If this setting does not match the loaded paper, it may cause feed errors and affect printing quality. 110 Handling Paper ). Handling rolls Using the Same Type of Paper Regularly Congure this setting so that current media type settings will be automatically selected when you load the same type of paper later. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Keep Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. Note • The specied media type setting is updated in the following situations. • When using sheets, if you send a print job before loading a sheet, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the print job. • When you have selected ManageRemainRoll > On on the Control Panel and a barcode is printed on the roll, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the barcode. • To change the media type setting, see “Changing the Type of Paper”. (→P.110) Handling Paper 111 Handling rolls Specifying the Paper Length When changing the length of paper after the paper has been advanced, specify the length as follows. Note • Specify the paper length when you have set ManageRemainRoll to On. (→P.126) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Chg. Paper Size, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Roll Length, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the length of paper loaded in the printer, and then press the OK button. Specify the roll length as follows. 1. Press the ◄ or ► button to move to the next eld for input. 2. Press the ▲ or ▼ button to enter the value. 3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 to nish entering the value, and then press the OK button. 112 Handling Paper ). Handling rolls Printing From a Desired Starting Point When printing inside boundaries or in other situations when you want to specify a particular position to start printing from, set Width Detection to Off in the printer menu for the type of paper used. Set Width Detection to Off 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Width Detection, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Off, and then press the OK button. Load paper in the desired position to start printing from Follow these instructions to load paper at the desired starting position for printing when Width Detection is Off. 1. If you did not send a print job in advance, a menu for selection of the type of paper is displayed. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Note • If a print job was received before paper was advanced, the media type and size specied by the job are shown on the Display Screen. Thus, this screen is not displayed. Go to step 2. 2. Width Detection OFF. OK to continue? is now shown on the Display Screen. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Leave OFF, and then press the OK button. 3. After a menu for selection of the paper size is displayed, press ▲ or ▼ to select the paper size, and then press the OK button. Handling Paper 113 Handling rolls 4. Open the Top Cover and check the position where paper is loaded. To start printing from the current position, close the Top Cover. To reposition the paper, push the Release Lever back. 5. Keeping the right edge of the paper aligned with the extended line of the Paper Alignment Line (a) to the right of the ejection guide and the leading edge aligned with the groove (b) at the far end of the Platen, load the paper at the position from which to start printing. 114 Handling Paper Handling rolls 6. Pull the Release Lever forward and close the Top Cover. Handling Paper 115 Handling rolls Removing the Roll from the Printer Remove rolls from the printer as follows. Note • If you need to cut the roll, see “Specifying the Cutting Method for Rolls”. (→P.129) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Eject Paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. The roll is now rewound and ejected. Caution • If you have selected ManageRemainRoll > On in the Control Panel menu, a barcode is printed on the leading edge of the roll. Do not remove the roll before the barcode is printed. You will be unable to keep track of the amount of roll paper left. (→P.126) 5. Positioning your hands as shown, open the Roll Cover. 116 Handling Paper Handling rolls 6. Using both hands, rotate the Roll Holder toward the back to rewind the roll. 7. Holding the Roll Holder ange (a), remove the holder from the Roll Holder Slot. Note • For instructions on removing the Roll Holder from rolls, see “Removing the Roll Holder from Rolls”. (→P.118) 8. Holding it at the positions indicated, close the Roll Cover. Note • To load new paper in the printer at this point, see “Loading Rolls in the Printer”. (→P.106) Handling Paper 117 Handling rolls Removing the Roll Holder from Rolls 1. Lift the Holder Stopper lever (a) from the shaft side to unlock it. Holding the Holder Stopper at the position indicated (b), remove it from the Roll Holder. 2. Remove the Roll Holder from the roll. 3. When removing attachments, push the tips (a) in as you remove the attachment. • 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment R (Roll Holder side) • 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment L (Holder Stopper side) 118 Handling Paper Handling rolls • 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment Important • Store the roll in the original bag or box, away from high temperature, humidity, and direct sunlight. If paper is not stored properly, the printing surface may become scratched, which may affect the printing quality when you use it again. Handling Paper 119 Handling rolls Clearing Jammed Roll Paper If paper from a roll becomes jammed, Paper jam. is shown on the Display Screen of the Control Panel. Remove the jammed paper as follows. 1. Open the Roll Cover. Use a commercially available cutter or the like to cut the paper of the loaded roll. Caution • When cutting paper, be careful to avoid injury or damage to the printer. 2. Push the Release Lever back. 3. Remove the jammed paper. • If paper is jammed inside the Top Cover 1. Open the Top Cover and move the Carriage to the left or right side manually, away from the jam. 2. Clear any jammed paper from inside the Top Cover. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 120 Handling Paper Handling rolls 3. Close the Top Cover. Important • Do not move the Carriage over jammed paper. This may damage the Printhead. • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). This may stain your hands and damage the printer. • If paper from a roll is jammed by the Paper Feed Slot 1. Open the Roll Cover. 2. Remove the jammed paper from the Paper Feed Slot. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. Handling Paper 121 Handling rolls • If the paper is jammed by the Ejection Guide Remove the jammed paper from the Output Tray. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 4. Pull the Release Lever forward. 122 Handling Paper Handling rolls Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot) Follow these steps to remove any scraps left in the Paper Feed Slot after you clear jammed sheets or roll paper. 1. 2. Turn the printer off. (→P.24) 3. Positioning your hands as shown, open the Roll Cover. 4. Fold an A4 sheet lengthwise four times and insert it through the gap of the Paper Feed Slot. Push the Release Lever back. Push the scrap out toward the Platen. 5. 6. Remove the scrap when it is pushed out onto the Platen. If any scraps remain inside the paper feed slot, repeat steps 4 and 5. Handling Paper 123 Handling rolls 7. Holding it at the positions indicated, close the Roll Cover. 8. Pull the Release Lever forward. 124 Handling Paper Handling rolls Feeding Roll Paper Manually After a roll has been advanced, you can press the Feed button to feed or retract the roll with the ▲ and ▼ buttons. 1. 2. Press the Feed button. Press the ▲ or ▼ button to advance or retract the roll. Press ▲ to retract the roll manually. Press ▼ to advance the roll manually. Note • If you hold down ▲ or ▼ for less than a second, the roll will move about 1 mm (0.04 in). If you hold down ▲ or ▼ for more than a second, the roll will move until you release the button. Release the button when the Display Screen indicates End of paper feed. Cannot feed paper more.. Handling Paper 125 Handling rolls Keeping Track of the Amount of Roll Paper Left Setting ManageRemainRoll to On in the Paper Menu of the Control Panel will print a barcode with text on the roll when the roll is removed that identies the type of paper and amount left. When ManageRemainRoll is On and you load rolls with printed barcodes, the type of paper and amount left are automatically detected after rolls are loaded. The barcode will be cut off after it has been read. Important • Because the ManageRemainRoll function is not compatible with clear lm, an error message may be displayed (The roll is empty.) after you load clear lm. For this reason, set ManageRemainRoll to Off before loading clear lm. • If the barcode on the roll is not detected, enter the type and length of paper on the Control Panel. Follow these steps to set ManageRemainRoll to On as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select ManageRemainRoll, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. 126 Handling Paper ). Handling rolls Specifying the Ink Drying Time for Rolls When you are using paper that takes longer for ink to adhere, if the Cutter touches printed surfaces that are still wet, it may damage the paper or cause rough cut edges. Also, ink may be transferred onto the paper surface during ejection, soiling it. You can prevent problems by adjusting the drying time after printing before the paper is cut. Windows 1. Display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.348) 2. Select the Main sheet and click C Advanced Settings in A Media Type. 3. In the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box displayed next, select the desired settings values in B Between Pages and C Between Scans in A Drying Time, and then click OK. (→P.354) Handling Paper 127 Handling rolls Mac OS X 1. 2. Choose Print in the application menu. 3. In the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box displayed next, select the desired settings values in Select the Main pane and click C Settings in A Media Type. C Between Pages and D Between Scans in B Drying Time, and then click OK. (→P.465) Note • By factory default, Drying Time is deactivated (Off) for all paper types. • To have the printer wait for ink to dry immediately after printing without releasing paper, set Cutting Mode to Eject in the printer menu. (→P.129) 128 Handling Paper Handling rolls Specifying the Cutting Method for Rolls How rolls are cut after ejection varies depending on printer settings. Cutting Method Automatic Eject (→P.130) Manual (→P.131) Paper Cutting (→P.132) The roll is automatically cut by the Cutter Unit following printer driver settings. Printer Setting Media Menu > Paper Choose this setting if you prefer not to Details > have documents dropped immediately after (Various printing, as when waiting for ink to dry. Types of To cut the roll with the Cutter Unit, press the Paper) > Cut button. Cutting Choose this setting when using media that Mode cannot be cut using the Cutter Unit. Cut each page from the roll using scissors. For continuous printing (if you will cut each page later), select Auto Cut > Yes or select Print Cut Guideline. (→P.331) Driver Setting Automatic Auto Cut Yes Eject Yes Manual NoYesPrint Cut Guideline Choose this option if you want to cut pages Cut button Yes by pressing Cutter Unit buttons for manual pressed cutting after printing when Auto Cut > No is selected or Print Cut Guideline is selected in the printer driver. Otherwise choose this option if you want to cut the roll edge after loading a roll. NoPrint Cut Guideline Note • Automatic and Eject are valid only when you have selected Auto Cut > Yes in the printer driver. • With Eject, printing does not resume after a series of jobs have been printed continuously until the roll is cut. • Eject is the preset selection in Cutting Mode for some types of paper. For this paper, we recommend keeping the preset cutting mode. Cut rolls manually in the following cases: Handling Paper 129 Handling rolls Eject (waiting for ink to dry after printing) Important • When cutting wide printed documents after ejection, have two people support the documents. If the paper drops, printed documents may be damaged. • Do not lift the paper when holding printed documents before cutting. If the paper rises, it may affect the printing quality or cause rough cut edges. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Cutting Mode, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Eject, and then press the OK button. Starts printing. When printing is nished, the printer will stop without cutting. 8. Holding the printed document to prevent it from dropping, press the Cut button to cut the roll. 130 Handling Paper ). Handling rolls Manual (when using media that cannot be cut with the Cutter Unit) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Cutting Mode, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Manual, and then press the OK button. Starts printing. The printer stops advancing the paper after printing. 8. Press the Feed button. Roll paper is fed to the specied cut position and then automatically stopped. 9. Cut the roll paper manually with scissors or the like. Handling Paper 131 Handling rolls 10. Press the OK button. After the roll is rewound, it stops automatically. Paper cutting (to have the roll cut at your specied position) 1. 2. Press the Feed button. 3. Press the Cut button. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. Press the ▼ button to advance the roll to the position for cutting. After the roll paper is cut, it is rewound automatically. Caution • If paper would be short when cut at a particular position, the roll may automatically be advanced in some cases before cutting. 132 Handling Paper Handling rolls Cutting the Leading Edge of Roll Paper Automatically If the leading edge of a roll is crooked or warped, it may cause an error message or printing problems. In this case, set Trim Edge First to Automatic or On in the Paper Menu on the Control Panel to have the printer cut the leading edge to make the edge straight after you load a roll. Trim Edge First offers the following options. • Automatic If the left and right side of the leading edge of the roll ((a) and (b)) are uneven by 3 mm (0.12 in) or more when you load the roll, the edge is cut an amount relative to the slant to ensure a straight edge, and scraps are removed. The edge is not cut if the unevenness is less than 3 mm. However, paper may sometimes be cut, depending on the state of the leading edge. • Off The edge is not cut and scraps are not removed. This setting is Off for most types of paper, by default. For more information, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • On The leading edge is cut off when you load a roll, and scraps are removed. The amount of paper cut from the leading edge varies depending on the type of paper. For more information, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Follow these steps to change the Trim Edge First setting. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Trim Edge First, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired setting option, and then press the OK button. This setting takes effect the next time you load a roll. Handling Paper 133 Handling rolls Reducing Dust from Cutting Rolls For media such as Backlit Film that are more likely to generate debris when cut, select CutDustReduct. > On in the Paper Menu of the Control Panel. This option reduces debris from cutting by printing black lines at the leading and trailing edges of documents. It may help prevent Printhead damage. You can specify for CutDustReduct. to be activated for particular types of paper. Important • Do not set CutDustReduct. to On for paper that wrinkles easily, such as Plain Paper or lightweight paper. This may impair cutting and cause paper jams. • Borderless printing is not available when CutDustReduct. is set to On. To use borderless printing, select CutDustReduct. > Off. Set CutDustReduct. to On as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded in the printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select CutDustReduct., and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. 134 Handling Paper ). Handling rolls Roll Holder Set Load a roll on the roll holder and then load the holder in the printer. The Roll Holder in the Roll Holder Set RH2-33 is for use with both 2-inch and 3-inch paper cores. Use the correct attachment for the particular paper core. (→P.103) • Roll Holder Set RH2-33 • Roll Holder (for 2- and 3-inch paper cores) • Attachments Using the 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment Using the 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment 2-Inch Paper Core Attachment 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment 3-Inch Paper Core Attachment L R Handling Paper 135 Handling sheets Handling sheets Loading Sheets in the Printer Follow these steps to load sheets in the printer. Important • One sheet of paper can be loaded in the Paper Feed Slot at a time. Do not load more than one sheet at a time. This may cause paper jams. • Before feeding paper or printing, make sure the sheet is at against the Roll Cover. The sheet may jam if it curls before feeding or printing and the trailing edge drops toward the front. Note • Store unused paper in the original package, away from high temperature, humidity, and direct sunlight. • Paper that is wrinkled or warped may jam. If necessary, straighten the paper and reload it. • Load the paper straight. Loading paper askew will cause an error. 1. Select sheets as the paper source. • If a print job was received Sheets are automatically selected, and the media type and size specied by the print job are shown on the Display Screen. Go to the next step. • If no print job was received 1. Press the Load button. 2. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Load Cut Sheet, and then press the OK button. Note • If any paper has been advanced that will not be used, a message is shown requesting you to remove it. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. Remove the paper and go to the next step. 136 Handling Paper Handling sheets 2. Slide the Width Guide (a) to align it with the mark for the size of paper you will load. 3. Load a single sheet printing-side up in the Paper Feed Slot, with the right edge aligned with the Paper Alignment Guide (a) to the right of the Roll Cover. Insert the paper until the leading edge makes contact and you hear a tone. Handling Paper 137 Handling sheets 4. Move the Width Guide (a) carefully to match the size of paper loaded. Set the Width Guide against the edge of the paper to prevent the paper from becoming crooked or wrinkled. 5. Press the OK button. • If a print job was received The printer now starts printing the print job. • If no print job was received A menu for selection of the type of paper is automatically shown on the Display Screen. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. The printer now starts feeding the paper. Note • For details on types of paper to select, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) 138 Handling Paper Handling sheets Changing the Type of Paper Follow these steps to change the type of paper specied on the printer after you have loaded paper. If you will continue using this type of paper later, selecting Keep Paper Type > On will save the time and effort of conguring the media type setting when you load the paper again. The current media type settings before you select On will be automatically selected at that time. (→P.111) Important • For best printing results, the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper. Be sure to select the type of paper to use correctly before printing. • Because the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper, the margins and the size of printed images may vary depending on the type of paper used. If margins and the size of images are not as you expected, adjust the paper feed amount. (→P.612) Changing the Type of Paper Note • After you load a roll, the printer automatically shows a menu for selection of the type of paper on the Display Screen. Select the type of paper and press the OK button. If no barcode has been printed on the roll and you have set ManageRemainRoll to On, specify the roll length after the type of paper. (→P.112) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Chg. Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded (Roll Paper or Cut Sheet), and then press the OK button. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded in the printer, and then press the OK button. Note • For details on types of paper, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) By default, Plain Paper is selected. • If you move the Release Lever, the setting automatically reverts to the previously selected paper. • Be sure to select the correct paper type. If this setting does not match the loaded paper, it may cause feed errors and affect printing quality. Handling Paper 139 Handling sheets Using the Same Type of Paper Regularly Congure this setting so that current media type settings will be automatically selected when you load the same type of paper later. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Keep Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. Note • The specied media type setting is updated in the following situations. • When using sheets, if you send a print job before loading a sheet, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the print job. • When you have selected ManageRemainRoll > On on the Control Panel and a barcode is printed on the roll, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the barcode. • To change the media type setting, see “Changing the Type of Paper”. (→P.139) 140 Handling Paper Handling sheets Printing From a Desired Starting Point When printing inside boundaries or in other situations when you want to specify a particular position to start printing from, set Width Detection to Off in the printer menu for the type of paper used. Set Width Detection to Off 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Width Detection, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Off, and then press the OK button. Handling Paper 141 Handling sheets Load paper in the desired position to start printing from Follow these instructions to load paper at the desired starting position for printing when Width Detection is Off. 1. If you did not send a print job in advance, a menu for selection of the type of paper is displayed. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Note • If a print job was received before paper was advanced, the media type and size specied by the job are shown on the Display Screen. Thus, this screen is not displayed. Go to step 2. 2. Width Detection OFF. OK to continue? is now shown on the Display Screen. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Leave OFF, and then press the OK button. 3. After a menu for selection of the paper size is displayed, press ▲ or ▼ to select the paper size, and then press the OK button. 4. Open the Top Cover and check the position where paper is loaded. To start printing from the current position, close the Top Cover. To reposition the paper, push the Release Lever back. 142 Handling Paper Handling sheets 5. Keeping the right edge of the paper aligned with the extended line of the Paper Alignment Line (a) to the right of the ejection guide and the leading edge aligned with the groove (b) at the far end of the Platen, load the paper at the position from which to start printing. 6. Pull the Release Lever forward and close the Top Cover. Handling Paper 143 Handling sheets Removing Sheets Remove sheets from the printer as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Eject Paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. The paper is ejected from the front of the printer. 5. Holding the paper, push the Release Lever back and remove the sheet. 6. Pull the Release Lever forward. 144 Handling Paper ). Handling sheets Clearing a Jammed Sheet If a sheet becomes jammed, Paper jam. is shown on the Display Screen of the Control Panel. Remove the jammed paper as follows. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Remove the jammed paper. • If paper is jammed inside the Top Cover 1. Open the Top Cover and move the Carriage to the left or right side manually, away from the jam. 2. Clear any jammed paper from inside the Top Cover. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 3. Close the Top Cover. Handling Paper 145 Handling sheets Important • Do not move the Carriage over jammed paper. This may damage the Printhead. • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). This may stain your hands and damage the printer. • If the paper is jammed by the Paper Feed Slot Remove the jammed paper from the Paper Feed Slot. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. • If the paper is jammed by the Ejection Guide Remove the jammed paper from the Output Tray. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 146 Handling Paper Handling sheets 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. Handling Paper 147 Handling sheets Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot) Follow these steps to remove any scraps left in the Paper Feed Slot after you clear jammed sheets or roll paper. 1. 2. Turn the printer off. (→P.24) 3. Positioning your hands as shown, open the Roll Cover. 4. Fold an A4 sheet lengthwise four times and insert it through the gap of the Paper Feed Slot. Push the Release Lever back. Push the scrap out toward the Platen. 5. 6. Remove the scrap when it is pushed out onto the Platen. If any scraps remain inside the paper feed slot, repeat steps 4 and 5. 148 Handling Paper Handling sheets 7. Holding it at the positions indicated, close the Roll Cover. 8. Pull the Release Lever forward. Handling Paper 149 Output Stacker Output Stacker Using the Output Stacker The Output Stacker can be held at two positions, as shown. • When storing printed documents on the Output Stacker Use position (1). • When the Output Stacker is not used, or when moving the printer Use position (2). When moving the printer, lift the Support Rod to the Extended position. (→P.151) Important • When storing printed documents on the Output Stacker, always use it in position (1). If you do not, printed documents may not be dropped into the Output Stacker, and the printed surface may become soiled. • When moving the printer, always lift the Support Rod to the Extended position before use in position (2). If the stacker is not used in position (2), the Basket Cloth may touch the oor and be soiled or damaged. • The Output Stacker can hold one sheet. When printing multiple pages, remove each sheet after it is printed. 150 Handling Paper Output Stacker Note regarding the Extended position The Output Stacker can be used in the regular position and an Extended position for easy removal of printed documents. For information on types of paper you can use with the stacker in Extended position, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Regular position Extended position Switch the stacker to Extended position as follows. 1. Lift the Support Rod to the position shown (a) and switch the stacker to Extended position. 2. When using rolls larger than A1 or 24 inches wide, pull out the Adjustable Stopper. Handling Paper 151 Printing Photos and Images Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Photos and Images Printing Photos and Images Printing is easy when you simply choose the print target. Easy Settings Simply choose the printing application in the list for optimal printing results. Print Target Choose presets that match the type of document to be printed. Print targets for photos and images Print Target Description Poster The best setting for posters. Prints using vivid and high impact colors. Photo (Color) Suitable for printing photographic images captured with a digital camera. Faithful Color Reproduction Prints by minimizing color differences. Suitable for when the printing results are too vivid or when printing scanned images. Caution • Depending on the Media Type setting, some Print Target options may not be available. Note • You can check the settings values for each print target by clicking View Settings. • You can also ne-tune these values as needed. (Advanced Settings) For details on Advanced Settings, see “Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing”. (→P.187) 152 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Photos and Images Print Quality Choose the print quality. The printing mode is determined by a combination of the print quality and resolution. Print Quality Description Highest A setting for printing at the highest resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in other modes, but this mode offers superior printing quality. High Choose this setting to print at high resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in “Standard” or “Draft” modes, but this mode offers exceptional printing quality. Standard Choose this setting to print at standard resolution when quality and speed are both important. Printing takes less time than in “Highest” or “High” mode. Draft Choose this setting to print faster. Printing in draft mode can help you work more efciently when checking layouts. For instructions on printing photos and images, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Photos and Images (Windows) (→P.154) • Printing Photos and Images (Mac OS X) (→P.156) Working With Various Print Jobs 153 Printing Photos and Images Printing Photos and Images (Windows) This topic describes how to print photos based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Photo image from a digital camera Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll Paper type: Premium Glossy Paper 200 Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Premium Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Glossy Paper 200. In the A Media Type, choose the type of paper used for printing, such as Glossy Paper, Coated Paper, and so on. Make sure the paper you select is loaded in the printer. Note • The paper type setting in the printer driver and related software (as well as on the Control Panel) is updated when you install the Media Conguration Tool from the User Software CD-ROM or if you change paper information by using the Media Conguration Tool. For details, see Media Conguration Tool. 5. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click Photo (Color) in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View Settings. 154 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Photos and Images 6. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 7. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click 10"x12". 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list. In this case, click 10-in. Roll (254.0mm), and then click OK. 10. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions,see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) 11. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For instructions on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Working With Various Print Jobs 155 Printing Photos and Images Printing Photos and Images (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print photos based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Photo image from a digital camera Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Premium Glossy Paper 200 Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click 10"x12". If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 156 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Photos and Images 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Premium Glossy Paper 200. Make sure the paper you select is loaded in the printer. Note • The types of paper indicated in the printer driver and related software (as well as on the Control Panel) are updated when you install the Media Conguration Tool from the User Software CD-ROM or if you change paper information by using the Media Conguration Tool. For details, see Media Conguration Tool. 7. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click Photo (Color) in the E Print Target list. Note • For information on settings optimized for printing photos and images, see “Printing Photos and Images”. (→P.152) • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View set.. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Working With Various Print Jobs 157 Printing Photos and Images 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 10 in. (254.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure C Page Size on the Page Setup pane shows the original size as specied in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, 10"x12". 13. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) 14. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 158 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings Printing CAD Drawings Printing CAD Drawings Using this printer, you can print ne lines and text clearly and sharply. It’s easy to produce highly precise drawings from CAD applications. Note • In Windows, you can print highly precise drawings using the provided imagePROGRAF HDI Driver for AutoCAD/AutoCAD LT. For details on the HDI driver, see the HDI Driver Guide. For instructions on CAD printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Line Drawings and Text (Windows) (→P.162) • Printing Line Drawings and Text (Mac OS X) (→P.164) Working With Various Print Jobs 159 Printing CAD Drawings Printing Line Drawings and Text Printing is easy when you simply choose the type of original to print. Easy Settings Simply choose the printing application in the list for optimal printing results. Print Target Choose presets that match the type of document to be printed. Print targets for line drawings and text Print Target Description CAD (Color Line Drawing) Settings optimized to print intricate lines in CAD drawings clearly. CAD (B/W Line Drawing) Settings optimized to print black lines in CAD drawings clearly. Perspective, GIS Settings optimized for printing 3D CAD drawings, perspective drawings, and maps, including GIS maps. Note • You can check the settings values for each print target by clicking View Settings. • You can also ne-tune these values as needed. (Advanced Settings) For details on Advanced Settings, see “Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing”. (→P.187) 160 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings Print Quality Choose the print quality. The printing mode is determined by a combination of the print quality and resolution. Print Quality Description Highest A setting for printing at the highest resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in other modes, but this mode offers superior printing quality. High Choose this setting to print at high resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in “Standard” or “Draft” modes, but this mode offers exceptional printing quality. Standard Choose this setting to print at standard resolution when quality and speed are both important. Printing takes less time than in “Highest” or “High” mode. Draft Choose this setting to print faster. Printing in draft mode can help you work more efciently when checking layouts. For instructions on printing line drawings and text, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Line Drawings and Text (Windows) (→P.162) • Printing Line Drawings and Text (Mac OS X) (→P.164) Working With Various Print Jobs 161 Printing CAD Drawings Printing Line Drawings and Text (Windows) This topic describes how to print line drawings based on the following example. • • • • • Document: CAD drawing Page size: A3 (297.0 × 420.0 mm [11.7 × 16.5 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click CAD (Color Line Drawing) or CAD (Monochrome Line Drawing) in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View Settings. 6. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 162 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings 7. In A Page Size, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A3. 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 10. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) 11. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Working With Various Print Jobs 163 Printing CAD Drawings Printing Line Drawings and Text (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print line drawings based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: CAD drawing Page size: A3 (297.0 × 420.0 mm [11.7 × 16.5 in]) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A3. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 164 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click CAD (Color Line Drawing) or CAD (Monochrome Line Drawing) in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View set.. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Working With Various Print Jobs 165 Printing CAD Drawings 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure C Page Size on the Page Setup pane shows the original size as specied in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A3. 13. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) 14. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 166 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings You can complete color settings when Color (CAD) is selected in Color Mode. Colors can be adjusted before printing as follows when Color Compatibility is selected. Note • Color (CAD) is displayed when you select Advanced Settings on the Main sheet and set Print Priority to Line Drawing/Text. Color Compatibility Color Setting Item Color Setting Description Color (CAD) 1 Print in standard colors. Color (CAD) 2 Print in brighter colors. Color (CAD) 3 Print with approximate colors emulating Canon iPF500, iPF600, iPF700, iPF510, iPF610, iPF710, iPF605, iPF720, iPF810, iPF820. Color (CAD) 4 Print emulating the HP Designjet 500/800, in colors resembling colors produced by these printers. Color (CAD) 5 Print emulating the HP Designjet 1000, in colors resembling colors produced by this printer. Important • If you have selected Color (CAD) 3, Color (CAD) 4, or Color (CAD) 5, it is not possible to match the colors and image quality produced by the specied printer exactly. For instructions on conguring Color Compatibility, refer to the following topics. • Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings (Windows) (→P.168) Working With Various Print Jobs 167 Printing CAD Drawings Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings (Windows) You can complete color settings when Color (CAD) is selected in Color Mode. Note • Color (CAD) is displayed when you select Advanced Settings on the Main sheet and set Print Priority to Line Drawing/Text. 1. 2. Click start > Printers and Faxes (or Printers). 3. Click the Device Settings tab to display the Device Settings sheet. 4. Click A Color Compatibility to display the Color Compatibility dialog box. Select the printer, and then display the printer properties dialog box. 168 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing CAD Drawings 5. Select the desired color settings in the A Color Compatibility list. Note • For details on color settings,see “Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings”. (→P.167) For printing instructions, refer to the following topic. • Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Windows) (→P.190) Working With Various Print Jobs 169 Printing CAD Drawings HP-GL/2 Printing This printer supports the original Canon GARO printer control language as well as HP-GL/2 and HP RTL(*1) emulation.(*2) When printing from applications that support HP-GL/2 output, specify HP-GL/2 in the application’s plotter output settings. Note • For instructions on conguring these settings, refer to the software documentation. The printer automatically switches to the corresponding processing depending on whether a GARO, HP-GL/2, or HP RTL job is received. Congure the optional settings for HP-GL/2 emulation on the printer control panel. (→P.49) This printer can emulate the following printers using HP-GL/2 emulation. Emulated Printers Canon iPF500, iPF600, iPF700, iPF510, iPF610, iPF710, iPF605, iPF720, iPF810 and iPF820 Hewlett-Packard Designjet 500, Designjet 800 and Designjet 1000 *1: HP-GL/2: Hewlett-Packard Graphics Language 2; HP RTL: Hewlett-Packard Raster Transfer Language *2: It may not be possible to print jobs with excessively large amounts of data correctly. 170 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Ofce Documents Printing Ofce Documents Printing Ofce Documents Printing is easy when you simply choose the type of original to print. Easy Settings Simply choose the printing application in the list for optimal printing results. Print Target Choose presets that match the type of document to be printed. Print targets for ofce documents Print Target Ofce Document Description Settings optimized for clear printing of ofce documents such as handouts. Note • You can check the settings values for each print target by clicking View Settings. • You can also ne-tune these values as needed. (Advanced Settings) For details on Advanced Settings, see “Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing”. (→P.187) Print Quality Choose the print quality. The printing mode is determined by a combination of the print quality and resolution. Print Quality Description Highest A setting for printing at the highest resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in other modes, but this mode offers superior printing quality. High Choose this setting to print at high resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in “Standard” or “Draft” modes, but this mode offers exceptional printing quality. Standard Choose this setting to print at standard resolution when quality and speed are both important. Printing takes less time than in “Highest” or “High” mode. Draft Choose this setting to print faster. Printing in draft mode can help you work more efciently when checking layouts. For instructions on printing ofce documents, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Ofce Documents (Windows) (→P.172) • Printing Ofce Documents (Mac OS X) (→P.174) Working With Various Print Jobs 171 Printing Ofce Documents Printing Ofce Documents (Windows) This topic describes how to print ofce documents based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Ofce document created using word-processing or spreadsheet programs Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Sheets Paper type: Plain Paper Paper size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click Ofce Document in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View Settings. 6. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 172 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Ofce Documents 7. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4. 8. 9. Click Manual in the L Paper Source list. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) 10. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Caution • Depending on the A Media Type setting, some E Print Target options may not be available. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Working With Various Print Jobs 173 Printing Ofce Documents Printing Ofce Documents (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print ofce documents based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Ofce document created using word-processing or spreadsheet programs Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Sheets Paper type: Plain Paper Paper size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4 - for Paper Tray (Large Margins). 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 174 Working With Various Print Jobs Printing Ofce Documents 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click Ofce Document in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View set.. 8. 9. 10. 11. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Manual in the A Paper Source list. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4 - for Paper Tray (Large Margins). Working With Various Print Jobs 175 Printing Ofce Documents 12. Specify additional printing conditions. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) 13. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 176 Working With Various Print Jobs Adjusting Images Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver Color settings specied in the application for your documents are essentially given priority over other settings for each print job, but further color adjustment is possible in the printer driver. Color Mode Choose how the printer driver processes color, as desired. The available options vary depending on the color mode. Color Mode Description Color Adjustment Color Print in color. You can adjust the color balance and color-matching method. Monochrome Print in grayscale. You can adjust the color balance. Color (CAD) A color mode optimized for line drawings (2D-CAD). Lines in red, yellow, and other colors are printed especially clearly. You can adjust the color balance. Monochrome (BK ink) A color mode for printing line drawings. Only Black ink is used. You can adjust the color balance. Monochrome Bitmap Print in a color mode for CAD, using Color Ink, with all non-white portions printed in black. No color adjustment is supported. Enhanced Printing Options 177 Adjusting Images Color Adjustment You can adjust colors separately for images, graphics, and text documents. Adjustment Item Cyan Description Fine-tune color tones by adjusting the levels of Cyan, Magenta, and Yellow. Magenta Yellow Gray Tone Adjust the gray tone to suit the images of monochrome photos. Choose cool black (tinged with blue), pure black (neutral), warm black (tinged with red), and so on. Select the color tone in the color region or from the list. Brightness Adjust the brightness of printed images while keeping the darkest and lightest portions intact. Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other. For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. Saturation Adjust the level of color saturation, in a range from subdued to vivid. Note • Click Object Adjustment to open the Object Adjustment dialog box, which allows you to select the color adjustment target from Image, Graphics, and Text. 178 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images Matching You can choose the color-matching mode and method. By adjusting the color-matching mode and method, you can make printed colors match the colors of on-screen images more closely. Matching Mode Description Remarks Driver Matching Mode Color adjustment based on the original color prole of the printer driver. This is the default color-matching method. Normally, use Driver Matching Mode. ICC Matching Mode Color adjustment based on ICC color proles (an international standard) using the printer driver. You can select the Input Prole in the Input Prole Settings. You can select the printer prole in the Printer Prole Settings list. Driver ICM Mode Color adjustment based on the standard Windows ICM function. The printer driver adjusts the colors. Available when using Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003, Windows Vista, or Windows Server 2008. Host ICM Mode Color adjustment based on the standard Windows ICM function. Windows adjusts the colors. ColorSync Color adjustment based on the standard Mac OS ColorSync function. Mac OS adjusts the colors. Available when using Mac OS X 10.3.9-10.4. Off (No Adjustment) No color-matching Choose this option for color-matching by the software application or with your own color prole, when you want to disable color-matching by the printer driver. Matching Method Description Auto Color-matching optimized for images, graphics, or text. Perceptual Color-matching optimized for photos. Prints images with smooth gradations and colors closer to those as displayed on the screen. Colorimetric Color-matching with adjustment to remove color from white area. Colors in data are reproduced accurately. Colorimetric (No Wht-pnt Corr) Color-matching without white adjustment to reect the prole of original data. Colors in data are reproduced accurately. Without white adjustment, colors are added to white areas. Saturation Color-matching optimized for graphics. This option emphasizes color saturation. Remarks The available options and their display order vary depending on your selected color-matching mode, as well as the operating system. Enhanced Printing Options 179 Adjusting Images Note • Be sure to calibrate your monitor colors correctly if you adjust the colors for printing. If monitor colors are not calibrated correctly, you may not obtain the desired printing results. For instructions on monitor calibration, refer to the documentation for your monitor and operating system. For instructions on color adjustment, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Windows) (→P.181) • Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Mac OS X) (→P.184) 180 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Windows) You can specify your own print settings instead of using the Print Target presets. This topic describes how to ne-tune the color tone of photos before printing. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. 6. Click Color in the G Color Mode list. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click D Advanced Settings to switch the print mode. Enhanced Printing Options 181 Adjusting Images 7. Click H Color Settings to display the Color Settings dialog box. 8. On the Color Adjustment sheet, adjust the color tones, brightness, and so on as desired. Adjustment Item D Cyan E Magenta Description Fine-tune color tones by adjusting the levels of Cyan, Magenta, and Yellow. F Yellow G Gray Tone Adjust the gray tone to suit the images of monochrome photos. Choose cool black (tinged with blue), pure black (neutral), warm black (tinged with red), and so on. Select the color tone in the color region or from the list. H Brightness Adjust the brightness of printed images while keeping the darkest and lightest portions intact. I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other. For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. J Saturation Adjust the level of color saturation, in a range from subdued to vivid. Note • Click Object Adjustment to open the Object Adjustment dialog box, which allows you to select the color adjustment target from Image, Graphics, and Text. 9. Close the Color Settings dialog box. 182 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images 10. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 11. 12. Conrm the settings of A Page Size, L Paper Source, and so on. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 183 Adjusting Images Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Mac OS X) You can specify your own print settings instead of using the Print Target presets. This topic describes how to ne-tune the color tone of photos before printing. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the F Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Main pane. 184 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. 8. 9. Click Color in the H Color Mode list. Click D Advanced Settings to switch the print mode. Click I Set to display the Color Settings dialog box. Enhanced Printing Options 185 Adjusting Images 10. On the Color Adjustment pane, adjust the color tones, brightness, and so on as desired. Adjustment Item D Cyan E Magenta Description Fine-tune color tones by adjusting the levels of Cyan, Magenta, and Yellow. F Yellow G Gray Tone Adjust the gray tone to suit the images of monochrome photos. Choose cool black (tinged with blue), pure black (neutral), warm black (tinged with red), and so on. Select the color tone in the color region or from the list. H Brightness Adjust the brightness of printed images while keeping the darkest and lightest portions intact. I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other. For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. J Saturation Adjust the level of color saturation, in a range from subdued to vivid. Note • Click Object Adjustment to open the Object Adjustment dialog box, which allows you to select the color adjustment target from Image, Graphics, and Text. 11. 12. Click OK to close the Color Settings dialog box. 13. 14. Conrm the settings of A Paper Source and C Page Size. Access the Page Setup pane. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 186 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing You can specify detailed print settings as desired for the quality level, colors, and other criteria. Advanced Settings For printing results that appear just as expected for your original, you can specify which graphic elements and colors to prioritize for printing. Note • Easy Settings are also available, providing convenient presets. To use the presets, simply choose the printing application. For details on Easy Settings, refer to the following topics. • Printing Photos and Images (→P.152) • Printing Line Drawings and Text (→P.160) • Printing Ofce Documents (→P.171) Print Priority Choose the graphic elements that you want to emphasize for printing. Print Priority (*1) Description Image A setting for posters or other documents made up mainly of photos or images, or for emphasizing photos or images in printed documents. Line Drawing/Text Choose this setting for CAD drawings made up mainly of intricate lines, or wall newspapers and other notices with a large amount of text. Suitable for emphasizing detailed text in printed documents. However, the quality may not be sufcient when printing photos or images that require a lot of color coverage. In this case, choose “Image” instead. Ofce Document Choose this setting for better legibility of documents combining text and graphics, such as documents and presentation material created with typical ofce applications. *1: Options suitable for the selected type of paper are listed under Print Priority. Print Quality Choose the print quality. The printing mode is determined by a combination of the print quality and resolution. Print Quality (*1) Description Print Priority Highest A setting for printing at the highest resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in other modes, but this mode offers superior printing quality. Image High Choose this setting to print at high resolution when quality is most important. Printing takes longer and consumes more ink than in “Standard” or “Draft” modes, but this mode offers exceptional printing quality. Image Line Drawing/Text Enhanced Printing Options 187 Adjusting Images Description Print Quality (*1) Print Priority Standard Choose this setting to print at standard resolution when quality and speed are both important. Printing takes less time than in “Highest” or “High” mode. Image Line Drawing/Text Ofce Document Draft Choose this setting to print faster. Printing in draft mode can help you work more efciently when checking layouts. Image Line Drawing/Text *1: Options suitable for the selected Print Priority are listed under Print Quality. Color Settings Setting Item Description Options Color Mode (*1) Color Monochrome Color (CAD) Monochrome (BK ink) Monochrome Bitmap Choose whether to print in color or monochrome. (→P.177) Color Adjustment Cyan Magenta Yellow Gray Tone Brightness Contrast Saturation You can adjust the levels of cyan, magenta, and yellow as well as the brightness, contrast, saturation, and gray tones. If you choose Monochrome or Monochrome (BK ink) in Color Mode only Brightness and Contrast can be adjusted. Image, Graphics, and Text are available as Object Adjustment options. (In Windows and Mac OS X 10.5 only.) Color-Matching Modes Driver Matching Mode ICC Matching Mode Driver ICM Mode Host ICM Mode ColorSync (Mac OS 10.3.9-10.4) Off (Windows) No Correction (Max OS X) Choose the color-matching mode. Other color-matching modes may be provided by the computer operating system, such as ICM and ColorSync. Color-Matching Method (*2) Auto Perceptual Colorimetric Colorimetric (No Wht-pnt Corr) (Max OS X) Saturation other Choose the color-matching method. The available options vary depending on your selection in “Color-Matching Mode”. *1: Options suitable for the selected Print Priority are listed under Color Mode. *2: The order of options displayed varies depending on the operating system. 188 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images Enhancing printing quality Setting Item Description Unidirectional Printing Choosing unidirectional printing can improve printing results if lines are printed crooked or images are uneven. However, this takes more time than regular printing. Thicken Fine Lines (Windows) Thicken Fine Lines (Mac OS X) Choose this option to make ne lines clearer in CAD drawings or similar documents. Sharpen Text Choose this option to print intricate text more distinctly. Reduce Print Unevenness (*1) Choose this option to counteract uneven printing. Economy Printing When this mode is selected, less ink is consumed than in regular printing, but the quality is diminished. Select this mode if you want to conserve ink when checking drawings, for example. Depending on the Media Type and Print Quality settings, this mode may not be available. *1: Displayed in Mac OS X. Note • To print at a higher level of quality, in the printer driver, choose High or Highest in Print Quality, and choose Unidirectional Printing as the direction of printing. For instructions on specifying the print quality and color settings before printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Windows) (→P.190) • Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Mac OS X) (→P.192) Enhanced Printing Options 189 Adjusting Images Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Windows) You can specify your own print settings instead of using the Print Target presets. As an example, this topic describes how to print CAD drawings as clearly as possible, with sharp lines and text. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. 6. 7. Click Line Drawing/Text in the E Print Priority list. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click D Advanced Settings to switch the print mode. Click High (1200dpi) in the F Print Quality list. Note • Options displayed in the F Print Quality list vary depending on the paper type. 190 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images 8. 9. Click Color (CAD) in the G Color Mode list. To adjust the color, click H Color Settings. Note • For instructions on adjusting color,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) 10. 11. Select the K Sharpen Text check box. 12. 13. Conrm the settings of A Page Size, L Paper Source, and so on. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 191 Adjusting Images Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Mac OS X) You can specify your own print settings instead of using the Print Target presets. As an example, this topic describes how to print CAD drawings as clearly as possible, with sharp lines and text. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the F Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. 192 Enhanced Printing Options Adjusting Images 7. Click D Advanced Settings to switch the print mode. 8. 9. Click Line Drawing in the E Print Priority list. Click High(1200dpi) in the F Print Quality list. Note • Options displayed in the F Print Quality list vary depending on the type of paper. 10. 11. Click Color (CAD) in the H Color Mode list. To adjust the color, click I Set. Note • For instructions on adjusting color, see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) 12. Access the Page Setup pane. 13. 14. Conrm the settings of A Paper Source and C Page Size. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 193 Choosing Paper for Printing Choosing Paper for Printing Choosing a Paper for Printing Choosing the right paper for your particular printing application will give you the best printing results. Media Type The printer and printer driver offer print settings optimized for various paper characteristics. Note • For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • The types of paper indicated in the printer driver and related software (as well as on the Control Panel) are updated when you install the Media Conguration Tool from the User Software CD-ROM or if you change paper information by using the Media Conguration Tool. For information about the Media Conguration Tool, see the Media Conguration Tool (Windows) or Media Conguration Tool (Macintosh). • An error message may be displayed on the printer Control Panel if the type of paper as specied in the printer driver does not match the type specied on the printer. Although you can print under these conditions, the printing results may not be suitable. If the paper type is not listed for selection If the type of paper loaded is not listed among the options for selection, try printing on Special 1, Special 2, and so on. Note that higher numbers in this setting enable more vivid colors but may also cause colors to run together. For instructions on specifying the paper type before printing, refer to the following topics. • Changing the Type of Paper (→P.195) 194 Enhanced Printing Options Choosing Paper for Printing Changing the Type of Paper Follow these steps to change the type of paper specied on the printer after you have loaded paper. If you will continue using this type of paper later, selecting Keep Paper Type > On will save the time and effort of conguring the media type setting when you load the paper again. The current media type settings before you select On will be automatically selected at that time. (→P.111) Important • For best printing results, the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper. Be sure to select the type of paper to use correctly before printing. • Because the printer ne-tunes the feed amount for each type of paper, the margins and the size of printed images may vary depending on the type of paper used. If margins and the size of images are not as you expected, adjust the paper feed amount. (→P.612) Changing the Type of Paper Note • After you load a roll, the printer automatically shows a menu for selection of the type of paper on the Display Screen. Select the type of paper and press the OK button. If no barcode has been printed on the roll and you have set ManageRemainRoll to On, specify the roll length after the type of paper. (→P.112) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Chg. Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded (Roll Paper or Cut Sheet), and then press the OK button. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper loaded in the printer, and then press the OK button. Note • For details on types of paper, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) By default, Plain Paper is selected. • If you move the Release Lever, the setting automatically reverts to the previously selected paper. • Be sure to select the correct paper type. If this setting does not match the loaded paper, it may cause feed errors and affect printing quality. Enhanced Printing Options 195 Choosing Paper for Printing Using the Same Type of Paper Regularly Congure this setting so that current media type settings will be automatically selected when you load the same type of paper later. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Keep Paper Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. Note • The specied media type setting is updated in the following situations. • When using sheets, if you send a print job before loading a sheet, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the print job. • When you have selected ManageRemainRoll > On on the Control Panel and a barcode is printed on the roll, the media type setting is updated to match the type of paper specied by the barcode. • To change the media type setting, see “Changing the Type of Paper”. (→P.195) 196 Enhanced Printing Options Choosing Paper for Printing Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver If you replace the paper, complete the printer driver settings for the paper type and size. For instructions on conguring paper settings in the printer driver, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) (→P.197) • Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) (→P.199) Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. Important • Always specify the same type and size of paper in the printer menu and printer driver. If the type and size do not match, an error message will be displayed and printing is not possible. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Note • Click the B Get Information button to display the Paper Information on Printer dialog box. On the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, you can obtain information on the paper in the printer and congure printer driver settings for the feed source and type of paper. Enhanced Printing Options 197 Choosing Paper for Printing 5. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 6. 7. 8. In the A Page Size list, select the size of the original as specied in the application. In the L Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Roll Paper in L Paper Source, select the width of the loaded roll in M Roll Paper Width. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) 198 Enhanced Printing Options Choosing Paper for Printing Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the F Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Enhanced Printing Options 199 Choosing Paper for Printing 7. Access the Page Setup pane. 8. 9. In the A Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Manual in A Paper Source, make sure the size as selected in Page Setup is displayed in C Page Size. If you have selected Roll Paper in A Paper Source, make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width. Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) 200 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size You can freely adjust the size of originals by enlarging or reducing them as desired. Enlarged/Reduced Printing Enlarge or reduce the original in the printer driver, as desired. Fit Paper Size Enlarge or reduce the original to match the size of the paper you are using. For instructions on resizing originals to match the paper size, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows) (→P.202) • Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X) (→P.204) Note • For better printing results when enlarging photos from a digital camera in TIFF or JPEG format, use an image-editing application software such as Adobe Photoshop to specify an image resolution of 150 dpi or more at actual size. Enhanced Printing Options 201 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing to match the paper size, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then open the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Select the printing application in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 202 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 9. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4. 10. 11. 12. 13. Select the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Select the D Fit Paper Size check box. Click ISO A3 in the G Paper Size list. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 203 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing to match the paper size, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 204 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 205 Printing enlargements or reductions 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure C Page Size on the Page Setup pane shows the original size as specied in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 13. 14. 15. 16. Select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Make sure E Fit Paper Size is selected. Click ISO A3 in the I Paper Size list. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 206 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width You can freely adjust the size of originals by enlarging or reducing them as desired. Enlarged/Reduced Printing Enlarge or reduce the original in the printer driver, as desired. Fit Roll Paper Width Enlarge or reduce the original as a whole to match the roll paper width, as desired. For instructions on resizing originals to match the roll paper width, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows) (→P.208) • Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X) (→P.210) Note • For better printing results when enlarging photos from a digital camera in TIFF or JPEG format, use an image-editing application software such as Adobe Photoshop to specify an image resolution of 150 dpi or more at actual size. Enhanced Printing Options 207 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing to match the roll width, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: 16 inches (406.4 mm) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Select the printing application in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 208 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 9. Select the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Note • If the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box is not displayed on the Page Setup sheet, clear the B Borderless Printing check box. 10. Click E Fit Roll Paper Width. Note • After you click E Fit Roll Paper Width, the Information dialog box is displayed. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list and click OK. • Make sure the roll paper width you specify matches the width of the loaded roll. 11. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 209 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing to match the roll width, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: 16 inches (406.4 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 210 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. 11. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 16 in. (406.4mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Enhanced Printing Options 211 Printing enlargements or reductions 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 13. 14. 15. Select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Click F Fit Roll Paper Width. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 212 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value You can freely adjust the size of originals by enlarging or reducing them as desired. Enlarged/Reduced Printing Enlarge or reduce the original in the printer driver, as desired. Scaling Enlarge or reduce originals by a particular amount, as desired. For instructions on entering a scaling value to resize originals, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Windows) (→P.214) • Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Mac OS X) (→P.216) Note • For better printing results when enlarging photos from a digital camera in TIFF or JPEG format, use an image-editing application software such as Adobe Photoshop to specify an image resolution of 150 dpi or more at actual size. Enhanced Printing Options 213 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Windows) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing by entering a scaling value, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) Important • In borderless printing, you cannot resize originals by entering a scaling value. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Select the printing application in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 214 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 9. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4. 10. 11. 12. Select the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Click ISO A4 in the G Paper Size list. Click F Scaling and enter “120”. Note • You can specify enlargement that exceeds the paper size, but in this case, the portions off the bottom and right edges of the paper will not be printed. • If the original size after enlargement or reduction is smaller than the paper size, the original is printed in the upper-left corner. In this case, you can center originals by selecting E Print Centered on the Layout sheet. 13. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 215 Printing enlargements or reductions Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before printing by entering a scaling value, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 216 Enhanced Printing Options Printing enlargements or reductions 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 217 Printing enlargements or reductions 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 13. 14. Select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Click G Scaling and enter “120”. Note • You can specify enlargement that exceeds the paper size, but in this case, the portion off the edge of the paper will not be printed. • If the original size after enlargement or reduction is smaller than the paper size, the original is printed in the upper-left corner. In this case, you can center originals by selecting the J Print Centered check box. 15. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 218 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size Printing at full size Printing on Oversized Paper Except in borderless printing, the actual printing area corresponds to your selected paper size minus the space for a margin. (→P.75) To print documents or images you prepare without a margin at actual size, use an oversized paper size. For example, to print a A4-sized original without a margin at A4 size, print it on paper larger than A4 size and cut away the excess margin. Note • If you prepare an original for printing without a margin and print it on paper of regular size, the image near the edge will not be printed. Oversize The margin required by the printer is added around the “outside” of a regular paper size. For example, when printing a A4-sized original (210×297 mm), you have the following options. • (a) Regular paper size: Gray area not printed • (b) Page Size • (c) Oversized paper size: Print area matches the page size (b) Important • When printing on oversize paper, load paper larger than the page size-a size that includes the margin required by the printer. • Sheets: Load paper that is at least 6 mm (0.24 in) wider and 26 mm (1 in) higher than the page size • Rolls: Load paper that is at least 6 mm (0.24 in) wider and 6 mm (0.24 in) higher than the page size Note • Paper larger than the maximum size supported by the printer cannot be used as paper for oversized printing. (→P.100) • Oversized printing (selecting Oversize in Page Size) is only available in Windows. For oversized printing on sheets, choose Manual as Paper Source. • To perform oversized printing on a Macintosh computer, you must specify a non-standard page size and print on it. • To specify a non-standard paper size in oversized printing, register the paper size as a Custom Paper Size. Oversized printing is not available with “Custom Size”. (→P.261) Enhanced Printing Options 219 Printing at full size For instructions on oversized printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing at Full Size (Windows) (→P.220) • Printing at Full Size (Mac OS X) (→P.222) Printing at Full Size (Windows) This topic describes how to print at full size based on the following example. (Oversized Printing) • • • • • Document: Any Type Page Size: A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 220 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. Click O Size Options to display the Paper Size Options dialog box. In the Paper Size Options dialog box, select the Oversize check box in Display Series. Click OK to close the Paper Size Options dialog box. Click Oversize - ISO A4 in the A Page Size list. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 12. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 221 Printing at full size Printing at Full Size (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print at full size based on the following example. (Oversized Printing) • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In F Paper Size, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4 - Oversize. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 222 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 223 Printing at full size 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure C Page Size shows the original size as specied in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4 - Oversize. 13. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 224 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size Borderless Printing at Actual Size Take advantage of borderless printing to print documents such as posters (made up mainly of photos or images) without a surrounding margin, or border. Borderless Printing In regular printing, a margin required by the printer is added around the original. With borderless printing, you can print documents without the margin, so that the printed image covers the entire surface of the paper. Important • Borderless printing is only available with rolls. • Paper you can use for borderless printing is restricted to particular types of paper and rolls of particular widths. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Paper incompatible with the printer’s auto cut function can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. • These features cannot be used in combination with borderless printing: special page layouts, centering originals, and printing cut lines on rolls. • You cannot have pages rotated 90 degrees to conserve paper if you have set up borderless printing at actual size or in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. • When borderless printing is used, the edge of the paper is cut during printing. Thus, ink density may be uneven at the edges. If you require higher image quality, specify No in Auto Cut in the printer driver. In this case, the paper can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. After ejecting and cutting the printed document, use scissors to cut away the top and bottom edges. • By factory default, the ink drying time is disabled for all paper. When you are using paper that takes longer for ink to adhere for borderless printing and the Cutter Unit touches printing surfaces that are not dry yet, it may damage the paper or the edge of the document that is cut, depending on frequency of use. In this case, follow these steps to change the ink drying time. • On the Main sheet of the printer driver, click Settings in Media Type. • Select the ink drying time in the Between Pages list of Drying Time. Borderless Printing Method Choose the method of borderless printing that suits the original, as desired. Enhanced Printing Options 225 Printing at full size Print Image with Actual Size Prints originals at actual size, without enlarging or reducing them. Originals must be prepared in a size that exceeds the dimensions of the paper by 3 mm (0.12 in) on each side. Note • Not all page sizes are available. • Even if you prepare originals of the same size as the paper size, the originals are automatically enlarged when you print borderlessly in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. This may affect image quality. When image quality is most important, make the original 3 mm longer on each side than the paper size so that the image can be printed at actual size in borderless printing. For instructions on borderless printing of photos and images at actual size, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows) (→P.227) • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X) (→P.229) 226 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows) This topic describes how to print borderlessly at actual size based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any type Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) Create the original in the source application 3 mm (0.12 in) larger on each side than 254.0×304.8 mm (10 × 12 in) -that is, 260.0×310.8 mm (10.2 × 12.2 in) Note • If you can specify the margin, as in Microsoft Word, set the margin at 0 mm. For instructions on specifying the margin, refer to the software documentation. • The extra 3 mm (0.12 in) on each side will not be printed. Create the original so that it ts inside the paper area to be printed on. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Coated Paper. 6. Select the print target in the E Print Target list. Enhanced Printing Options 227 Printing at full size 7. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the source application. In this case, click 10"x12". 9. 10. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. 11. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list-in this case, click 10-in. Roll Select the B Borderless Printing check box to display the Information dialog box. (254.0mm). 12. 13. 14. Click OK to close the Information dialog box. In C Borderless Printing Method, click F Print Image with Actual Size. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) 228 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print borderlessly at actual size based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: 10 × 12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm)-Borderless Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, choose a paper size supported for borderless printing. Here, click 10"x12" - Borderless. Note • Paper sizes supported for borderless printing are indicated by “-Borderless”. 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. Enhanced Printing Options 229 Printing at full size 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Coated Paper. 7. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. 230 Enhanced Printing Options Printing at full size 11. Conrm that the roll paper width matches the paper size. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 10 in. (254.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, 10"x12" - Borderless. 13. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 231 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size Take advantage of borderless printing to print documents such as posters (made up mainly of photos or images) without a surrounding margin, or border. Borderless Printing In regular printing, a margin required by the printer is added around the original. With borderless printing, you can print documents without the margin, so that the printed image covers the entire surface of the paper. Important • Borderless printing is only available with rolls. • Paper you can use for borderless printing is restricted to particular types of paper and rolls of particular widths. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Paper incompatible with the printer’s auto cut function can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. • These features cannot be used in combination with borderless printing: special page layouts, centering originals, and printing cut lines on rolls. • You cannot have pages rotated 90 degrees to conserve paper if you have set up borderless printing at actual size or in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. • When borderless printing is used, the edge of the paper is cut during printing. Thus, ink density may be uneven at the edges. If you require higher image quality, specify No in Auto Cut in the printer driver. In this case, the paper can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. After ejecting and cutting the printed document, use scissors to cut away the top and bottom edges. • By factory default, the ink drying time is disabled for all paper. When you are using paper that takes longer for ink to adhere for borderless printing and the Cutter Unit touches printing surfaces that are not dry yet, it may damage the paper or the edge of the document that is cut, depending on frequency of use. In this case, follow these steps to change the ink drying time. • On the Main sheet of the printer driver, click Settings in Media Type. • Select the ink drying time in the Between Pages list of Drying Time. Borderless Printing Method Choose the method of borderless printing that suits the original, as desired. 232 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing Fit Paper Size Enlarge or reduce the original to match the size of the paper you are using. Note • The printer driver automatically enlarges originals 3 mm (0.12 in) past the dimensions of the paper on each side. The 3 mm portion beyond the edge on each side is not printed. For instructions on borderless printing of photos, images, and other documents to match the paper size, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows) (→P.234) • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X) (→P.236) Enhanced Printing Options 233 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before borderless printing to match the paper size, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any type Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) In the application, create an original that takes up the entire space of the paper size. Note • If you can specify the margin, as in Microsoft Word, set the margin at 0 mm. For instructions on specifying the margin, refer to the software documentation. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Coated Paper. 6. Select the print target in the E Print Target list. 234 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing 7. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click 10"x12". 9. 10. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. 11. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list-in this case, click 10-in. Roll Select the B Borderless Printing check box to display the Information dialog box. (254.0mm). 12. 13. 14. 15. Click OK to close the Information dialog box. In C Borderless Printing Method, click D Fit Paper Size. Click Match Page Size in the G Paper Size list. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 235 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before borderless printing to match the paper size, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click 10"x12". Note • All sizes are available in borderless printing if you resize originals to match the paper size. 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 236 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Coated Paper. 7. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 237 Borderless Printing 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 10 in. (254.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, 10"x12". 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. On the Page Setup pane, select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Select the H Borderless Printing check box. Click E Fit Paper Size under D Enlarged/Reduced Printing. In I Paper Size, click the paper size. In this case, click 10"x12" - Borderless. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 238 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width Take advantage of borderless printing to print documents such as posters (made up mainly of photos or images) without a surrounding margin, or border. Borderless Printing In regular printing, a margin required by the printer is added around the original. With borderless printing, you can print documents without the margin, so that the printed image covers the entire surface of the paper. Important • Borderless printing is only available with rolls. • Paper you can use for borderless printing is restricted to particular types of paper and rolls of particular widths. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Paper incompatible with the printer’s auto cut function can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. • These features cannot be used in combination with borderless printing: special page layouts, centering originals, and printing cut lines on rolls. • You cannot have pages rotated 90 degrees to conserve paper if you have set up borderless printing at actual size or in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. • When borderless printing is used, the edge of the paper is cut during printing. Thus, ink density may be uneven at the edges. If you require higher image quality, specify No in Auto Cut in the printer driver. In this case, the paper can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. After ejecting and cutting the printed document, use scissors to cut away the top and bottom edges. • By factory default, the ink drying time is disabled for all paper. When you are using paper that takes longer for ink to adhere for borderless printing and the Cutter Unit touches printing surfaces that are not dry yet, it may damage the paper or the edge of the document that is cut, depending on frequency of use. In this case, follow these steps to change the ink drying time. • On the Main sheet of the printer driver, click Settings in Media Type. • Select the ink drying time in the Between Pages list of Drying Time. Borderless Printing Method Choose the method of borderless printing that suits the original, as desired. Enhanced Printing Options 239 Borderless Printing Scale to t Roll Paper Width Enlarge or reduce the original as a whole to match the roll paper width. Note • You can combine this function with rotating pages 90 degrees before printing so that the original width (relative to portrait orientation) matches the roll paper width in borderless printing. For instructions on borderless printing of photos, images, and other documents to match the roll paper width, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows) (→P.241) • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X) (→P.243) 240 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before borderless printing to match the roll width, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) In the application, create an original that takes up the entire space of the paper size. Note • If you can specify the margin, as in Microsoft Word, set the margin at 0 mm. For instructions on specifying the margin, refer to the software documentation. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Coated Paper. 6. Select the print target in the E Print Target list. Enhanced Printing Options 241 Borderless Printing 7. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 9. 10. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. 11. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list-in this case, click 10-in. Roll Select the B Borderless Printing check box to display the Information dialog box. (254.0mm). 12. 13. 14. Click OK to close the Information dialog box. In C Borderless Printing Method, make sure E Scale to t Roll Paper Width is selected. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) 242 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to enlarge originals before borderless printing to match the roll width, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. Note • All sizes are available in borderless printing if you resize originals to t the roll width. 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. Enhanced Printing Options 243 Borderless Printing 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Coated Paper. 7. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. 244 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 10 in. (254.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 13. 14. Select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Select the H Borderless Printing check box. This ensures that F Fit Roll Paper Width is automatically selected in D Enlarged/Reduced Printing. 15. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 245 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing at Actual Size Take advantage of borderless printing to print documents such as posters (made up mainly of photos or images) without a surrounding margin, or border. Borderless Printing In regular printing, a margin required by the printer is added around the original. With borderless printing, you can print documents without the margin, so that the printed image covers the entire surface of the paper. Important • Borderless printing is only available with rolls. • Paper you can use for borderless printing is restricted to particular types of paper and rolls of particular widths. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Paper incompatible with the printer’s auto cut function can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. • These features cannot be used in combination with borderless printing: special page layouts, centering originals, and printing cut lines on rolls. • You cannot have pages rotated 90 degrees to conserve paper if you have set up borderless printing at actual size or in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. • When borderless printing is used, the edge of the paper is cut during printing. Thus, ink density may be uneven at the edges. If you require higher image quality, specify No in Auto Cut in the printer driver. In this case, the paper can be printed without borders on the left and right sides only. After ejecting and cutting the printed document, use scissors to cut away the top and bottom edges. • By factory default, the ink drying time is disabled for all paper. When you are using paper that takes longer for ink to adhere for borderless printing and the Cutter Unit touches printing surfaces that are not dry yet, it may damage the paper or the edge of the document that is cut, depending on frequency of use. In this case, follow these steps to change the ink drying time. • On the Main sheet of the printer driver, click Settings in Media Type. • Select the ink drying time in the Between Pages list of Drying Time. Borderless Printing Method Choose the method of borderless printing that suits the original, as desired. 246 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing Print Image with Actual Size Prints originals at actual size, without enlarging or reducing them. Originals must be prepared in a size that exceeds the dimensions of the paper by 3 mm (0.12 in) on each side. Note • Not all page sizes are available. • Even if you prepare originals of the same size as the paper size, the originals are automatically enlarged when you print borderlessly in combination with resizing originals to match the paper size. This may affect image quality. When image quality is most important, make the original 3 mm longer on each side than the paper size so that the image can be printed at actual size in borderless printing. For instructions on borderless printing of photos and images at actual size, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows) (→P.248) • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X) (→P.250) Enhanced Printing Options 247 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows) This topic describes how to print borderlessly at actual size based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any type Page size: 10×12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm) Paper: Roll Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) Create the original in the source application 3 mm (0.12 in) larger on each side than 254.0×304.8 mm (10 × 12 in) -that is, 260.0×310.8 mm (10.2 × 12.2 in) Note • If you can specify the margin, as in Microsoft Word, set the margin at 0 mm. For instructions on specifying the margin, refer to the software documentation. • The extra 3 mm (0.12 in) on each side will not be printed. Create the original so that it ts inside the paper area to be printed on. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Coated Paper. 6. Select the print target in the E Print Target list. 248 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing 7. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the source application. In this case, click 10"x12". 9. 10. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. 11. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list-in this case, click 10-in. Roll Select the B Borderless Printing check box to display the Information dialog box. (254.0mm). 12. 13. 14. Click OK to close the Information dialog box. In C Borderless Printing Method, click F Print Image with Actual Size. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 249 Borderless Printing Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print borderlessly at actual size based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: 10 × 12 inches (254.0×304.8 mm)-Borderless Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Heavyweight Coated Paper Roll paper width: 10 inches (254.0 mm) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, choose a paper size supported for borderless printing. Here, click 10"x12" - Borderless. Note • Paper sizes supported for borderless printing are indicated by “-Borderless”. 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 250 Enhanced Printing Options Borderless Printing 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Heavyweight Coated Paper. 7. 8. 9. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 251 Borderless Printing 11. Conrm that the roll paper width matches the paper size. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 10 in. (254.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, 10"x12" - Borderless. 13. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 252 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing) You can create vertical or horizontal banners by printing originals that are in banner format on rolls. Originals created in Microsoft Word or other applications in your preferred size can be enlarged to ll the width of roll paper by completing simple printer driver settings. Fit Roll Paper Width You can easily create vertical or horizontal banners by automatically enlarging or reducing originals to t the full width of rolls. Note • The maximum supported roll length is 18.0 m or 19.7 yd. For instructions on printing vertical or horizontal banners, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Windows) (→P.254) • Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Mac OS X) (→P.258) Important • Before printing, check how much of the roll paper is left. If you have activated automatic detection of the remaining roll paper, a warning message is displayed when there is not enough roll paper left. • If not much ink is left, prepare replacement ink tanks. • To print at a higher level of quality, in the printer driver, choose High or Highest in Print Quality, and choose Unidirectional Printing as the direction of printing. Enhanced Printing Options 253 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Windows) This topic describes how to print a banner about ve times as long as the roll width based on the following example. • • • • • Document: A horizontal banner created in Microsoft Word Page size: Non-standard (100×500 mm [3.9×19.7 in]) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: 16 in (406.4 mm) Follow the steps below to print a banner in either horizontal or vertical format. 1. Register a Custom Paper Size. Banners tend to be in non-standard sizes, so register a Custom Paper Size. In this example, 100×500 mm (3.9×19.7 in) is registered. 2. In the application, create an original in the size you registered. 3. Print the banner, using the settings that correspond to banners. Registering a Custom Paper Size This example describes how to register a paper size that is horizontally elongated and suitable for banners in either horizontal or vertical format. 1. 2. Display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.348) 3. 4. 5. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Click O Size Options to display the Paper Size Options dialog box. Enter a desired paper name in Custom Paper Size Name. “My Horizontal Banner” is used in this example. 6. 7. 8. 9. In Units, click mm. Under Paper Size, enter “100” in Width and “500” in Height. Click Add to add the paper size of “My Horizontal Banner.” Click OK to close the Paper Size Options dialog box. 254 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 10. Close the printer driver dialog box. Note • You can also specify a Custom Size as the paper size. Note that Custom Size settings are not available after you exit the application. For more information,see “Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Windows)”. (→P.262) Creating the banner in the application Follow the steps below to create the banner in Microsoft Word using the Custom Paper Size you registered. 1. 2. 3. Start Microsoft Word. Choose Page Setup from the File menu to display the Page Setup dialog box. Under Paper Size, click the Custom Paper Size you registered-"My Horizontal Banner" in this example. Important • If "My Horizontal Banner" is not listed, make sure this printer is selected as the printer to use. • In applications such as Microsoft PowerPoint that do not enable you to choose registered paper sizes, use the custom paper size setting in “Custom” and specify 100×500 mm (3.9×19.7 in) 4. 5. Set the printing orientation to horizontal. Create the banner. Printing the banner Follow these steps to print the banner using the corresponding banner settings. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the Microsoft Word menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click Poster in the E Print Target list. Enhanced Printing Options 255 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 6. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 7. 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size you registered, “My Horizontal Banner”. Select the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Note • If the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box is not displayed on the Page Setup sheet, clear the B Borderless Printing check box. 9. 10. 11. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. After you click E Fit Roll Paper Width, the Information dialog box is displayed. Select the width of the loaded roll in the Roll Paper Width list. In this case, click 16-in. Roll (406.4mm), and then click OK. 256 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 12. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) If printing is unsuccessful, you may be able to print after completing the following setting. 1. On the Layout sheet, click J Special Settings to display the Special Settings dialog box. 2. In the FineZoom Settings list, click Yes. Enhanced Printing Options 257 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print a banner about ve times as long as the roll width based on the following example. • • • • • Document: An original designed for a horizontal banner Page Size: Non-standard (100×500 mm [3.9×19.7 in]) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: 16 inches (406.4 mm) Follow the steps below to print a banner in either horizontal or vertical format. 1. In the application, create an original in the format of a horizontal or vertical banner. 2. Register a Custom Page Sizes Banners tend to be in non-standard sizes, so register a Custom Page Sizes in Page Setup. In this example, 100×500 mm (3.9×19.7 in) is registered. 3. Print the banner, using the settings that correspond to banners. Note • The following procedures are based on Mac OS X 10.4. The method of setting up non-standard paper sizes varies depending on the version of Mac OS X. Register a Custom Page Sizes This example describes how to register and print using a page size that is horizontally elongated and suitable for banners in either horizontal or vertical format. 1. 2. Create the document in the application. 3. 4. Select the printer in the B Format for list. Choose Page Setup from the application menu to display the Page Attributes dialog box. Click Manage Custom Sizes in the C Paper Size list to display the Custom Page Sizes dialog box. 258 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 5. Double-click Untitled in the list at left, and then enter a name for the page size you want to register. Here, enter “100*500.” If the Untitled size is not listed at left, click + below the list. 6. Under Page Size, enter “10” in Width and “50” in Height. Here, measurements are entered in centimeters. 7. Specify the margins by entering “0.3” in Printer Margins. Here, too, measurements are entered in centimeters. 8. 9. Click OK to close the Custom Page Sizes dialog box. In the C Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click "100*500", the size you registered. 10. 11. In D Orientation, click the icon of the document in landscape orientation. Click F OK to close the dialog box. Print the banner Follow the steps below to print the banner using the corresponding banner settings. 1. 2. Choose Print in the application menu. 3. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Access the Main pane. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Enhanced Printing Options 259 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, 16 in. (406.4mm). Note • If the width of the loaded roll is not displayed in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane and update the printer information. 9. 10. 11. 12. In C Page Size, make sure "100*500" is displayed, as registered in Page Setup. Select the D Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. Click F Fit Roll Paper Width. Conrm the print settings, and click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 260 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes By specifying the paper size, you can print on non-standard sizes of paper. There are two ways to print on non-standard paper sizes, as follows. Registering non-standard paper size in the printer driver After you register non-standard paper sizes, they are listed with standard sizes so that you can choose them anytime as needed. Note • These non-standard paper sizes you register in the printer driver are called Custom Paper Size in Windows and “Custom Sizes” in Mac OS X. Specifying custom paper sizes for temporary use Because these are sizes you specify temporarily in the printer driver, the sizes will not be available after you exit the application. If you want to set up a non-standard paper size so that it will always be available, we recommend registering the paper size in the printer driver. Note • These temporary paper sizes you register on the printer are called “Custom Sizes” in Windows. • This can only be congured in Windows. For instructions on specifying non-standard paper sizes for printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Windows) (→P.262) • Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Mac OS X) (→P.266) Enhanced Printing Options 261 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Windows) This topic describes two ways to print on non-standard paper sizes. • Printing by using Custom Size • Printing by using Custom Paper Size Printing by using Custom Size This section describes how to print using Custom Size based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: Square of non-standard dimensions (430×430 mm [16.9×16.9 in]) Paper: Sheets Paper type: Any type Paper Size: A square sheet (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) 1. 2. 3. 4. Load the square paper (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) in the printer. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Choose Print in the application menu. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, select from the E Print Target list. 262 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Click Manual in the L Paper Source list. Click Custom Size in the A Page Size list to display the Custom Size Settings dialog box. Conrm that mm is selected in Units. Enter “430” (16.9 in) in both Width and Height. Click OK to close the Custom Size Settings dialog box. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 263 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing by using Custom Paper Size This section describes how to print using Custom Paper Size based on the following example. First, register a non-standard paper size called “430 mm Square” as a Custom Paper Size. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page Size: A square sheet (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) Paper: Sheets Media Type: Any type Paper Size: A square sheet (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) 1. 2. 3. 4. Load the square paper (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) in the printer. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the A Media Type that is loaded in the printer. Choose Print in the application menu. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, select the E Print Target from the E Print Target list. 264 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 7. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 8. 9. Click O Size Options to display the Paper Size Options dialog box. Enter a desired paper name in Custom Paper Size Name. “430 mm Square” is used in this example. 10. 11. Select mm in Units. Enter “430” (16.9 in) in both Width and Height. Note • If you select the Fix the Ratio of the Width to Height check box, after you enter a value in either Width or Height, the other value will be automatically applied based on the original aspect ratio. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. Click Add to register “430 mm Square”. Click OK to close the Paper Size Options dialog box. Click Manual in the L Paper Source list. In the A Page Size list, click the size you added, "430 mm Square". Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 265 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Mac OS X) This section describes how to register and print Custom Page Sizes based on the following example. Here, you will register a non-standard paper size named “430*430” in Custom Page Sizes. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page Size: A square sheet (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) Paper: Sheets Media Type: Any type Paper Size: A square sheet (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) Note • The following procedures are based on Mac OS X 10.4. The method of setting up non-standard paper sizes varies depending on the version of Mac OS X. 1. 2. 3. Create the document in the application. Load the square paper (430 × 430 mm [16.9 × 16.9 in]) in the printer. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. 266 Enhanced Printing Options Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 5. Click Manage Custom Sizes in the C Paper Size list to display the Custom Page Sizes dialog box. 6. In Page Size, enter the height and width of the original. Here, enter “43.00 cm” in Height and Width. 7. In Printer Margins, enter “0.5” for the top and side margins and “2.3” for the bottom margin. Here, measurements are entered in centimeters. 8. Double-click Untitled in the list at left in the Custom Page Sizes dialog box and enter the paper name-in this case, “430*430”. 9. 10. Click OK to close the Custom Page Sizes dialog box. In the C Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click “430*430”, the size you registered. 11. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 12. Access the Main pane. 13. 14. 15. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, select from the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Enhanced Printing Options 267 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes 16. Access the Page Setup pane. 17. 18. 19. Click Manual in the A Paper Source list. In C Page Size, make sure “430*430” is displayed, as registered in Page Setup. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 268 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other By arranging originals from word-processing or spreadsheet programs or web browser screen shots next to each other on single sheets, you can create highly expressive presentation materials, easy-to-understand meeting materials, and a variety of other printed documents. Free Layout (Windows) Besides combining multiple pages in a single-page layout, you can combine originals from multiple les-even multiple source applications-in a single-page layout. Important • Free Layout cannot be used in 64-bit version of Windows. Enhanced Printing Options 269 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet imagePROGRAF Free Layout (Macintosh) Besides combining multiple pages in a single-page layout, you can combine originals from multiple les-even multiple source applications-in a single-page layout. For instructions on arranging originals from multiple applications, refer to the following topics. • Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Windows) (→P.271) • Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Mac OS X) (→P.273) 270 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Windows) This topic describes how to arrange multiple originals using the Free Layout function. Important • Free Layout cannot be used in 64-bit version of Windows. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. 5. 6. Select the A Page Layout check box. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click Free Layout in the A Page Layout list. Enhanced Printing Options 271 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 7. When you attempt to print, the imagePROGRAF Free Layout window is displayed. (At this point, the document will not be printed yet.) 8. Edit and rearrange the image in the imagePROGRAF Free Layout window as desired. Important • Without closing the imagePROGRAF Free Layout window, repeat steps 1-7 to arrange originals from multiple applications on the same page. Note • For instructions on editing and rearranging images, refer to the imagePROGRAF Free Layout help topic. 9. Print from the imagePROGRAF Free Layout menu. Note • For details on imagePROGRAF Free Layout functions, refer to Free Layout. 272 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to use the Free Layout function to arrange multiple originals next to each other before printing. 1. 2. Choose Print in the application menu. 3. 4. 5. Select the N Free Layout check box. 6. Edit and rearrange the image in the Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout window as desired. Access the Page Setup pane. Click M Print. The Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout window is displayed. Note • Without closing the Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout window, repeat steps 1 to 4 to arrange originals from multiple applications on the same page. • For instructions on editing and rearranging images, refer to the Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout help topic. Enhanced Printing Options 273 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 7. Print from the Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout menu. Note • For details on Canon imagePROGRAF Free Layout functions, refer to Free Layout. 274 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Continuously You can print multiple pages as a single continuous image, without margins between pages. Roll paper (banner) Important • This feature is only available with rolls. It cannot be used when printing on sheets. • During banner printing, settings for conserving paper, number of copies, borderless printing, enlargement or reduction, and other layout-related settings are disregarded. For instructions on borderless printing of photos and images at actual size, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Windows) (→P.276) • Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Mac OS X) (→P.278) Enhanced Printing Options 275 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Windows) This topic describes how to print multiple pages as a single continuous image, without margins between pages. Important • This feature is only available with rolls. It cannot be used when printing on sheets. • During banner printing, settings for conserving paper, number of copies, borderless printing, enlargement or reduction, and other layout-related settings are disregarded. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, click the type of paper that is loaded. 6. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 276 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 7. 8. 9. 10. Click N Roll Paper Options to display the Roll Paper Options dialog box. Select the B Banner Printing check box. Click OK. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 277 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print multiple pages as a single continuous image, without margins between pages. Important • This feature is only available with rolls. It cannot be used when printing on sheets. • During banner printing, settings for conserving paper, number of copies, borderless printing, enlargement or reduction, and other layout-related settings are disregarded. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Click the original size in the C Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 278 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, click the type of paper that is loaded. 10. 11. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper (Banner) in the A Paper Source list. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 279 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet To conserve paper, you can print several pages of the original on a single sheet by reducing the original and dividing the sheet into areas for each page. Page Layout Specify a number of pages of the original to print on a single sheet, in a layout of multiple pages per sheet. Note • You can print up to 16 pages of the original on a single sheet. • You can also change the page layout order and print page boundary lines, as desired. Important • This function cannot be combined with the following options. • Borderless Printing • Scaling Originals (Windows) • Banner Printing (Windows) For instructions on printing multiple pages per sheet, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Windows) (→P.281) • Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Mac OS X) (→P.283) 280 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Windows) This topic describes how to print four pages of originals together on a single sheet based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: A3 (297.0×420.0 mm [11.7×16.5 in]) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then open the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Enhanced Printing Options 281 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 8. In A Page Size, click the size of the original as specied in the application software. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 9. 10. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 11. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. 12. 13. Select the A Page Layout check box. Click 4 Pages/Sheet in the A Page Layout list. Note • You can select the layout order for placing four pages on a sheet and a frame border in the Page Layout Printing dialog box by clicking B Set. 14. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) 282 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print four pages of an original on a single sheet, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A3 (297.0 × 420.0 mm [11.7 × 16.5 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A3. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Layout pane. Enhanced Printing Options 283 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 6. Click 4 in the A Pages per Sheet list. Note • You can choose the layout order and specify a boundary line for the four pages in B Layout Direction and C Border. 7. Access the Main pane. 8. 9. 10. 11. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 12. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. 284 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 13. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 14. Make sure C Page Size shows the original size as specied in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A3. 15. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 285 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Posters in Sections You can enlarge an original to print it in sections on several sheets. By assembling the printed sheets, you can create a poster larger than the maximum supported paper size of the printer. Page Layout Choose poster printing. For instructions on printing large posters, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Large Posters (Windows) (→P.287) Note • This method of poster printing is supported in Windows. 286 Enhanced Printing Options Tiling and multiple pages per sheet Printing Large Posters (Windows) You can enlarge an original to print it in sections on several sheets. By assembling the printed sheets, you can create a poster larger than the maximum supported paper size of the printer. This topic describes how to enlarge an A2 original for printing it in sections on four sheets, based on the following example. • • • • Document: Poster Page size: A2 (420.0×594.0 mm [16.5 × 23.4 in]) Paper: Sheets Paper Size: A2 (420.0 × 594.0 mm [16.5 × 23.4 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click Poster in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Enhanced Printing Options 287 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet 7. In A Page Size, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A2. 8. 9. 10. 11. Click Manual in the L Paper Source list. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. Select the A Page Layout check box. Click Poster (2 x 2) in the A Page Layout list. Note • Follow the steps below to print only a portion of the poster as divided for printing. • Click B Set under A Page Layout to display the Pages to Print dialog box. • On the Pages to Print dialog box, clear the check boxes of the portion you do not want to print. • Click OK to close the Pages to Print dialog box. 12. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) 288 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Rolls You can print originals centered on a page-for example, if the paper is larger than the original, or if you are reducing the original. Centering originals relative to roll paper width If you use originals smaller than the roll paper width, you can center them relative to the width when printing. Print Centered Aligns the center of the original with the center of the roll, relative to the width. For instructions on centering originals when printing on rolls, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Windows) (→P.290) • Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Mac OS X) (→P.292) Enhanced Printing Options 289 Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Windows) This topic describes how to center originals before printing on rolls based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Select the print target in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 290 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals 7. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm). 10. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. 11. 12. Select the E Print Centered check box. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 291 Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to center originals before printing on rolls based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 292 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Enhanced Printing Options 293 Centering originals 11. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width -in this case, ISO A3/A4 (297.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 12. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 13. 14. Select the J Print Centered check box. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 294 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Sheets You can print originals centered on a page-for example, if the paper is larger than the original, or if you are reducing the original. Centering originals on sheets If you use paper larger than the original size or print originals after reduction, the printed images may be aligned in the upper-left corner of the paper. In this case, you can center originals on sheets when printing. Print Centered Aligns the center of the original with the center of the sheet. For instructions on centering originals when printing on sheets, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Windows) (→P.296) • Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Mac OS X) (→P.298) Enhanced Printing Options 295 Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Windows) This topic describes how to reduce an original 50% for printing centered on a sheet. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Sheets Paper type: Plain Paper Paper size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 7. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. case, click ISO A4. 296 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Select the C Enlarged/Reduced Printing check box. 13. 14. Select the E Print Centered check box. Click Match Page Size in the G Paper Size list. Click F Scaling and enter “50”. Click Manual in the L Paper Source list. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Important • If you have selected Manual as the paper source, follow the instructions on the printer control panel to enter the paper size. Enhanced Printing Options 297 Centering originals Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to center originals for printing on sheets, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 Paper: Sheets Paper type: Plain Paper Paper size: Non-standard This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4 - for Paper Tray (Large Margins). 4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 298 Enhanced Printing Options Centering originals 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 10. 11. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Click Manual in the A Paper Source list. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4 - for Paper Tray (Large Margins). Enhanced Printing Options 299 Centering originals 12. 13. Select the J Print Centered check box. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Important • If you have selected Manual as the paper source, follow the instructions on the printer control panel to enter the paper size. 300 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees You can conserve roll paper by specifying particular settings as suitable for your original. Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper) When originals are printed in portrait orientation, the original is rotated 90 degrees before printing if it ts within the roll width. This enables you to conserve paper. Important • If the page would exceed the roll paper width after rotation, use this function with Scale to t Roll Paper Width to print rotated pages. For tips on conserving roll paper, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Windows) (→P.302) • Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Mac OS X) (→P.304) Enhanced Printing Options 301 Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Windows) This topic describes how to conserve paper by rotating originals 90 degrees before printing, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3×11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) This example illustrates how to rotate an A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3×11.7 in) original in portrait orientation 90 degrees to t within the width of A3/A4 roll paper (297.0 mm [11.7 in]), which enables you to conserve paper. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then open the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 302 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper 6. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm). 9. 10. Select the K Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper) check box. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 303 Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to conserve roll paper by rotating originals 90 degrees before printing, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) This example illustrates how to rotate an A4 (210.0×297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) original in portrait orientation 90 degrees to t within the width of A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]), which enables you to conserve paper. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 304 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Access the Page Setup pane. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width -in this case, ISO A3/A4 (297.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Enhanced Printing Options 305 Conserving roll paper 10. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 11. 12. Select the L Rotate Page 90 degrees check box. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 306 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins You can conserve roll paper by specifying particular settings as suitable for your original. No Spaces at Top or Bottom (Conserve Paper) You can print without feeding the paper for blank portions of originals if there are top and bottom margins in originals. This enables you to conserve as much paper as the size of the margins. Important • Printing without the top and bottom margins is not supported in the following cases. • Banner printing • If you have chosen poster as the type of page layout Note • Even during borderless printing, you can print without the top and bottom margins. • Printing without the top and bottom margins may cause inconsistency in the size of printed documents, depending on the layout of images or text in your originals. For tips on conserving roll paper, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Windows) (→P.308) • Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Mac OS X) (→P.310) Enhanced Printing Options 307 Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Windows) This topic describes how to conserve roll paper when printing originals that have a top and bottom margin, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: Any type Page size: A4 (210.0×297.0mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 308 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper 6. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 7. 8. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A3/A4 Roll (297.0mm). 9. 10. 11. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. Select the G No Spaces at Top or Bottom (Conserve Paper) check box. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 309 Conserving roll paper Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to conserve roll paper when printing originals that have a top and bottom margin, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: Any Type Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A3/A4 roll (297.0 mm [11.7 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 310 Enhanced Printing Options Conserving roll paper 5. Access the Main pane. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Access the Page Setup pane. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width -in this case, ISO A3/A4 (297.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Enhanced Printing Options 311 Conserving roll paper 10. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 11. 12. Select the K No Spaces at Top or Bottom check box. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 312 Enhanced Printing Options Checking Images Before Printing Checking Images Before Printing Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing You can check the print layout on the preview screen. Open Preview When Print Job Starts (Windows) While viewing the preview screen, you can also adjust orientation or other settings, and your changes will be instantly applied on the preview screen. Note • Under some settings and in some environments, PageComposer may be started. Enhanced Printing Options 313 Checking Images Before Printing Preview (Macintosh) While viewing the preview screen, you can also adjust layout or size settings, and your changes will be instantly applied on the preview screen. For instructions on how to check the layout before printing, refer to the following topics: • Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows) (→P.315) • Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X) (→P.317) 314 Enhanced Printing Options Checking Images Before Printing Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows) This topic describes how to preview images of print jobs before actually printing them. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. Select the L Open Preview When Print Job Starts check box. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After you click OK, when you print a job, the imagePROGRAF Preview window will be displayed. Note • If PageComposer is running, access the Special Settings dialog box from the Layout sheet and clear Enable Preview Switching. Enhanced Printing Options 315 Checking Images Before Printing 6. 7. On the main window, you can check the layout and change settings as needed. To print, click Start Printing in the File menu. Note • For details on imagePROGRAF Preview functions, see Preview. 316 Enhanced Printing Options Checking Images Before Printing Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to check the layout before printing using the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview function. 1. 2. Choose Print in the application menu. 3. 4. 5. Select the O Print Preview check box. 6. 7. Check the layout and adjust settings in the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview window as desired. Access the Main pane. Click M Print. The Canon imagePROGRAF Preview window is displayed. Print from the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview menu. Note • For details on imagePROGRAF Preview functions, refer to Preview. Enhanced Printing Options 317 Other useful settings Other useful settings Printing With Watermarks You can add watermarks (background images) to documents that require special handling. Watermark Watermarks are applied to all pages of your document. Important • Watermarks are not printed if you select poster as the type of page layout. The following watermarks are provided: • • • • • • • • CONFIDENTIAL COPY DRAFT FILE COPY FINAL PRELIMINARY PROOF TOP SECRET You can also create your own watermarks. Specify the following options to customize your watermark. • Watermark string: Specify the font, size, color, and so on. Surround the watermark with a frame, if desired. • Watermark position: Specify the position on the page, the angle, and so on. • Watermark printing method: Specify whether to print the watermark superimposed or under the document image. You can also print the watermark only on the rst page, if desired. Note • Watermarks are supported in Windows. • In addition to the provided watermarks, you can create up to 50 original watermarks in Windows. For detailed instructions on printing with watermarks, refer to the following topics: • Printing with Watermarks-COPY, FILE COPY, and so on (Windows) (→P.319) 318 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Printing with Watermarks-COPY, FILE COPY, and so on (Windows) This topic describes how to print with watermarks, based on the following example of printing with a “FILE COPY” watermark. • • • • • Document: CAD drawing Page size: A2 (420.0×594.0 mm [16.5 × 23.4 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in[) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After conrming that D Easy Settings is selected, click CAD (Color Line Drawing) in the E Print Target list. Note • You can check the settings values selected in the E Print Target list by clicking G View Settings. Enhanced Printing Options 319 Other useful settings 6. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 7. In A Page Size, click the size of the original as specied in the application software. In this case, click ISO A2. 8. 9. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 10. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. 11. 12. Select the C Watermark check box. Click FILE COPY in the Watermarks list. Note • Click D Edit Watermark to open the Edit Watermark dialog box. In the Edit Watermark dialog box, you can create custom watermarks and change the position and angle of watermarks. 13. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) 320 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation You can specify the original orientation to match the orientation of the paper for printing. Orientation Paper is usually loaded in the printer in portrait orientation. When you have an original in landscape orientation, you can specify the printing orientation so that the original is printed in landscape orientation. Rotate 180 degrees The original is rotated 180 degrees to print it upside down. Mirror A mirror image of the original is printed. For instructions on specifying the original orientation before printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Windows) (→P.322) • Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Mac OS X) (→P.324) Enhanced Printing Options 321 Other useful settings Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Windows) This topic describes how to print an original in landscape orientation after matching the paper orientation, based on the following example. • • • • • Document: An original in landscape orientation Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm)/Letter (8.3 × 11.7 in) Paper: Roll Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. 6. 7. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then open the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 322 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings 8. In the A Page Size list, click the size of the original as specied in the application. In this case, click ISO A4 or Letter (8.5"x11"). 9. 10. 11. In H Orientation, click J Landscape. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. Select the width of the loaded roll in the M Roll Paper Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 Roll (420.0mm). 12. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 323 Other useful settings Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to print an original in landscape orientation after matching the paper orientation, based on the following example. • • • • • 1. Document: An original in landscape orientation Page size: A4 (210.0 × 297.0 mm [8.3 × 11.7 in]) Paper: Roll paper Paper type: Plain Paper Roll paper width: A2/A3 roll (420.0 mm [16.5 in]) This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. 5. Select the printer in the A Printer list. In the F Paper Size list, click the size of the original. In this case, click ISO A4. In D Orientation, click the icon of the document in landscape orientation. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 324 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings 6. Access the Main pane. 7. 8. 9. 10. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. In this case, click Plain Paper. 11. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. Make your selection in the E Print Target list. Make your selection in the F Print Quality list. Access the Page Setup pane. Enhanced Printing Options 325 Other useful settings 12. Make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in the B Roll Width list-in this case, ISO A2/A3 (420.0mm). Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. 13. Make sure the C Page Size setting matches the original size as selected in C Paper Size in the Page Attributes dialog box-in this case, ISO A4. 14. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) 326 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Using Favorites You can register print settings as “favorites” to reuse settings from a particular job that met your expectations, or settings for a particular page size that you will use repeatedly. Favorites Registering a favorite for later use. You can choose the settings you have registered from a list before printing, and you can check the settings details. Note • You can also save the favorite settings as les. Using these les is a convenient way to print under the same conditions on another computer. (In Windows.) For instructions on using favorites to print, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Using Favorites (Windows) (→P.328) • Using Favorites (Mac OS X) (→P.330) Enhanced Printing Options 327 Other useful settings Using Favorites (Windows) This topic describes how to register favorites and print using favorite settings. Registering a favorite Follow the steps below to save the current print settings as a favorite. 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. Click H Add to display the Add dialog box. 6. 7. 8. 9. Enter a desired name in Name, such as “Photos for Presentations” or “Monthly Report.” Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Complete the print settings. Click the Favorites tab to display the Favorites sheet. Choose a tting icon for these print settings in the Icon list. In Comment, enter a description of the favorite to be added, as desired. Click OK to close the Add dialog box. The favorite you have added is now displayed in A Favorites. Note • To save a favorite as a le, click J Export and specify the le to save. 328 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Printing using the favorite Follow the steps below to print using the favorite you have registered. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Favorites, choose the favorite you registered. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Click the Favorites tab to display the Favorites sheet. Note • To import a favorite, click I Import and specify the favorite le. 5. 6. Click D Apply Favorite to replace the favorite settings with the current print settings. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For instructions on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Enhanced Printing Options 329 Other useful settings Using Favorites (Mac OS X) You can use the Presets function in Mac OS X for favorite-based printing. Note • In the printing dialog box, click Save As in the Presets list to save the current print settings. This is a standard feature of the operating system. For details, refer to the Mac OS documentation. 330 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Cutting Roll Paper After Printing Roll paper can be automatically cut after printing. Note • It may not be possible to cut certain types of paper, such as adhesive paper. For details on types of paper that cannot be used with the auto cut feature, see the Paper Reference Guide (→P.95) Automatic Cutting Roll paper is cut automatically after printing. If you prefer, you can print continuously without cutting the roll, or you can print a cut line. For instructions on cutting roll paper after printing, refer to the following topics, as appropriate for your computer and operating system. • Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Windows) (→P.332) • Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Mac OS X) (→P.333) Enhanced Printing Options 331 Other useful settings Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Windows) This topic describes how to cut roll paper automatically after printing (using the auto cut function), as well as how to print a cut line for manual cutting. Note • The auto cut function is activated on the printer by default and when the printer driver is installed. Follow the steps below to reactivate the function if it is disabled, or to select the setting for printing a cut line instead. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. Click Roll Paper in the L Paper Source list. 6. To enable automatic cutting, click Yes in the A Automatic Cutting list. If you prefer to cut the Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. Click N Roll Paper Options to display the Roll Paper Options dialog box. paper later yourself, click Print Cut Guideline. 7. 8. Click OK to close the Roll Paper Options dialog box. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Roll paper will be automatically cut after printing. 332 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to cut roll paper automatically after printing (using the auto cut function), as well as how to print a cut line for manual cutting. Note • The auto cut function is activated on the printer by default and when the printer driver is installed. Follow the steps below to reactivate the function if it is disabled, or to select the setting for printing a cut line instead. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the C Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. Enhanced Printing Options 333 Other useful settings 5. Access the Page Setup pane. 6. 7. Click Roll Paper in the A Paper Source list. 8. 9. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Access the Main pane. Click C Set to display the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box. 334 Enhanced Printing Options Other useful settings 10. To enable automatic cutting, click Printer Default in the H Automatic Cutting list. If you prefer to cut the paper later yourself, click Print Cut Guideline. Important • If the automatic cut function has been deactivated on the printer, change the auto cut setting on the printer Control Panel. 11. 12. Click OK to close the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box. Conrm the print settings, and then click M Print to start printing. Note • For tips on conrming print settings, see “Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.457) Enhanced Printing Options 335 Printer Driver Windows Software Printer Driver Printer Driver Settings (Windows) For instructions on accessing the Windows printer driver, refer to the following topics. • Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Windows) (→P.346) • Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from the Operating System Menu (Windows) (→P.348) For information on the Windows printer driver settings, refer to the following topics. • Main Sheet (Windows) (→P.350) You can specify the type of paper, color processing, print quality, print preview, and other settings. Choose Easy Settings to specify basic print settings based on the printing application or Advanced Settings to complete more detailed settings as desired. • • • • • Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.354) View Settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Windows) (→P.355) Color Adjustment Sheet: Color (Windows) (→P.356) Matching Sheet (Windows) (→P.359) Color Adjustment Sheet: Monochrome (Windows) (→P.361) • Page Setup Sheet (Windows) (→P.364) You can specify the page size of the original, borderless printing, enlargement or reduction, the orientation, the paper size and feed source, and automatic cutting. • Paper Size Options Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.367) • Layout Sheet (Windows) (→P.368) You can specify the page layout, watermarks, the orientation, the number of copies, and print processing options. • Page Options Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.370) • Special Settings Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.371) 336 Windows Software Printer Driver • Favorites Sheet (Windows) (→P.372) Groups of print settings you select on each sheet can be saved as a favorite. Favorites you have added can be edited or used at the time of printing as desired. • Utility Sheet (Windows) (→P.374) You can specify settings related to maintenance for the Printhead and feed amount, as well as settings for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. • Support Sheet (Windows) (→P.375) You can view support information and the user manual. • Device Settings Sheet (Windows) (→P.377) You can display settings for optional equipment installed on the printer and see the version information for the printer driver. imagePROGRAF Free Layout is a feature for freely arranging originals from various source applications on a single page as desired before printing. For details, see Free Layout. Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy is a feature for automatic enlargement and printing of scanned originals from a Color imageRUNNER. For details, see Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. Important • Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy and imagePROGRAF Free Layout cannot be used on 64-bit version of Windows. Windows Software 337 Printer Driver Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. Important • Always specify the same type and size of paper in the printer menu and printer driver. If the type and size do not match, an error message will be displayed and printing is not possible. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. Note • Click the B Get Information button to display the Paper Information on Printer dialog box. On the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, you can obtain information on the paper in the printer and congure printer driver settings for the feed source and type of paper. 5. Click the Page Setup tab to display the Page Setup sheet. 338 Windows Software Printer Driver 6. 7. 8. In the A Page Size list, select the size of the original as specied in the application. In the L Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Roll Paper in L Paper Source, select the width of the loaded roll in M Roll Paper Width. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Windows)”. (→P.336) Windows Software 339 Printer Driver Conrming Print Settings (Windows) There are two ways to conrm the print settings, as follows. • Checking a preview of the settings • Checking a print preview Checking a preview of the settings A preview of the settings is displayed on the left side of the Main, Page Setup, and Layout sheets. By checking illustrations and numerical values in the preview, you can conrm current settings for the page size, orientation, paper source, layout, and so on. Display Area Information Displayed P Top illustrations Illustrations indicate the orientation, page layout, borderless printing selection, color mode, and other settings information. Q Middle, bordered area The page size, paper size, and method and percentage of enlargement or reduction are indicated. R Bottom illustrations Illustrations indicate the feed source, orientation, borderless printing selection, and other settings information. 340 Windows Software Printer Driver Note • To conrm the Print Target specied in Easy Settings, click G View Settings on the Main sheet to display the View Settings dialog box. Checking a print preview You can check an image of the original just as it will be printed. When you activate this feature, imagePROGRAF Preview or PageComposer is started before printing. Conrming how documents will be printed this way helps prevent printing errors. For details on print previews,see “Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing”. (→P.313) Windows Software 341 Printer Driver Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows) This topic describes how to preview images of print jobs before actually printing them. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. 5. Select the L Open Preview When Print Job Starts check box. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. After you click OK, when you print a job, the imagePROGRAF Preview window will be displayed. Note • If PageComposer is running, access the Special Settings dialog box from the Layout sheet and clear Enable Preview Switching. 342 Windows Software Printer Driver 6. 7. On the main window, you can check the layout and change settings as needed. To print, click Start Printing in the File menu. Note • For details on imagePROGRAF Preview functions, see Preview. Windows Software 343 Printer Driver Using Favorites (Windows) This topic describes how to register favorites and print using favorite settings. Registering a favorite Follow the steps below to save the current print settings as a favorite. 1. 2. 3. 4. Choose Print in the application menu. 5. Click H Add to display the Add dialog box. 6. 7. 8. 9. Enter a desired name in Name, such as “Photos for Presentations” or “Monthly Report.” Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Complete the print settings. Click the Favorites tab to display the Favorites sheet. Choose a tting icon for these print settings in the Icon list. In Comment, enter a description of the favorite to be added, as desired. Click OK to close the Add dialog box. The favorite you have added is now displayed in A Favorites. Note • To save a favorite as a le, click J Export and specify the le to save. 344 Windows Software Printer Driver Printing using the favorite Follow the steps below to print using the favorite you have registered. 1. 2. 3. Choose Print in the application menu. 4. In the A Favorites, choose the favorite you registered. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Click the Favorites tab to display the Favorites sheet. Note • To import a favorite, click I Import and specify the favorite le. 5. 6. Click D Apply Favorite to replace the favorite settings with the current print settings. Conrm the print settings and print as desired. Note • For instructions on conrming print settings,see “Conrming Print Settings (Windows)”. (→P.340) Windows Software 345 Printer Driver Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Windows) 1. 2. Choose Print from the File menu to display the dialog box for printing conditions. Select the printer, and then display the printer driver dialog box. Note • The dialog box for specifying printing conditions varies depending on the source application. In some cases, when you select the printer, a sheet for conguring the printer driver is added to the dialog box. In the following case, click Preferences. • Example: Print dialog box displayed by the application software Six sheets of print settings are displayed by the printer driver: Main, Page Setup, Layout, Favorites, Utility, and Support. Note • The titles of dialog boxes may vary depending on the application, and sheets other than these six sheets may be displayed. 346 Windows Software Printer Driver Important • If you access the printer driver dialog box from the source application, changes you make to the settings will only apply temporarily to that application. Because these are sizes you specify temporarily in the printer driver, the sizes will not be available after you exit the application. • You can also access the printer driver dialog box from the Windows system menu. To use the settings continuously in all applications, open the printer driver from the system menu to make the settings. see “Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from the Operating System Menu (Windows)”. (→P.348) Windows Software 347 Printer Driver Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from the Operating System Menu (Windows) 1. 2. Click start > Printers and Faxes (or Printers). 3. Click Printing Preferences to display the Printing Preferences dialog box, titled with the Select the printer, and then display the printer properties dialog box. name of this printer. Note • The Device Settings sheet is also an extension of the printer driver. (→P.377) 348 Windows Software Printer Driver Six sheets of print settings are displayed by the printer driver: Main, Page Setup, Layout, Favorites, Utility, and Support. Important • If you access the printer driver dialog box from the operating system menu, changes you make to the settings will apply to all applications you use for printing. • You can also access the printer driver dialog box from applications. see “Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Windows)”. (→P.346) Windows Software 349 Printer Driver Main Sheet (Windows) The following settings are available on the Main sheet. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help le. Note • On the Main sheet, choose Easy Settings to specify basic print settings based on the particular printing application, or switch to Advanced Settings to complete more detailed settings as desired. Common Items A Media Type Select the type of paper. For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) B Get Information Displays Paper Information on Printer. You can update the printer driver settings for the feed source, media type, and roll width by selecting the feed source. • Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.353) C Advanced Settings Displays Paper Detailed Settings. You can congure the printing settings to match the type of media, such as the ink drying time. • Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Windows) (→P.354) L Open Preview When Print Job Starts If you turn this on, imagePROGRAF Preview starts before printing. This allows you to check on-screen previews of documents before printing. • Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (→P.313) M Status Monitor Starts imagePROGRAF Status Monitor. You can check the printer status, job status, and other conditions. You can also set up email notication if printer errors occur by completing the Email Notice settings. For details, refer to the Status Monitor help le. 350 Windows Software Printer Driver N About Displays version information for the printer driver. S Defaults Restores all settings on the sheet to the default values. Conguration using Easy Settings E Print Target Choose presets that match the type of document to be printed. • Printing Photos and Images (→P.152) • Printing Line Drawings and Text (→P.160) • Printing Ofce Documents (→P.171) Depending on the A Media Type setting, some E Print Target options may not be available. F Print Quality Choose the level of print quality. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) G View Settings Displays the Print Target setting values. You can view and change the order of Print Target setting values. • View Settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Windows) (→P.355) Windows Software 351 Printer Driver Conguration using Advanced Settings E Print Priority Choose the graphic elements that you want to emphasize for printing. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) F Print Quality Choose the level of print quality. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) G Color Mode Choose the color mode. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) Depending on the A Media Type setting, some G Color Mode options may not be available. H Color Settings Click to display the Color Settings dialog box for more advanced color settings. • Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver (→P.177) I Thicken Fine Lines Activate this option to print ne lines more distinctly. J Unidirectional Printing Select this checkbox to prevent problems such as misaligned lines and improve the print quality. However, the printing speed becomes slower. K Sharpen Text Activate this option to print text more sharply. T Economy Printing Select this checkbox to reduce the amount of ink consumed during printing. However, the print quality is worse than for normal printing. Select this mode if you want to conserve ink when checking drawings, for example. Depending on the A Media Type and F Print Quality settings, this mode may not be available. 352 Windows Software Printer Driver Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Windows) On the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, you can obtain information on the paper in the printer and congure printer driver settings for the paper source and media type. Note • To display the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, on the Main sheet, click Get Information by Media Type. (→P.350) A Paper Source Shows the Paper Source supported by the printer, as well as information about the loaded paper. To update the Paper Source and media type settings in the printer driver, select the desired Paper Source option and click OK. Windows Software 353 Printer Driver Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Windows) The Paper Detailed Settings dialog box offers the following settings. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. Note • To display the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box, on the Main sheet, click Settings by Media Type. (→P.350) A Drying Time Specify the time that the printer waits for ink to dry, as needed. The Drying Time setting is only valid for rolls. • (→P.127) B Between Pages Specify the time the printer waits after printing a page until ejecting the paper, as needed. C Between Scans Specify the time the printer waits after printing a line on the page until printing the next line, as needed. D Roll Paper Margin for Safety You can specify the length of a margin on the leading edge of paper to ensure that paper susceptible to curling is held rmly against the Platen. E Near End Margin Specify the length of the Near End Margin (the leading edge margin) of the roll, as needed. F Cut Speed Select the speed of automatic cutting, as needed. You can adjust this setting if paper is not cut well when automatic cutting is used. G Mirror Specify whether to print a mirror image, as needed. Select this option to print a version of the document or image with the left and right sides inverted. 354 Windows Software Printer Driver View Settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Windows) In the View Settings dialog box, you can check details of the selected printing application. Note • To display the View Settings dialog box, on the Main sheet, click View Settings by Print Target. (→P.350) A Print Target Shows all Print Target options (settings items for the printing application). B Name Identies the item selected in Print Target by its name and an icon. C Details Here, you can conrm detailed settings values for each listed item for the selected Print Target. Windows Software 355 Printer Driver Color Adjustment Sheet: Color (Windows) If the color tone as printed is not as you expected, you can adjust it on the Color Adjustment sheet. Note • To display the Color Adjustment sheet, on the Main sheet, click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings. (→P.350) A Sample Type Choose a sample image from Standard, Portrait, Landscape, or Graphics. B View Color Pattern Select this checkbox to display the color pattern. C Apply to Sample Select this checkbox to apply the changed settings to the sample image. D Cyan / E Magenta / F Yellow Fine-tune color tones by adjusting the levels of each color. G Gray Tone Adjust the color tone of grays as desired. Choose Cool Black (tinged with blue) or Warm Black (tinged with red). H Brightness Adjust the overall image brightness as desired. You can adjust the brightness if the printed document is lighter or darker than the original image (that is, the original photo that was scanned or the original graphic as it appears on the computer screen). I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other, as desired. Increasing the Contrast makes images sharper, and reducing the Contrast softens images. 356 Windows Software Printer Driver Saturation Adjust the color intensity as desired. Increasing the Saturation setting makes colors more vivid, and reducing the Saturation makes colors more subdued. K Object Adjustment Select this option to display the Object Adjustment dialog box, in which you can specify objects subject to color adjustment. S Defaults Click to restore all settings on the sheet to the default values. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) Windows Software 357 Printer Driver Object Adjustment dialog box: Color In the Object Adjustment dialog box, you can specify what type of print jobs to apply color adjustment to. If an original comprises images, graphics, and text, you can specify which portion to apply color adjustment to. Note • To display the Object Adjustment dialog box, click Object Adjustment on the Color Adjustment sheet. A Image Select this option to apply color adjustment to image areas, such as photos. B Graphics Select this option to apply color adjustment to graphics, such as lines and circles. C Text Select this option to apply color adjustment to text. 358 Windows Software Printer Driver Matching Sheet (Windows) On the Matching sheet, you can specify color matching to compensate for differences in the appearance of colors on various devices. Driver Matching Mode The following options are available when you select Driver Matching Mode in the A Matching Mode list. Note • To display the Matching sheet, on the Main sheet, click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings, and then click the Matching sheet. (→P.350) A Matching Mode Select the color matching mode to use, as desired. Normally, select Driver Matching Mode. For color matching based on ICC proles, select ICC Matching Mode, Driver ICM Mode, or Host ICM Mode, depending on your color matching system. If you prefer not to use the printer driver for color matching, select No. B Matching Method Select the color matching method that suits the document to be printed. Various Matching Method options are available depending on your selection in Matching Mode. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) Windows Software 359 Printer Driver ICC Matching Mode, Driver ICM Mode and Host ICM Mode On the Matching sheet, you can specify color matching to compensate for differences in the appearance of colors on various devices. The following options are available when you select ICC Matching Mode, Driver ICM Mode, or Host ICM Mode on the A Matching Mode sheet. Note • To display the Matching sheet, on the Main sheet, click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings, and then click the Matching sheet. (→P.350) A Matching Mode Select the color matching mode to use, as desired. B Input Prole Settings You can select Image, Graphics, or Text. You can choose Matching Method and Input Prole. Various options are available depending on your selected Matching Mode. To apply the same input prole automatically for Graphics and Text, select Use the Same Prole for All Objects. To apply separate input proles to Graphics and Text, clear Use the Same Prole for All Objects and specify the individual settings. C Printer Prole Settings Specify the printer prole as desired. Normally, select Auto Settings. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) 360 Windows Software Printer Driver Color Adjustment Sheet: Monochrome (Windows) On the Color Adjustment sheet for monochrome printing, you can adjust the brightness and contrast. Note • To display the Color Adjustment sheet, on the Main sheet, click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings. (→P.350) A Sample Type Choose a sample image from Standard, Portrait, Landscape, or Graphics. B View Color Pattern Select this checkbox to display the color pattern. C Apply to Sample Select this checkbox to apply the changed settings to the sample image. D Cyan / E Magenta / F Yellow Not available. G Gray Tone Not available. H Brightness Adjust the overall image brightness as desired. You can adjust the brightness if the printed document is lighter or darker than the original image (that is, the original photo that was scanned or the original graphic as it appears on the computer screen). I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other, as desired. Increasing the Contrast makes images sharper, and reducing the Contrast softens images. Windows Software 361 Printer Driver J Saturation Not available. K Object Adjustment Select this option to display the K Object Adjustment dialog box, in which you can specify objects subject to color adjustment. S Defaults Click to restore all settings on the sheet to the default values. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) 362 Windows Software Printer Driver Object Adjustment dialog box: Monochrome In the Object Adjustment dialog box, you can specify what type of print jobs to apply color adjustment to. If an original comprises images, graphics, and text, you can specify which portion to apply color adjustment to. Note • To display the Object Adjustment dialog box, click Object Adjustment on the Color Adjustment sheet. A Image Select this option to apply color adjustment to image areas, such as photos. B Graphics Select this option to apply color adjustment to graphics, such as lines and circles. C Text Select this option to apply color adjustment to text. Windows Software 363 Printer Driver Page Setup Sheet (Windows) The following settings are available on the Page Setup sheet. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help le. A Page Size Select the page size as specied in the source application. For details on available page sizes,see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) B Borderless Printing Borderless printing is available if Roll Paper is selected in the L Paper Source list. Choose from the following options when this setting is activated. • Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size (→P.232) • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.239) • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (→P.225) D Fit Paper Size Scales the document image to match the paper size. E Scale to t Roll Paper Width Scales the document image to match the roll width. F Print Image with Actual Size Prints documents at their actual size. This function is available when you have selected the size same as the width of Roll Paper for either the length or width of the document from the A Page Size list. G Paper Size Available when D Fit Paper Size is selected. Choose the size of the paper you will print on. For details on available paper sizes,see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) Paper sizes compatible with borderless printing are shown in the list. 364 Windows Software Printer Driver C Enlarged/Reduced Printing Choose from the following options when this setting is activated. • Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (→P.201) • Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.207) • Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (→P.213) D Fit Paper Size Scales the document image to match the paper size. E Fit Roll Paper Width Scales the document image to match the roll width. F Scaling Resizes the document image based on a specied scaling value. Enter a value in a range of “5-600.” G Paper Size Choose the size of the paper you will print on. For details on available paper sizes,see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) H Orientation Choose the printing orientation. • Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (→P.321) K Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper) Activate this setting to rotate the document image by 90 degrees before printing. • Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (→P.301) L Paper Source Choose the feed source, as desired. Options displayed in the list vary depending on the selection in Media Type on the Main sheet. M Roll Paper Width Choose the roll width. For details on available roll widths,see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) N Roll Paper Options Complete optional roll paper settings. Click to display the Roll Paper Options dialog box. Under A Automatic Cutting, you can specify Yes or No and Print Cut Guideline. • Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (→P.331) Select B Banner Printing when printing multiple pages continuously. • Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (→P.275) Windows Software 365 Printer Driver P Output Method Click to display the Output Method dialog box, which enables you to complete the Output Method and Name of data to be saved settings. O Size Options Click to display the Paper Size Options dialog box, which enables you to register additional paper sizes or select the size system for use. S Defaults Restores all settings on the sheet to the default values. 366 Windows Software Printer Driver Paper Size Options Dialog Box (Windows) In the Paper Size Options dialog box, you can create and register your own Custom Paper Size. The sizes you dene are listed with standard paper sizes for selection later as needed. Note • To display the Paper Size Options dialog box, on the Page Setup sheet, click Paper Size Options. (→P.364) A Paper Size List Shows the names and sizes of paper that can be used with the printer driver. B Delete Custom paper sizes created by users can be deleted from the A Paper Size List, as needed. However, they cannot be deleted in the following situations. • If a standard paper size of the printer driver is selected. • If an oversized paper size is selected. • If a paper size in a red box is selected. C Custom Paper Size Name You can name Custom Paper Size as desired. D Units Specify the desired unit of measure for the Custom Paper Size height and width. E Paper Size Specify the desired Width and Height. You can make your selection from sizes that are compatible with Borderless Printing by selecting Borderless Printing Size. To maintain the aspect ratio of the Width and Height as you resize the paper, select Fix the Ratio of the Width to Height. F Add Enables you to register the custom paper size you have specied or overwrite an existing custom paper size. Windows Software 367 Printer Driver Layout Sheet (Windows) The following settings are available on the Layout sheet. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. A Page Layout Activate this setting to select a particular page layout. • • • • Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (→P.280) Printing Posters in Sections (→P.286) Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (→P.269) Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals (→P.450) B Set Click to display one of the following dialog boxes depending on the selection in A Page Layout. In these dialog boxes, you can specify layout details and which pages to print, as well as other settings. • Page Layout Printing • Pages to Print • Free Layout Settings C Watermark Activating this option makes two settings available, Watermarks and D Edit Watermark. • Printing With Watermarks (→P.318) Watermarks Lists the provided watermarks. Choose the watermark to print. D Edit Watermark Click to display the Edit Watermark dialog box for creating your own, original watermark. E Print Centered Activate this setting to print document images in the center of the paper. • Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (→P.289) • Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (→P.295) F Rotate 180 degrees Activate this option to rotate document images by 180 degrees before printing. 368 Windows Software Printer Driver G No Spaces at Top or Bottom (Conserve Paper) Activate this setting to print the next image skipping blank areas above and below printable data in documents, which enables you to conserve the paper. • Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (→P.307) H Copies Enter the number of copies to print, in a range of “1-999.” Reverse Order Activate this option to print pages in reverse order. I Page Options Click to display the Page Options dialog box, which enables you to complete settings for printing the user name, date, or page number in the header or footer. J Special Settings If the printing results are not as you expected, click this option to change how printing is processed. S Defaults Click to restore all settings on the sheet to the default values. Windows Software 369 Printer Driver Page Options Dialog Box (Windows) The Page Options dialog box offers the following settings. Note • To display the Page Options dialog box, on the Layout sheet, click Page Options. (→P.368) A Print Date Select where the date is printed, as desired. To print the time as well, select B Print Time Also. C Print User Name Select where the user name is printed, as desired. D Print Page Number Select where the page number is printed, as desired. E Format Settings Click to display the Format Settings dialog box, which enables you to complete format-related settings. Note • If you specify the same position for multiple items, the items are printed from left to right in this order: date, user name, and page number. • When you print multiple pages per sheet using Page Layout Printing or similar functions, these items will be printed for each page. 370 Windows Software Printer Driver Special Settings Dialog Box (Windows) If the printing results are not as you expected, you can change how printing is processed in the Special Settings dialog box. Note • To display the Special Settings dialog box, on the Layout sheet, click Special Settings. (→P.368) A FineZoom Settings This function is used in large-format printing. Normally, choose Auto. If documents are not printed correctly on large-format paper, it may help to select Yes, and if ne lines are not visible or if images are distorted when printed, it may help to select No. B Application Color Matching Priority You can give applications priority in color management. C Enable Preview Switching When this option is selected, PageComposer starts if you print with Open Preview When Print Job Starts selected on the Main sheet. D Fast Graphic Process If image colors are inconsistent in printed documents or if lines are printed in varying thicknesses, clearing this option may help produce the expected results. Important • This function cannot be used on 64-bit version of Windows. E Reduce Print Unevenness If you are concerned about print unevenness, the printing results can be improved by selecting this option. However, printing may take longer for some images. F Adjust faint lines If ne lines are printed in colors that do not match the colors of other shapes, clearing this option may help produce the expected results. However, lines in some colors may appear broken. Windows Software 371 Printer Driver Favorites Sheet (Windows) The following settings are available on the Favorites sheet. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. A Favorites Printing favorites you have created are listed with Default Settings favorites. • Using Favorites (→P.327) B Settings Details Displays details of the favorite selected in the A Favorites. C Comment Displays notes registered in the favorite. D Apply Favorite Click to change the current print settings to those of the favorite selected in the A Favorites. E Application Settings Priority Activate this setting to use settings values specied in the source application in preference to favorite settings selected in the A Favorites, when clicking D Apply Favorite. For details on the settings items used in preference, refer to the printer driver help. F Delete Click to delete the selected favorite from the A Favorites list. G Edit Click to display the Edit dialog box, which enables you to change the name and icon for the favorite selected in the A Favorites list. 372 Windows Software Printer Driver H Add Click to display the Add dialog box, which enables you to add the current print settings as a favorite. I Import Click to display the Open dialog box, which enables you to import favorite settings saved as a le. J Export Click to display the Save As dialog box, which enables you to save the favorite settings as a le. K Up Click to move the selected favorite up in the A Favorites list. L Down Click to move the selected favorite down in the A Favorites list. Windows Software 373 Printer Driver Utility Sheet (Windows) The following items can be executed on the Utility sheet. For details on the utilities, refer to the relevant utility help. A Maintenance Click to start the imagePROGRAF Status Monitor, which offers the following maintenance for the printer. • • • • Nozzle (ink ejecting outlet) check Nozzle (ink ejecting outlet) cleaning Head alignment adjustment Feed amount adjustment B Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Click to launch Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy (*1) (iR enlargement copy), which enables you to create hot folders used for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy and assign print settings to hot folders. • Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows) (→P.432) *1: For details, see Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. 374 Windows Software Printer Driver Support Sheet (Windows) On the Support sheet, you can view support information and the user’s manual. A Support Information Click to access the Canon support webpage, where you can nd the latest information on the printer and consumables, check for printer driver updates, and browse other information. B User Manual Click to view the printer user’s manual. This function requires the user’s manual to be installed on your computer. C Settings Summaries Click to display the View Settings dialog box, which enables you to conrm the settings for the Main, Page Setup, Layout, and Favorites sheets. Windows Software 375 Printer Driver Settings Summaries Dialog Box (Windows) The Settings Summaries dialog box enables you to conrm the settings for the Main, Page Setup, Layout, and Favorites sheets. A Copy Click to copy the settings information to the clipboard. You can paste the settings information into a le created with a text editor or similar application. 376 Windows Software Printer Driver Device Settings Sheet (Windows) Many settings items on the printer properties sheets are controlled by Windows applications. However, the Device Settings sheet is for conguring the printer, and it is an extension of the printer driver. The following settings are available on the Device Settings sheet. A Color Compatibility Click to display the Color Compatibility dialog box, which enables you to adjust colors if you have selected Color Mode > Color (CAD). • For details on color settings, see Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings. (→P.167) B About You can display version information for the printer driver. Windows Software 377 Preview Preview The Features of Preview The main features of Preview are as follows. • While viewing this screen, you can adjust layout settings of a document created with application software. • You can not only adjust layout settings but also your changes will be instantly applied on the preview screen, and you can print the preview screen as it is seen. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Preview settings. Operating Environment You can use the Preview in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/Server 2008 • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver 378 Windows Software Preview Starting Preview Follow the procedure below to start the Preview. 1. 2. Start the apllication software which you use. From the application software’s File menu, select the printer setup menu to open the Print dialog box. Note • Normally, select Print from the File menu. 3. On the Main sheet, click on the Open Preview When Print Job Starts check box. Click the OK button to save the settings. 4. 5. On the Print dialog box in the apllication software, click the Print button. Preview main window is displayed. Windows Software 379 Preview Preview Main Window The Preview main window consists of the menu and tool bars, preview and dialog area and status bar. Note • You can use the View menu to show or hide the tool bar. Menu Bar This allows you to select menus required for operations. Tool Bar This allows you to select tool buttons required for major operations. 380 Windows Software Preview Preview Area You can check the settings you made in this area. Dialog Area This allows you to set the print conditions and perform a print job. For more information about Dialog Area, see “Dialog Area”. (→P.382) Status Bar This shows the message, Pages and Output Size. Windows Software 381 Preview Dialog Area You can select the layout and print on the center. Media Type / Paper Source /Paper Size You can conrm the information that is set. Layout Selection You can print which conserves paper by selecting the layout. For more information about Layout Selection, see “Printing with Selecting the Layout”. (→P.387) Center Originals Across Roll You can print on the center of the media loaded in the printer. For more information about Center Originals Across Roll, see “Print on the Center”. (→P.384) Note • You cannot select this if Cut Sheet is selected in Paper Source. “No Spaces at Top or Bottom” You can save paper on not to feed roll paper for the empty spaces when the print data contains spaces at the top or bottom. For more information about “No Spaces at Top or Bottom”, see “Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom”. (→P.385) Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. “Print” Button Click the button to start printing. “Cancel” Button Click the button to stop printing. 382 Windows Software Preview Printer Information You can conrm the information acquired from the printer. Update Printer Information Button Click the button to update the printer information with connecting to the printer. Status Monitor Button Click the button to start Status Monitor. Windows Software 383 Preview Print on the Center You can print on the center of the media loaded in the printer. 1. Click the Center Originals Across Roll check box on. 2. Click the “Print” button Printing on the center begins. Note • You cannot select this if Cut Sheet is selected in Paper Source. 384 Windows Software Preview Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom You can save paper on not to feed roll paper for the empty spaces when the print data contains spaces at the top or bottom. 1. Click the “No Spaces at Top or Bottom” check box on. 2. Click the “Print” button. Printing on the settings with no spaces at top or bottom begins. Windows Software 385 Preview Priority setting for rotating 90 degrees You can select Rotate 90 Degrees If Possible or Use Driver Settings from the Options menu. Setting Details Rotate 90 Degrees If Possible Rotates pages in portrait orientation 90 degrees before printing. Pages are only rotated if they can t lengthwise across the roll. Use Driver Settings Follows printer driver settings when determining whether to rotate pages. Selecting Rotate 90 Degrees If Possible or Placing a checkmark for Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper) on the printer driver Selecting Use Driver Settings 386 Windows Software Preview Printing with Selecting the Layout You can print which conserves paper by selecting the layout. 1. In Layout Selection, click the layout button to use. Button Details Upper Button Turn at the position of . Turn at the position of . Turn at the position of . Turn at the position of . Right Button Left Button Lower Button Windows Software 387 Preview Note • Right Button or Left Button can be selected only when the rotated pages can t lengthwise across the roll. • By clicking Right Button or Left Button, you can save paper by printing in landscape orientation on roll paper. • You can select only Upper Button or Lower Button if Cut Sheet is selected. Button Details The button is selected currently. The button can be selected. The button can not be selected. 2. Click the Start Printing button. Printing on the selected layout begins. 388 Windows Software Preview Enlarge/Reduce the screen display You can enlarge or reduce the screen display when you select Zoom from the View menu. Setting Details Fit Screen Display all. Fit to Width Display to the width of the paper. Reduce Display at half of the standard size. Standard Display at the standard size. Enlarge Display with the double of the standard size. Enlarge More Display with the triple of the standard size. Note • You can also select the setting by clicking the ▼ button on the tool bar. Moving a Page You can move a page to display when you select Go to Page from the View menu. Setting Details First Page Go to the rst page. Previous Page Go to the previous page. Next Page Go to the next page. Last Page Go to the last page. Go to Page Go to the specied page. Note • You can also move a page by clicking on the tool bar. Using the ruler You can conrm the layout with using the ruler. • Switching the ruler Show/Hide In the View menu, select Ruler to switch the ruler Show/Hide. • Changing the ruler unit You can set the ruler unit when you select Units from the View menu. Setting Details mm Use mm as the ruler unit. inch Use inches as the ruler unit. Windows Software 389 Free Layout Free Layout The Features of Free Layout The main features of Free Layout are as follows. • Allows you to lay out at will and print a document created with application software. • You can not only lay out multiple pages on one page but also lay out and print a multiple-le document on one page, or lay out and print a document created with multiple application programs on one page. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Free Layout settings. Operating Environment You can use the Free Layout in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/Server 2008 • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver Note • This function is not available on 64-bit version of Windows. 390 Windows Software Free Layout Starting Free Layout Follow the procedure below to start the Free Layout. 1. 2. Start the apllication software which you use. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 3. From the list, select the printer and select the “Layout” sheet. Note • Your printer is depicted in the lower-left area of this screen. 4. In the “Layout” sheet, click on the “Page Layout” check box and select “Free Layout” from the list. Click the “OK” button to save the settings. Note • When you select “Free Layout”, all other setting items will be disabled. Windows Software 391 Free Layout 5. On the Print dialog box in the apllication software, click the Print button. Free Layout main window is displayed. 392 Windows Software Free Layout Free Layout Main Window The Free Layout main window consists of the menu and tool bars, layout area and status bar. Note • You can use the “View” menu to show or hide the tool and status bar. Menu Bar This allows you to select menus required for operations. Tool Bar This allows you to select tool buttons required for major operations. Layout Area This allows you to lay out objects and edit the object size and orientation. Windows Software 393 Free Layout Status Bar This shows the paper size, unit of length, and number of objects. Detailed Settings The printer driver opens when you select “Detailed Settings” from the “File” menu. The printer driver is used to congure basic settings to match the type of media loaded in the printer. Refer to Printer Driver for details on the printer driver. Note • When you select the “Detailed Settings”, the only three sheets displayed are the “Main” sheet, the “Page Setup” sheet, and the “Layout” sheet. Some of the printer driver settings may be disabled. 394 Windows Software Free Layout Preferences Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Preferences” from the “File” menu. This allows you to congure the preferences of Free Layout. “Units” Set the unit for paper length, margins, and so on. “Gridlines” You can input a grid line width value in numerical characters so that they serve as a guide to laying out objects. Note • You can input between 10.0 and 200.0(mm) (between 0.39 and 7.88(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Divisions” You can change the number of divisions of grid lines so that they serve as a guide to laying out objects. Note • You can input between 1 and 10. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Grid Color” Select the grid line color. Auto Arrange Spacing Change the object-to-object spacing to be applied in the operation of laying out objects automatically. Note • You can input between 0.0 and 100.0(mm) (between 0.00 and 3.94(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. Windows Software 395 Free Layout “Object Frame Style” You can select the object frame style for printing. The following settings are available for the object frame style. Setting Details “None” You can print with no frame style. “Solid Line” You can print the solid line as the frame style. “Dotted Line” You can print the dotted line as the frame style. “Dashed Line” You can print the dashed line as the frame style. “Crop Marks” You can print with the crop marks. 396 Windows Software Free Layout Page Options Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Page Options” from the “File” menu. This allows you to congure the roll paper length, object layout order, and margins of Free Layout. “Roll Paper Length” Set the length of one page to print on roll paper. The following settings are available for roll paper length. Setting Details “Auto Settings” The one-page length to be printed on roll paper is automatically set so that the laid-out objects are printed on one page. “Manual Settings” You can input the length of one page to print on roll paper in numerical characters. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. • You can input between 203.2 and 18000.0(mm) (between 8.00 and 708.66(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Order” Set the object layout order. The following settings are available for order. Setting Details “Upper Left to Right” The objects are laid out from upper left to right. “Upper Left to Bottom” The objects are laid out from upper left to bottom. “Upper Right to Left” The objects are laid out from upper right to left. “Lower Left to Top” The objects are laid out from lower left to top. Note • When you have selected “Roll Paper Length” > “Auto Settings” and “Paper Orientation” > “Vertical”, you can choose “Upper Left to Right” or “Upper Right to Left”. • When you have selected “Roll Paper Length” > “Auto Settings” and “Paper Orientation” > “Horizontal”, you can choose “Upper Left to Bottom” or “Lower Left to Top”. Windows Software 397 Free Layout “Margins” You can input the paper margins in numerical characters. Note • You can input between 0.0 and 50.0(mm) (between 0.00 and 1.97(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. Zoom Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Zoom” from the “View” menu. You can enlarge or reduce the screen display. Scaling Set the magnication for enlargement or reduction of the screen display. Note • You can input between 25 and 400. • You can change the numbers by clicking “▼” button. 398 Windows Software Free Layout Format Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Format” from the “Object” menu after you select an object. “Size” Sheet You can rotate, enlarge, or reduce an object. Note • When the objects are not selected, you can not select “Format”. “Rotate” When you place a checkmark here, you can select “Rotate Right” or “Rotate Left”. Setting Details “Rotate Right” Rotates the object 90 degrees clockwise. “Rotate Left” Rotates the object 90 degrees counterclockwise. Note • When several objects are selected, you cannot select “Rotate”. “Enl./Red.” When you place a checkmark here, you can select “Scaling”, “Fit Paper Size”, or “Fit Photo Size”. Setting Details “Scaling” Allows you to input the value of the enlargement or reduction ratio of an object. “Fit Paper Size” Prints by enlarging or reducing each object to match the paper size. If you are using roll paper, objects are enlarged or reduced so that the width of each object matches the width of the roll paper. “Fit Photo Size” Prints all of the objects at the specied photo size. Note • You can input between 25 and 600. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. Windows Software 399 Free Layout “Position” Sheet You can rotate, enlarge, or reduce an object. Note • When the objects are not selected, you can not select “Format”. “Object Position” You can move the object position by changing the values. Setting Details “Vertical Pos” You can input the number of the vertical position in numerical characters. “Horizontal Pos” You can input the number of the horizontal position in numerical characters. “Page Pos” You can input the number of the page position in numerical characters. “Object Size” You can conrm the object size. Note • When several objects are selected, you cannot display “Object Size”. 400 Windows Software Free Layout Laying out a Multiple-File Document on One Page You can lay out and print a multiple-le document on one page. 1. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 2. Click “Properties” to open the “Properties” dialog box. 3. In the “Page Setup” sheet, select Paper Source. Windows Software 401 Free Layout 4. In the “Layout” sheet, click on the “Page Layout” check box and select “Free Layout” from the list. Note • When you select “Free Layout”, all other setting items will be disabled. 5. 6. Click the “OK” button to save the settings. In the “Print” dialog box, select the pages to print and the number of copies, and click the “OK” button. 402 Windows Software Free Layout Free Layout starts, laying out the document created with application software in the layout area as an object. 7. Leaving Free Layout running, open other les with the application software and repeat the above steps. Windows Software 403 Free Layout Laying out a Document Created with Multiple Application Programs on One Page You can lay out and print a document created with multiple application programs on one page. 1. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 2. Click “Properties” to open the “Properties” dialog box. 3. In the “Page Setup” sheet, select Paper Source. 404 Windows Software Free Layout 4. In the “Layout” sheet, click on the “Page Layout” check box and select “Free Layout” from the list. Note • When you select “Free Layout”, all other setting items will be disabled. 5. 6. Click the “OK” button to save the settings. In the “Print” dialog box, select the pages to print and the number of copies, and click the “OK” button. Windows Software 405 Free Layout Free Layout starts, laying out the document created with application software in the layout area as an object. 7. Leaving Free Layout running, open other les with other application software and repeat the above steps. 406 Windows Software Free Layout Selecting an Object When an object is selected, a select box (blue border) appears around the object. Note • • • • To select an object, click that object. To select multiple successive objects, click them while holding down the Shift key. To select multiple arbitrary objects, click them while holding down the Ctrl key. To select all objects, select “Select All” from the “Edit” menu. When you specify the area with dragging the mouse, the object in the area is selected. Windows Software 407 Free Layout Changing the Object Size You can change the object size by means of mouse operation or by specifying a scaling value. Note • The vertical-to-horizontal ratio remains unchanged when the object is enlarged or reduced. Resizing by means of mouse operation 1. 2. Select an object. Place the pointer at a corner of the selection box around the object to show the arrow handle, and drag this handle to change the object size. Resizing by specifying a scaling value 1. Select an object. Click on the “Enl./Red.” checkbox in the Format Dialog Box (→P.399) and select “Scaling”. 2. You either enter numbers directly. Note • You can input between 25 and 600. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. 3. Click the “OK” button. 408 Windows Software Free Layout Moving an Object You can move the object position. 1. 2. Select an object. Place the pointer inside the selection box of the object to show the crosshair handle, and drag it to move the object. Alternatively, you can move the “Object Position” by changing the values in “Vertical Pos”, “Horizontal Pos” and “Page Pos” in the Format Dialog Box. (→P.399) Rotating an Object You can rotate the object. 1. 2. Select an object. Select “Rotate Left 90 Degrees” or “Rotate Right 90 Degrees” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may click on the “Rotate” check box in the Format Dialog Box (→P.399) then select “Rotate Right” or “Rotate Left”, and click the “OK” button. Windows Software 409 Free Layout Laying out Objects Automatically Click “Auto Arrange Object” in the tool bar. This automatically lays out objects. Alternatively, you may select “Auto Arrange Object” from the “Object” menu. Note • The object layout order varies depending on the “Order” setting in the Page Options Dialog Box (→P.397) dialog box. 410 Windows Software Free Layout Aligning Objects You can align objects systematically. 1. 2. Select multiple objects. Click the align button from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may select the align menu from the “Object” menu. “Align Top” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the top. “Center Vertically” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the vertical center. “Align Bottom” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the bottom. Windows Software 411 Free Layout “Align Left” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the left. “Center Horizontally” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the horizontal center. “Align Right” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the right. 412 Windows Software Free Layout Changing the Object Overlapping Order You can change the object overlapping order. 1. 2. Select an object. Select the Overlapping Order menu from the “Object” menu. Note • The order of overlapping affects the order of objects automatically laid out. • You can also select by clicking the right button of the mouse on an object. “Bring to Front” Moves the object to the frontmost position. “Send to Back” Moves the object to the backmost position. “Bring Forward” Moves the object one position to the front. Windows Software 413 Free Layout “Send Backward” Moves the object one position to the back. 414 Windows Software Free Layout Pasting a Copied or Cut Object 1. Click “Copy” or “Cut” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may select “Copy” or “Cut” from the “Edit” menu. 2. Click “Paste” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may select “Paste” from the “Edit” menu. Note • The copied or cut object is laid out at the end of the page. • You can also select by clicking the right button of the mouse on an object. • In order to paste an object on any position that you like, you can paste the object with “Pointed Paste” by clicking the right button of the mouse on any position that you want. Windows Software 415 Free Layout Folded Duplex Window This window is displayed if you select “Folded Duplex” from the “Edit” menu after selecting an object. Using the “Folded Duplex” function allows you to print with fold lines added. The Folded Duplex window consists of the menu and tool bars, layout area and status bar. Note • The toolbar and status bar can be toggled between hidden and displayed from the “View” menu. Menu Bar This allows you to select menus required for operations. Tool Bar This allows you to select tool buttons required for major operations. 416 Windows Software Free Layout Layout Area This allows you to check the arrangement and orientation of objects. Status Bar This shows the paper source, roll paper width, and output size. Windows Software 417 Free Layout Prints using Folded Duplex Allows you to produce duplex printing by combining two pages and folding them. “Folded Duplex” Any two pages can be arranged and printed in a layout that becomes duplex on folding. This can be used such as for advertising posters that are suspended from the ceiling. 1. 2. Select two objects from the layout area of Free Layout. Select Folded Duplex from the “Edit” menu of Free Layout. Open the Folded Duplex window and arrange the selected objects in the layout area. 3. 4. Open the “Finished Size Settings” dialog box from the “Edit” menu. Select “Fit Roll Paper Width” or “Specify Folded Size” in “Finished Size”. Note • “Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper)” is also available when “Specify Folded Size” is selected. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Click “OK” to save the settings. Open the “Binding Settings” dialog box from the “Edit” menu. Select “Bottom” or “Top” in “Binding Edge”. Specify the “Binding” width in “Binding”. Congure the Fold Line Color and Fold Line Type from Print Fold Lines. Note • When the Only Print Center and Edges checkbox is selected, fold lines are only printed at the three locations of the center and both edges. 10. 11. Click “OK” to save the settings. Conrm the print setting and begin printing. 418 Windows Software Free Layout Finished Size Settings Dialog Box This dialog box is displayed when you select “Finished Size Settings” from the “Edit” menu. This allows you to congure nished size settings. “Finished Size” Selects the method for setting the nished size. The following settings are available for the nished size. Setting Details “Fit Roll Paper Width” Prints by automatically enlarging or reducing the entire document so that the width of the document matches the roll paper width. “Specify Folded Size” Prints by automatically enlarging or reducing the entire document to match the size of the paper. Select the actual size of the paper you want to print on in “Fit Paper Size”. “Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper)” Prints by rotating pages by 90 degrees. Pages are automatically rotated if they will t within the roll paper width when rotated, and are not rotated if they will not t within the roll paper width. Windows Software 419 Free Layout Binding Settings Dialog Box This is displayed when you select “Binding Settings” from the “Edit” menu. This allows you to congure the binding edge settings. “Binding Edge” Congures the binding edge when folding paper. The following settings are available for the binding edge. Setting Details “Bottom” Prints by placing the binding margin (gutter) at the bottom of the document. “Top” Prints by placing the binding margin (gutter) at the top of the document. “Binding” Congures the binding margin (gutter). Prints by creating a binding margin (gutter) of the specied size. Enter the margin size as a number. Note • The values that can be entered are 0 to 50 (mm). “Print Fold Lines” Congures the color and type of fold lines. Note • To not print fold lines, clear the “Print Fold Lines” checkbox. “Fold Line Color” You can select the fold lines. “Fold Line Type” You can select the fold lines. The following settings are available for the fold line type. Setting Details “Solid Line” You can print the solid line as the frame style. “Dotted Line” You can print the dotted line as the frame style. “Dashed Line” You can print the dashed line as the frame style. “Only Print Center and Edges” To print fold lines at the center and both edges, select the Only Print Center and Edges checkbox. 420 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy The Features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy The main features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy are as follows. • Allows the document scanned with the Color imageRUNNER to be automatically enlarged and printed. • You can perform basic printer settings such as printer selection, media type and output prole selection, and matching methods, in addition to borderless printing and enlargement/reduction process without growing through the printer driver. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy settings. Operating Environment You can use the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Windows 2000/XP/Server 2003/Vista/Server 2008 • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver Note • This function is not available on 64-bit version of Windows. Windows Software 421 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Follow the procedure below to start the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. To start by selecting “Printers and Faxes” from the “start” button 1. From the Windows “start” button, select “Printers and Faxes” to open the “Printers and Faxes” dialog box. 2. Right-click the Printers icon and select “Print Settings” to open the “Printing Preferences” dialog box. In the “Utility” sheet, click the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” button. 3. The “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box displays. Note • If you click on the “Add to Startup folder” check box in the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, the icon of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility will appear on the task bar when starting Windows thereafter. 422 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy To start by selecting “imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” from the “start” button 1. From the Windows “start” button, select “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. 2. The “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box displays. Windows Software 423 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Dialog Box The explanation below is on the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. Note • For the step to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, see “Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. (→P.422) “Hot Folder” The hot folder list appears. “Add” Button Click the button to open the “Easy Setup Wizard” dialog box so that you can add a hot folder. “Edit” Button From the “Hot Folder” list, select a hot folder and click the button to open the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box that allows you to edit the hot folder. “Delete” Button From the “Hot Folder” list, select a hot folder and click the button to delete the hot folder. “Start” Button Clicking the button changes the status of the selected “inactive” Hot Folder to “active”. “Stop” Button Clicking the button changes the status of the selected “active” Hot Folder to “inactive”. “Add to Startup folder” Register the application in the Windows startup menu. “Save Printed Data” Automatically saves printed data. “About” Button Click the button to display the name and the version number of the utility. “Operation Guide” Button Click the button to display the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Setup Manual”. 424 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Hot Folder Hot folder refers to a folder used for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. • When transferred to the PC’s hot folder, the document data scanned with the Color imageRUNNER is printed in enlarged size from the printer according to the print conditions set in the hot folder. • You can create a new hot folder, edit or delete an existing one, and set print conditions at will. Note • You can create up to 20 hot folders. Windows Software 425 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Creating a New Hot Folder 1. Open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, and then click the “Add” button. Note • For the step to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, see “Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. (→P.422) 2. The “Easy Setup Wizard” dialog box displays. Click the “Next” button. 3. Select the type of printer to use. Click the “Next” button. 426 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy 4. Select the media type to print. Note • If the “Borderless Printing” checkbox is checked, only media types that can be used for borderless printing are displayed in the list. Click the “Next” button. 5. Select roll paper or cut sheet to print. Also, select the media size to print. Click the “Next” button. 6. Select the color matching method. Click the “Next” button. Windows Software 427 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy 7. To receive a document scanned with the Color imageRUNNER, you need to share a folder. Enter the folder shared name in Shared Name. Click the “Next” button. Note • This shared name is used as the name of the hot folder. • You cannot use the “Back” button, after clicking the “Next” button here. 8. Click “Finish” button to close the “Easy Setup Wizard” dialog box. The hot folder you have created appears in the “Hot Folder” list in the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. 428 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Specifying an Existing Shared Folder as a Hot Folder 1. 2. Share the folder you want to specify as a hot folder. Open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, and then click the “Add” button. Note • For the step to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, see “Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. (→P.422) 3. The “Easy Setup Wizard” dialog box displays. Click the “Manual Settings” button. 4. The “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box displays. Enter the hot folder name in “Name”. Click the “Browse” botton, with selecting “Specify a folder”, to set the existing shared folder. Windows Software 429 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy 5. The location of the folders will appear. Select the folder to specify a hot folder, and click the “OK” button. 6. As necessary, set the print conditions in the hot folder. (→P.431) Click the “OK” button to close the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. The hot folder you have created appears in the “Hot Folder” list in the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. 430 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Setting the Print Parameters The printer driver opens when you click the “Properties” button in the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. The printer driver is used to congure basic settings to match the type of media loaded in the printer. Refer to Printer Driver for details on the printer driver. Note • The only three sheets displayed are the “Main” sheet, the “Page Setup” sheet, and the “Layout” sheet. Some of the printer driver settings may be disabled. “Apply Sharpness” Place a checkmark here to set the sharpness. Drag the slider bar to the left or right to adjust. You can also adjust by directly entering a number in the numeric input eld. Note • You can input between 0 and 500. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. • You cannot be applied to PDF les. Windows Software 431 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows) Scanned originals from a Color imageRUNNER can be enlarged and printed automatically. Originals you create by scanning with a Color imageRUNNER are transferred to a "hot folder" and printed automatically after enlargement according to printing conditions you specify for that folder. This processing sequence is called the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy function. To use Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy, rst complete these settings in the following order. 1. Register a hot folder on your computer. Register a hot folder on your computer for storing scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER and complete the settings for enlargement copy. 2. Complete the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER. Congure the Color imageRUNNER to send scanned originals to the hot folder. After these settings are complete, you can print enlarged copies of scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER. Registering a hot folder on your computer Folders used for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy (iR enlargement copy) are called hot folders. Register a hot folder on your computer for storing scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER. You can specify printing conditions (such as the image quality and paper size), based on which originals transferred to the hot folder will be printed. Follow these steps to register and modify hot folders. 1. 2. Display the printer driver dialog box. (→P.348) 3. Click Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy to start the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Click the Utility tab to display the Utility sheet. Copy utility. 4. Use the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility to register or modify hot folders. For instructions on registering and modifying hot folders, refer to the help le for the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility. 432 Windows Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Completing the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER. Congure the Color imageRUNNER to send scanned originals to the hot folder. It is easy to send scanned originals to the hot folder if you assign the scanning settings and destination to a Favorites button on the Color imageRUNNER. For instructions on assigning scanning settings and destinations to a Favorites button, refer to the setting manual, displayed by clicking Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Setup Manual button of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility, or refer to the Color imageRUNNER manual. Scanning the original and print an enlargement Follow the steps below to scan an original on the Color imageRUNNER for enlarged printing on the printer. For detailed instructions, refer to the Color imageRUNNER manual. 1. 2. 3. 4. Load the original on the platen glass or document feeder of the Color imageRUNNER. Press Send to display the screen for transmission. Press Favorites, and then press the Favorites button assigned to the hot folder. Press Start on the control panel. If you scan originals on the platen glass, after scanning all originals, press Done on the touch-panel display. Scanned originals are sent to the hot folder and automatically enlarged and printed following the conditions you specied for the folder. Note • For details on Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy, refer to Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. Windows Software 433 Status Monitor Status Monitor The Features of imagePROGRAF Status Monitor imagePROGRAF Status Monitor is a utility for checking the printer status and managing print jobs. Two screens are available in imagePROGRAF Status Monitor : “Printer List” shows a list of printers, and “Status Monitor” shows details for each printer. • You can view a list of the printers for which printer drivers have been installed on your computer, printers connected to your computer, and printers found on the network. • If a printer error occurs, you can investigate the corrective action immediately. • Images of Ink Tanks are shown, with different images for various types of ink. An icon and warning message will notify you when ink levels are low. • The type of paper loaded in each media source is identied. You can also check to see if paper has run out. • This way, the utility enables you to check printer information and take care of printer maintenance for optimal printing results. • You can also set up automatic email notication of any printer problems or errors to email addresses you designate in advance. • You can use the Accounting Manager to collect the print job logs for the printers and check information such as the printing costs. For details of the Accounting Manager, see Accounting Manager. (→P.437) 434 Windows Software Status Monitor Note • For details, refer to the imagePROGRAF Status Monitor help. Windows Software 435 Status Monitor Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Status Monitor You can use the “Job” sheet in imagePROGRAF Status Monitor for operations such as pausing and canceling print jobs. Preempting Other Jobs If you select a print job and click the “Preempt” button, the selected job is printed ahead of the job that currently precedes it in the print queue. Pausing/Resuming Print Jobs Selecting a print job and clicking the “Pause” button pauses printing of the selected job. To resume printing of a paused print job, select the print job and click the “Resume” button. Note • Once all the print data for a print job has been sent to the printer, the job can no longer be paused/resumed. Canceling Print Jobs Selecting a print job and clicking the “Cancel Job” button cancels printing of the selected job. Note • You cannot cancel other users’ print jobs. Printing Held Jobs Printing of the job with a “Status” of “Holding” is paused because the paper specied by the driver does not match the paper currently loaded in the printer. Use the procedure below to print the held job. 1. 2. Select the held job and click the “Replace Paper” button. Replace the paper in the printer with the correct paper. Note • To continue printing without changing the paper in the printer, select the held job and click “Continue to print” button. 436 Windows Software Accounting Accounting Accounting Manager The Accounting Manager stores the printer’s print job logs so that you can use the information for checking printing costs, etc. The benets of using the Accounting Manager are outlined below. • Print Job Log Collection This allows you to check which documents were printed from each printer, who printed them and when. • Calculation of the Total Pages Used and the Total Cost This allows you to use the collected print job logs to calculate totals for items such as the number of pages printed, the amount of paper used and the printing costs incurred. • Regular Data Acquisition for Print Jobs This automatically logs print jobs at regular intervals. • Exporting Print Job Data This allows you to export collected print job data as a CSV le. Important • The Accounting Manager in Status Monitor displays approximate estimates of the amount of paper consumed and the ink consumed per printed page. Canon cannot guarantee the accuracy of these estimates. These estimates will also vary depending on the conditions of printer use. Launching the Accounting Manager The procedure for launching the Accounting Manager is shown below. 1. 2. Open the imagePROGRAF Status Monitor window. Select “Accounting” in the “Accounting” menu. Or, open the “Accounting” sheet and click the “Accounting” button. Windows Software 437 Accounting Accounting Manager Main Window The Accounting Manager main window consists of a title bar, menu bar, toolbars, listed job selection area, job list area, totals area and status bar. Title Bar This displays the printer model, its serial number and the port number it is using. Menu Bar Allows you to select the menu options required for operation. Toolbars Provide tool buttons and pull-down menus for the main operations. Note • You can opt to either show or hide the toolbars in the “View” menu. 438 Windows Software Accounting Listed Job Selection Area You can use this area to select which job log is displayed. If you are using regular data acquisition, this area allows you to view the collective job logs for each specied period. For more information on how to select the job logs displayed, see Switching Between Displaying Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs. (→P.447) Job List Area This area lists the details of acquired jobs. It displays a list of either the print jobs on the printers or the regularly acquired print jobs. The displayed information includes the amounts of paper and ink consumed, the costs, the media type and the time taken for printing. Windows Software 439 Accounting Totals Area Displays the total costs for the selected job and the amounts of paper and ink consumed. Note • If you are viewing regularly acquired print jobs, selecting a period on the left side of the window displays the total costs for that period and the amounts of paper and ink consumed. Status Bar Displays messages and other information. 440 Windows Software Accounting Accounting Manager Basic Procedures The rst time you use the Accounting Manager, use the following procedures to congure the settings. 1. Congure unit costs, including the costs of ink and paper. For details of the unit cost settings, see Conguring Unit Costs in Accounting Manager. (→P.441) 2. Set options such as the units displayed. For details of the unit settings, see Conguring Units and Display Settings in Accounting Manager. (→P.445) 3. If you are using Regular Data Acquisition, congure the Regular Data Acquisition settings. For details of the Regular Data Acquisition settings, see Automatically Acquiring Print Job Logs at Regular Intervals. (→P.446) 4. Specify the jobs to be listed. For details of how to select the job logs displayed, see Switching Between Displaying Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs. (→P.447) This displays the required print job logs and lists the details. Conguring Unit Costs in Accounting Manager Select “Unit Costs” in the “Settings” menu to open the “Unit Costs” dialog box. Congure the unit cost settings in this dialog box. Note • When you select a job and then open the “Unit Costs” dialog box, items with unit costs that have not yet been congured for that job are shown highlighted. • Setting the Unit Cost for Ink (→P.442) • Setting the Unit Cost for Paper (→P.443) • Setting the Unit Cost for Items Other Than Ink and Paper (→P.444) Windows Software 441 Accounting Setting the Unit Cost for Ink Open the “Ink” sheet. Set the unit cost for ink in this sheet. To set the same unit cost for all the inks 1. 2. 3. Select the “Use same price for all ink” checkbox. Enter the “Tank Capacity” and “Price”. Click the “OK” button. Important • Your settings are not applied until you click the “OK” button. To set different unit costs for each ink color 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. Select the ink color to be costed. Enter the “Tank Capacity” and “Price”. Click the “Overwrite” button. Repeat steps 1 to 3 for all the inks. Click the “OK” button. Important • Your settings are not applied until you click the “OK” button. 442 Windows Software Accounting Setting the Unit Cost for Paper Open the “Paper” sheet. Set the unit cost for paper in this sheet. 1. 2. 3. Select a media type from the “Media Type” list. Enter the “Width”, “Length” and “Price”. Click the “Add” button. To change the unit cost for a media type you have already set, click the “Overwrite” button. 4. Click the “OK” button. Important • Your settings are not applied until you click the “OK” button. Windows Software 443 Accounting Setting the Unit Cost for Items Other Than Ink and Paper Open the “Other” sheet. Use this sheet to set any price for items other than inks and paper. 1. 2. 3. 4. Enter any name in the “Name” eld. Enter a value in “Unit Cost”. Use “Allocated” to specify whether the costs are allocated as being incurred by the print job. Click the “Add” button. To change the unit cost for a media type you have already set, click the “Overwrite” button. 5. Click the “OK” button. Note • You can set unit costs for up to 5 items. Important • Your settings are not applied until you click the “OK” button. 444 Windows Software Accounting Conguring Units and Display Settings in Accounting Manager Select “Units and Display” in the “Settings” menu to open the “Units and Display” dialog box. Use this dialog box to congure the display settings. “Date Display Format” Use this option to select the display format for dates. "YYYY" indicates the year, "MM" the month and "DD" the day. “Currency Unit” Enter the currency unit. Enter a text string up to 3 characters long. “1000 Separator” Use this option to select the symbol used as a separator in numbers. The symbol is inserted every 3 digits. “Decimal Symbol” Use this option to select the symbol used as a decimal point. “Ink Consumed” Use this option to select the unit used for ink consumption. “Paper Width” Use this to select the unit used for paper width. “Paper Length” Use this to select the unit used for paper length. “Area Display Format” Use this to select the unit used for paper area. Windows Software 445 Accounting Automatically Acquiring Print Job Logs at Regular Intervals This feature collects print job logs from the printer at regular intervals and saves the logs on your computer. 1. 2. 3. Select “Regular Data Acquisition” in the “Settings” menu. Select “Acquire print job logs regularly”. Click the “OK” button to close the dialog box. Note • Immediately after you congure Regular Data Acquisition, no print jobs are displayed. Wait a few moments and then select “Refresh” in the “View” menu to display the print jobs. • A maximum of 10,000 records are saved in a print job log. If this number is exceeded, jobs are deleted from the log starting from the oldest record. To save old data, it is recommended that you export the data as a CSV le. For details of how to export print job logs as CSV les, see Exporting Print Job Data as a CSV File. (→P.447) Canceling Regular Print Job Log Acquisition You can use this procedure to cancel the regular acquisition of print job logs from printers. 1. 2. 3. Select “Regular Data Acquisition” in the “Settings” menu. Uncheck the “Acquire print job logs regularly” option. Click the “OK” button to close the dialog box. 446 Windows Software Accounting Switching Between Displaying Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs The print job logs displayed by the Status Monitor Accounting Manager contain two types of job: Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs. You can select whether to display Jobs on Printer or Regularly Acquired Jobs in the Listed Job Selection Area on the left side of the window. “Jobs on Printer” This shows a list of the print jobs currently held on printers. You can change the number of jobs displayed per page using the “Print Jobs Shown Per Page” setting in the “View” menu or the toolbar. You can skip to a particular page using the “Go to” option in the “View” menu or the toolbar. Note • For printers with built-in hard disks, you can view up to 500 print jobs per printer. • For printers without built-in hard disks, you can view up to 32 print jobs per printer. However, only 10 jobs can be displayed if the printer is switched off. “Regularly Acquired Jobs” This shows a list of regularly acquired print jobs. To view all the jobs in a set period, specify the period using “Period” and then “Starting Date” (or “Starting Day of Week” or “Starting Month”) in the “View” menu or the toolbar. For example, to view monthly job logs starting on the 1st of each month, set “Period” to “Monthly” and set “Starting Date” to “1”. Note • Up to 10,000 regularly acquired jobs are displayed for each printer. Exporting Print Job Data as a CSV File You can export the collected print job data in the form of a CSV le by selecting “Export Job Cost Data” in the “File” menu. Note • You can also select “Export Job Cost Data” using the icon in the toolbar. “Selected Jobs” Exports the data for the selected print jobs in the job list as a CSV le. Note • You can select multiple jobs by holding down the Shift key or Ctrl key as you click the job names. “Listed Jobs” Exports the data for the print jobs currently displayed in the list as a CSV le. Windows Software 447 Accounting Showing Job Properties If you select a job in the job list and then select “Show Job Properties” in the “File” menu, the “Job Properties” dialog box appears, allowing you to check information such as detailed cost data. You can copy text-based information in this dialog box to the clipboard by clicking the “Copy” button. Note • You can also open this dialog box by right-clicking the selected job and selecting “Show Job Properties”. Or you can also use the toolbar icon to open the dialog box. • If you select multiple jobs and open the “Job Properties” dialog box, the total costs for the selected jobs are displayed. Showing, Saving and Loading Selected Unit Cost Data “Show Unit Cost Data” Select “Show Unit Cost Data” in the “File” menu to open the “Unit Cost Data” dialog box. This lists the unit costs for items such as the selected ink and paper. You can copy text-based information in this dialog box to the clipboard by clicking the “Copy” button. “Save Unit Cost Data” Select a destination folder using “Save Unit Cost Data” in the “File” menu. The unit cost data for items such as the selected ink and paper is saved as a le. “Load Unit Cost Data” Selecting “Load Unit Cost Data” in the “File” menu loads saved unit cost data. Showing the Total Amount of Ink and Paper Consumed Select “Show Ink and Paper Consumed” in the “File” menu to open the “Show Ink and Paper Consumed” dialog box. This lists the total amounts of ink and paper consumed by the printer so far. You can copy text-based information in this dialog box to the clipboard by clicking the “Copy” button. Note • Up to 7 types of media are listed in order of the amount consumed. The total consumption for other media types is shown as “Other”. 448 Windows Software Digital Photo Front-Access Digital Photo Front-Access Digital Photo Front-Access Digital Photo Front-Access is an application that links photos from Canon digital cameras and other image les on your computer with various other applications. • Simply select an image and click the icon of the application you want to start to launch the application. • You can also print from Digital Photo Front-Access. In short, Digital Photo Front-Access can help you manage images in many ways from editing to printing as an effective way to work with other applications. • Digital Photo Front-Access also enables image retouching. For automatic retouching, select an image for retouching and click Image Adjustment. • Because this application automates the workow from retouching to display for all of your images, it can save time and work in retouching. Note • For details, refer to the Digital Photo Front-Access help. Windows Software 449 Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals You can print a variety of source documents from word-processing or spreadsheet programs or screen shots from web browsers after composing an original with them using PosterArtist. This topic describes how to use PosterArtist to compose originals from multiple applications, creating a poster layout for printing. Important • This function is only supported in Windows. • PosterArtist (sold separately) must be installed to use this function. 1. 2. 3. Choose “Print” in the application menu. 4. Click the Layout tab to display the Layout sheet. Select the printer in the dialog box, and then open the printer driver dialog box. (→P.346) Make sure the Main sheet is displayed. 450 Windows Software Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals 5. 6. 7. Select the A Page Layout check box. Click in the Edit Using PosterArtist in the A Page Layout list. When you attempt to print, PosterArtist starts up and the PageCapture window is displayed. (At this point, the document will not be printed yet.) 8. 9. Choose the page to load in PosterArtist. Edit and rearrange the image in the PosterArtist window as desired. Important • Without closing the PosterArtist window, repeat steps 1-8 to arrange originals from multiple applications on the same page. Note • For instructions on editing and rearranging images, refer to the PosterArtist Manual. 10. Print from the PosterArtist menu. Windows Software 451 Device Setup Utility Device Setup Utility imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility is a utility to establish communication between the printer and your computer by completing relevant settings. After the printer is installed, for example, you can use imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility to complete the network settings initially. • Starting imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility will show a list of printers found on the network. In this list, select the printer (specically, the printer’s MAC address) that you want to set up, and then congure the basic settings from your computer, such as the printer’s IP address and the network frame type. • You can see which printers are online in the network by checking the printer list. Communication between your computer and these printers is possible. Note • We recommend that your network or printer administrator complete the setup work using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. • For details, refer to the imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility help. Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility Install imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the User Software CD-ROM provided with the printer as follows: Important • In Windows 2000/Windows XP/Windows Server 2003/Windows Vista/Windows Server 2008, you must log on with administrative rights equivalent to the “Administrator” account. 1. 2. 3. 4. Insert the User Software CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive. On the Setup Menu window, click Install Individual Software. Click Install in imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Follow the instructions on the screen to proceed with the installation. 452 Windows Software Device Setup Utility Conguring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility On a computer running Windows, you can use imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility provided with the printer to congure the printer’s IP address. This topic describes how to congure the IP address using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Important • To congure network settings, you must be logged in with administrative rights such as “Administrator” account. We recommend that your network administrator congure the network settings. • For instructions on installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility, see “Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility”. (→P.452) When specifying an IPv4 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv4 tab. In the Setting IP Address list, choose Manual. Enter the IP address assigned to the printer and click the Set button. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Note • To congure the IP address automatically, choose Auto in the Setting IP Address list and select DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP. • You can also specify the subnet mask and default gateway. When specifying an IPv6 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv6 tab. In IPv6, select On. When there is an IPv6-compatible router in the network environment, select On in Stateless Address. Additionally, when there is an DHCPv6-compatible server in the network environment, select On in DHCPv6. Note • When there is no IPv6-compatible router or DHCPv6-compatible server, select On in Manual and enter the IPv6 Address and Prex Length. 7. 8. 9. Click Set. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Windows Software 453 Printer Driver Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X) For instructions on accessing the Mac OS X printer driver, refer to the following topics. • Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Mac OS X) (→P.460) For information on the Mac OS X printer driver settings, refer to the following topics. • Main Pane (Mac OS X) (→P.461) You can specify the media type, color processing, print quality, print preview, and other settings. Choose Easy Settings to specify basic print settings based on the printing application or Advanced Settings to complete more detailed settings as desired. • • • • Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Mac OS X) (→P.465) View settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Mac OS X) (→P.466) Color Settings Pane: Color (Mac OS X) (→P.467) Color Settings Pane: Monochrome (Mac OS X) (→P.469) • Page Setup Pane (Mac OS X) (→P.471) You can specify the page size of the original, borderless printing, enlargement or reduction, the orientation, the paper size and source, and automatic cutting. • Utility Pane (Mac OS X) (→P.473) You can specify settings related to maintenance for the Printhead and feed amount, as well as settings for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. • Additional Settings Pane (Mac OS X) (→P.474) You can specify settings for how print jobs are sent to the printer. • Support Pane (Mac OS X) (→P.475) You can view support information and the user’s manual. With the imagePROGRAF Free Layout feature, you can arrange originals from various source applications on a single page before printing. For details, see Free Layout. With the imagePROGRAF Preview feature, you can check the layout before printing and adjust layout or size settings while viewing a preview screen. For details, see Preview. With the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy feature, you can automatically enlarge and print scanned originals from a Color imageRUNNER. For details, see Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. 454 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X) If you have replaced the paper, you must complete the following settings in the printer driver. 1. This sets the B Format for and C Paper Size. Note • The conguration method varies depending on the OS and application software you are using. If Page Setup is displayed in the application menu, the settings are congured by opening the Page Attributes dialog box from Page Setup. If it is not displayed, the settings are congured in the upper part of the printer driver displayed when you select Print from the application software menu. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the A Printer list. Choose the original size in the F Paper Size list. If you congured the settings using the Page Attributes dialog box, click F OK to close the dialog box, and then select Print from the application software menu. 5. Access the Main pane. 6. In the A Media Type list, select the type of paper that is loaded. Mac OS X Software 455 Printer Driver 7. Access the Page Setup pane. 8. 9. In the A Paper Source list, select how paper is supplied. If you have selected Manual in A Paper Source, make sure the size as selected in Page Setup is displayed in C Page Size. If you have selected Roll Paper in A Paper Source, make sure the width of the loaded roll is displayed in B Roll Width. Note • If the width of the roll loaded in the printer is not shown in B Roll Width, click L Printer Information on the Main pane to update the printer information. Note • A variety of settings are available in the printer driver to suit different printing applications. For details on available printing conditions, see “Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X)”. (→P.454) 456 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Conrming Print Settings (Mac OS X) There are two ways to conrm what printing conditions have been specied, as follows. • Checking a preview of the settings • Checking a print preview Checking a preview of the settings A preview of the settings is displayed on the left side of the Main, Page Setup, Utility, and Additional Settings panes.By checking images and numerical values in the preview, you can conrm current settings for the page size, orientation, paper source, and so on. Display Area Information Displayed Pane displayed when the H Images tab is clicked On top, illustrations indicate the page size of the original, the paper size, orientation, layout, borderless printing selection, color mode, and other settings information. Under this, the page size, paper size, and method and percentage of enlargement or reduction is displayed. Pane displayed when the I Size tab is clicked Paper size details are indicated numerically. Pane with printer and paper illustrations Illustrations indicate the paper source, orientation, borderless printing selection, and other settings information. Note • To conrm the Print Target specied in Easy Settings, click G View set. on the Main pane to display the View settings dialog box. Mac OS X Software 457 Printer Driver Checking a print preview You can check an image of the original just as it will be printed. Conrming the image of print jobs beforehand helps prevent printing errors. For details on print previews,see “Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing”. (→P.313) 458 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X) This topic describes how to check the layout before printing using the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview function. 1. 2. Choose Print in the application menu. 3. 4. 5. Select the O Print Preview check box. 6. 7. Check the layout and adjust settings in the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview window as desired. Access the Main pane. Click M Print. The Canon imagePROGRAF Preview window is displayed. Print from the Canon imagePROGRAF Preview menu. Note • For details on imagePROGRAF Preview functions, refer to Preview. Mac OS X Software 459 Printer Driver Using Favorites (Mac OS X) You can use the Presets function in Mac OS X for favorite-based printing. Note • In the printing dialog box, click Save As in the Presets list to save the current print settings. This is a standard feature of the operating system. For details, refer to the Mac OS documentation. Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Mac OS X) 1. In the application software, select Print from the File menu to display the dialog box for printing conditions. Note • This dialog box includes basic printing options and enables you to choose the printer, specify the range of pages, number of copies, and so on. 2. Select the printer in the Printer list. 3. Click Print to start printing. As shown in the following illustration, you can switch to other panes in this dialog box to complete settings for various methods of printing, including enlarged and reduced printing, borderless printing, and so on. 460 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Main Pane (Mac OS X) The following settings are available on the Main pane. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. Note • On the Main pane, choose Easy Settings to specify basic print settings based on the print target, or switch to Advanced Settings to complete more detailed settings as desired. Common Items A Media Type Select the paper type. For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) B Get Information Displays Paper Information on Printer. You can update the printer driver settings for the feed source, media type, and roll width by selecting the feed source. • Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Mac OS X) (→P.464) C Set Displays Paper Detailed Settings. You can congure the printing settings to match the type of media, such as the ink drying time. • Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Mac OS X) (→P.465) O Print Preview If you turn this on, imagePROGRAF Preview starts before printing. This allows you to check on-screen previews of documents before printing. Important • This cannot be selected if Free Layout is enabled in the Page Setup panel. • Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (→P.313) L Printer Displays Printer. You can display printer information such as the remaining ink levels. Mac OS X Software 461 Printer Driver Conguration using Easy Settings E Print Target Choose presets that match the type of document to be printed. • Printing Photos and Images (→P.152) • Printing Line Drawings and Text (→P.160) • Printing Ofce Documents (→P.171) F Print Quality Choose the level of print quality. G View set. Click to display the View settings dialog box, which enables you to conrm the settings for the selected item from the E Print Target list or change the order of items listed in E Print Target. 462 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Conguration using Advanced Settings E Print Priority Choose the graphic elements that you want to emphasize for printing. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) F Print Quality Choose the level of print quality. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) H Color Mode Choose the color mode. • Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) I Set Click to display the Color Settings dialog box for more advanced color settings. • Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver (→P.177) J Unidirectional Printing Select this checkbox to prevent problems such as misaligned lines and improve the print quality. However, the printing speed becomes slower. Q Thicken Fine Lines Activate this option to print ne lines more distinctly. P Sharpen Text Activate this option to print text more sharply. K Reduce Print Unevenness Select this checkbox for two-pass printing to reduce color shading. This option is displayed if you have selected Plain Paper in Media Type and Ofce Document in Print Priority. N Economy Printing Select this checkbox to reduce the amount of ink consumed during printing. However, the print quality is worse than for normal printing. Select this mode if you want to conserve ink when checking drawings, for example. Depending on the Media Type and Print Quality settings, this mode may not be available. Mac OS X Software 463 Printer Driver Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Mac OS X) On the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, you can obtain information on the paper in the printer and congure printer driver media type setting. Note • To display the Paper Information on Printer dialog box, on the Main pane, click Get Information by Media Type. (→P.461) A Paper Source Shows the Paper Source supported by the printer, as well as the type of paper loaded. To update the media type setting in the printer driver, select the desired Paper Source option and click OK. 464 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Mac OS X) The Paper Detailed Settings dialog box offers the following settings. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. Note • To display the Paper Detailed Settings dialog box, on the Main pane, click Set by Media Type. (→P.461) A Media Type Select the paper type. For information on the types of paper the printer supports, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) B Drying Time Specify the time that the printer waits for ink to dry, as needed. The Drying Time setting is only valid for rolls. • (→P.127) C Between Pages Specify the time the printer waits after printing a page until ejecting the paper, as needed. D Between Scans Specify the time the printer waits after printing a line on the page until printing the next line, as needed. E Roll Paper Margin for Safety You can specify the length of a margin on the leading edge of paper to ensure that paper susceptible to curling is held rmly against the Platen. F Near End Margin Specify the length of the Near End Margin (the leading edge margin) of the roll, as needed. G Cut Speed Select the speed of automatic cutting, as needed. You can adjust this setting if paper is not cut well when automatic cutting is used. H Automatic Cutting You can activate or deactivate automatic cutting and printing of cut lines, as desired. In this list, specify Printer Default, None, or Print Cut Guideline. Mac OS X Software 465 Printer Driver J Mirror Specify whether to print a mirror image, as needed. Select this option to print a version of the document or image with the left and right sides inverted. View settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Mac OS X) In the View settings dialog box, you can check details of the selected printing application. Note • To display the View settings dialog box, on the Main pane, click View settings by Print Target. (→P.461) A Print Target Shows all Print Target options (settings items for the printing application). B Name Identies the item selected in Print Target by its name and an icon. C Details Here, you can conrm detailed settings values for each item selected in the Print Target list. 466 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Color Settings Pane: Color (Mac OS X) In general, make any needed adjustments to the color of documents in the application used to create them. However, if the color tone as printed is not as you expected, you can also adjust the color in the printer driver. Color Adjustment pane: color If the color tone as printed is not as you expected, you can adjust it on the Color Adjustment pane. Note • To display the Color Adjustment pane, on the Main pane click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings. (→P.461) A Sample Type Choose a sample image from Standard, Portrait, Landscape, or Graphics. B View Color Pattern Select this checkbox to display the color pattern. C Apply to Sample Select this checkbox to apply the changed settings to the sample image. D Cyan / E Magenta / F Yellow Correct color tones by adjusting the levels of each color. G Gray Tone Adjust the color tone of grays as desired. Choose Cool (tinged with blue) or Warm (tinged with red). H Brightness Adjust the overall image brightness as desired. You can adjust the brightness if the printed document is lighter or darker than the original image (that is, the original photo that was scanned or the original graphic as it appears on the computer screen). I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other, as desired. Increasing the Contrast makes images sharper, and reducing the Contrast softens images. Mac OS X Software 467 Printer Driver J Saturation Adjust the color intensity as desired. Increasing the Saturation setting makes colors more vivid, and reducing the Saturation makes colors more subdued. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) K Object Adjustment Select this option to display the Object Adjustment dialog box, in which you can specify objects subject to color adjustment. Matching pane On the Matching pane, you can specify color matching to compensate for differences in the appearance of colors on various devices. Note • To display the Matching pane, on the Main pane click Color Settings by Color Mode in Advanced Settings, and then click Matching. (→P.461) A Matching Mode Select the color matching mode to use, as desired. B Matching Method Select the matching method that suits the document to be printed. Various Matching Method options are available depending on your selection in Matching Mode. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) 468 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Color Settings Pane: Monochrome (Mac OS X) The following settings are available on the Color Settings pane for monochrome printing. Color Adjustment pane: Monochrome On the Color Adjustment pane for monochrome printing, you can adjust the brightness and contrast. Note • To display the Color Adjustment pane, on the Main pane, click Color Settings in Advanced Settings. (→P.461) A Sample Type Choose a sample image from Standard, Portrait, Landscape, or Graphics. B View Color Pattern Select this checkbox to display the color pattern. C Apply to Sample Select this checkbox to apply the changed settings to the sample image. D Cyan / E Magenta / F Yellow Not available. G Gray Tone Not available. H Brightness Adjust the overall image brightness as desired. You can adjust the brightness if the printed document is lighter or darker than the original image (that is, the original photo that was scanned or the original graphic as it appears on the computer screen). I Contrast Adjust the contrast of the darkest and lightest portions relative to each other, as desired. Increasing the I Contrast makes images sharper, and reducing the I Contrast softens images. Mac OS X Software 469 Printer Driver J Saturation Not available. Note • For details on settings items,see “Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver”. (→P.177) K Object Adjustment Select this option to display the Object Adjustment dialog box, in which you can specify objects subject to color adjustment. 470 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Page Setup Pane (Mac OS X) The following settings are available on the Page Setup pane. For details on settings items, refer to the printer driver help. A Paper Source Choose how paper is supplied. Options displayed in the list vary depending on the selection in A Media Type in the Main pane. B Roll Width Displays the paper width of the roll loaded in the printer. Unknown is displayed if the printer cannot detect the roll paper width. C Page Size Displays the size of the original, as specied in the page settings of the application. For details on page sizes available in the application.see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) D Enlarged/Reduced Printing Select this checkbox to choose the following options. • Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (→P.201) • Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.207) • Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (→P.213) E Fit Paper Size Resizes the document image to match the paper size. F Fit Roll Paper Width Resizes the document image to match the roll width. G Scaling Resizes the document image based on a specied scaling value. Enter a value in a range of “5-600.” H Borderless Printing Borderless printing is available if Roll Paper is selected in the A Paper Source list. Activate this setting for borderless printing to match the size and width of the paper. • Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size (→P.232) • Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.239) • Borderless Printing at Actual Size (→P.225) Mac OS X Software 471 Printer Driver I Paper Size Choose the size of the paper you will print on. Click Display all selections for Paper Size to list available sizes. For details on available paper sizes,see “Paper Sizes”. (→P.100) J Print Centered Select this checkbox to print document images in the center of the paper. • Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (→P.289) • Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (→P.295) K No Spaces at Top or Bottom Select this checkbox to print the next image skipping blank areas above and below printable data in documents, which enables you to conserve the paper. • Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (→P.307) L Rotate Page 90 degrees Select this checkbox to rotate the document image by 90 degrees before printing. • Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (→P.301) N Free Layout Select this checkbox to start imagePROGRAF Free Layout before printing. This allows you to print multiple documents next to each other. Important • This cannot be selected if Print Preview is enabled in the Main panel. • Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (→P.269) 472 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Utility Pane (Mac OS X) The following settings are available on the Utility pane. A Set Click to display the Printer dialog box, which offers the following maintenance for the printer. • Nozzle (ink ejecting outlet) cleaning • Head alignment adjustment • Feed amount adjustment B View Click to start imagePROGRAF Printmonitor, which enables you to view the status of print jobs. C Set Click to complete the settings for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy (iR enlargement copy). *1: For details, see Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. Mac OS X Software 473 Printer Driver Additional Settings Pane (Mac OS X) The following settings are available on the Additional Settings pane. A Data Send Method Choose how print data is sent to the printer. • B Send Print Data Immediately to Printer • C Send All Print Data as Batch to Printer 474 Mac OS X Software Printer Driver Support Pane (Mac OS X) On the Support pane, you can view support information and the user’s manual. A Support Information Click to access the Canon support webpage, where you can nd the latest information on the printer and consumables, check for printer driver updates, and browse other information. B User Manual Click to view the printer user’s manual. This function requires the user’s manual to be installed on your computer. C Settings The settings can be saved as a le. Click to display the Export dialog box, which enables you to specify where to save the le. D About You can display version information for the printer driver. Mac OS X Software 475 Preview Preview The Features of Preview The main features of Preview are as follows. • While viewing this screen, you can adjust layout settings of a document created with application software. • You can not only adjust layout settings but also your changes will be instantly applied on the preview screen, and you can print the preview screen as it is seen. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Preview settings. Operating Environment You can use the Preview in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Mac OS X (10.3.9 to 10.5) • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver 476 Mac OS X Software Preview Starting Preview Follow the procedure below to start the Preview. 1. 2. Start the apllication software which you use. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 3. 4. Click “Print Preview” in the “Main” panel to attach a checkmark. 5. Preview main window is displayed. Click the “Print” button in the “Print” dialog box. Mac OS X Software 477 Preview Preview Main Window The Preview main window consists of the menu and tool bars, and preview, dialog , drawer and status area. Note • You can use the “View” menu to show or hide the tool bar. Menu Bar This allows you to select menus required for operations. Tool Bar This allows you to select tool buttons required for major operations. Preview Area You can check the settings you made in this area. 478 Mac OS X Software Preview Dialog Area This allows you to set the print conditions and perform a print job. Drawer Area This allows you to display the thumbnails of a document. This area appears when you click “Drawer” from the tool bar. Alternatively, you may select “Drawer” from the “View” menu. Status Area This shows “Input Size” and “Output Size”. Mac OS X Software 479 Preview Paper Settings Panel This panel appears when you select Paper Settings in the dialog area. “Media Type” This allows you to select the media type. Note • Always select media type that is actually set in the printer. When the media you chose is different from the media set in the printer, you may not receive the desired print results. “Easy Settings” / “Advanced Settings” Two modes are available to provide the optimum print settings for jobs. The settings available on each mode are as follows. • Easy Settings (→P.482) • Advanced Settings (→P.484) Paper Source You can select the paper source. The following settings are available for paper source. Setting Details “Manual” Select for manual paper feed printing. “Roll Paper” Select to print on roll paper. “Roll Paper Width” This selects the width of the roll media set to the printer. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. 480 Mac OS X Software Preview “Copies” You can input the number of print copies in numerical characters. Note • The maximum value is 999. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Restore Defaults” Button Click the button to reset to the setting when starting Preview. “Print” Button Click the button to begin printing. “Update Printer Info.” Button Click the button to acquire printer information. Mac OS X Software 481 Preview Easy Settings You can easily select the best settings for the print job by just selecting an item from the print target list that matches the content of the document. “Print Target” You can easily select the best settings for the print job simply. If you select each “Print Target” item the corresponding comment for that item is displayed below the list. Setting Details “Default Settings” Suitable for printing normal documents that contain a mixture of text, photographs, and graphics. “Ofce Document” Suitable for printing handouts as well as general ofce documents for which print clarity is key. “Poster” The best setting for posters.Prints using vivid and high impact colors. “CAD (Color Line Drawing)” Prints the ne lines of CAD drawings and other such documents sharp and clear. CAD (B/W Line Drawing) Suitable for printing CAD drawings with sharp, dark lines. “Perspective, GIS” Suitable for attractive printing of 3D-CAD drawings, perspective drawings, and GIS drawings including maps. “Photo (Color)” Suitable for printing photographic images captured with a digital camera. “Faithful Color Reproduction” Prints by faithfully reproducing the colors of the original image. “Custom Settings” Suitable for printing documents for which Advanced Settings have been specied. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. 482 Mac OS X Software Preview “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. Mac OS X Software 483 Preview Advanced Settings Presents detailed settings for the print quality, the color mode, and other items so you can select the values for these settings yourself. “Print Priority” Select a print quality mode that is appropriate for the print job. Setting Details “Image” This mode achieves the best results for printing photographic images and illustrations. “Line Drawing” This mode is best for printing CAD drawings with ne lines or wall newssheet or other documents that contain large amounts of text. However, you may not achieve the quality you expect with printing photographs or other images with many lled areas. For these types of jobs, select “Image”. “Ofce Document” Prints common ofce documents, such as proposals, memos for distribution, etc., so they are easy to read. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. 484 Mac OS X Software Preview Output Settings Panel This panel appears when you select Output Settings in the dialog area. “Enlarged/Reduced Printing” Select the method for enlarged/reduced printing. The following settings are available for enlarged/reduced printing. Setting Details Fit Paper Size Enlarges/reduces the whole page automatically to t the media size selected for output. Select the media size to print from Paper Size. “Fit Roll Paper Width” Enlarges/reduces the whole page automatically to t the width of the roll paper with the page width. *Make sure that the width of the roll paper in the printer is set correctly for “Roll Paper Width” in the Paper Settings panel. *Displayed only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. Scaling Enlarges/reduces the whole page by the scaling rate as specied. Input the scaling value in numerical characters. You can specify a range between 5 and 600%. *You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. *Although Scaling can be set to make the image larger than the media size, the part that does not t in the media cannot be printed. *This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Borderless Printing”. “Borderless Printing” You can print the media without margins on all sides when the roll paper with the specic width and the specic media type is used. For more information about “Borderless Printing”, see “Print with No Borders”. (→P.496) Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. • This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Print Centered”. Mac OS X Software 485 Preview Paper Size You can select the size of the print media. Note • This is not displayed when “Fit Roll Paper Width” is set in “Enlarged/Reduced Printing”. “Print Centered” You can print on the center of the media loaded in the printer. For more information about “Print Centered”, see “Print on the Center”. (→P.497) Note • This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Borderless Printing”. “No Spaces at Top or Bottom” You can save paper on not to feed roll paper for the empty spaces when the print data contains spaces at the top or bottom. For more information about “No Spaces at Top or Bottom”, see “Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom”. (→P.498) Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. “Rotate Page” Select the method for rotating page. The following settings are available for rotating page. Setting Details “Rotate Right 90 Degrees” Rotates the portrait page right 90 degrees and print in landscape orientation. When the rotated page can t in the width of roll paper, the page is rotated automatically, and when it can not t in the width of roll paper, the page is not rotated. “Rotate Left 90 Degrees” Rotates the portrait page left 90 degrees and print in landscape orientation. When the rotated page can t in the width of roll paper, the page is rotated automatically, and when it can not t in the width of roll paper, the page is not rotated. “Rotate 180 degrees” Allows you to rotate the image 180 degrees from the vertical to the right. “Restore Defaults” Button Click the button to reset to the setting when starting Preview. “Print” Button Click the button to begin printing. “Update Printer Info.” Button Click the button to acquire printer information. 486 Mac OS X Software Preview Color Settings Panel This panel appears when you select Color Settings in the dialog area. “Color Mode” You can select a color mode to suit the print job. Setting Details “Color” Enables color printing. “Monochrome” Disables color printing and converts image from continuous color to grayscaled monochrome. “Color (CAD)” Prints lines in the best color possible so they are easy to see. “Monochrome Bitmap” Prints all colors other than white in black. “Monochrome (BK ink)” Select to print all lines with black ink. Note • The availability of settings depends on the print priority and media type selections. “Color Adjustment” / “Matching” You can set the color adjustment and matching. • Color Adjustment (→P.488) • Matching (→P.490) “Restore Defaults” Button Click the button to reset to the setting when starting Preview. “Print” Button Click the button to begin printing. “Update Printer Info.” Button Click the button to acquire printer information. Mac OS X Software 487 Preview Color Adjustment You can set the color adjustment. Adjusting Color Normally colors should be adjusted in the software application, but if you see colors in the printout that do not match colors on the screen, you can perform color adjustments. 1. 2. Select “Color” on “Color Mode” in the Color Settings panel. 3. Drag each slider to the left or right to adjust. Select “Color Adjustment”. Setting Details “Cyan” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Magenta” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Yellow” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Brightness” Adjusts the brightness of the entire image. When the results of the printout are brighter than the original images such as the original photo before scanning and graphics created on the display, or when you want to print in different degrees of brightness, use this feature. “Contrast” Adjusts the relative brightness between the brightest and darkest portions of the image. *For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. “Saturation” Adjusts the hues for vivid color or dark color. “Gray Tone” Adjusts gray from cool black (bluish tones) to warm black (reddish tones). Note • You can also click the up or down arrow, or enter the number directly to increase or decrease the value. 488 Mac OS X Software Preview Adjusting Monochrome Use the monochrome setting to print monochrome images of color photographs captured with a scanner or digital camera or other color images. 1. 2. Select “Monochrome” on “Color Mode” in the Color Settings panel. 3. Drag each slider to the left or right to adjust. Select “Color Adjustment”. Setting Details “Brightness” Adjusts the brightness of the entire image. When the results of the printout are brighter than the original images such as the original photo before scanning and graphics created on the display, or when you want to print in different degrees of brightness, use this feature. “Contrast” Adjusts the relative brightness between the brightest and darkest portions of the image. *For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. Note • You can also click the up or down arrow, or enter the number directly to increase or decrease the value. Mac OS X Software 489 Preview Matching You can set the matching. “Matching Mode” You can select a matching mode to suit the print job. Setting Details Driver Matching Mode (→P.492) Independent driver color matching is performed. ICC Matching Mode (→P.493) Color matching using ColorGear is performed. ColorSync (→P.494) Color matching using CMM from Mac OS is performed. “No Correction” No color matching is performed. Select this option when you want to perform color matching in the software application. Note • You need to set each correction on the printer driver. “Matching Method” You can select a matching method to suit the print job. “Input Prole” Select the input prole. Note • You can select only after ICC Matching Mode has been selected in “Matching Mode”. “Printer Prole” Select the printer prole. Note • You can select only after ICC Matching Mode or “ColorSync” has been selected in “Mode”. 490 Mac OS X Software Preview “Soft Proof” When you place a checkmark here, “ColorSync” applies to the preview area. Note • You can select only after “ColorSync” has been selected in “Matching Mode”. Mac OS X Software 491 Preview Driver Matching Mode 1. Under “Mode”, select Driver Matching Mode. 2. Click “Matching Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting Details “Auto” Automatically selects the best color matching method for each Image, Graphics, Text. “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. Saturation Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. 492 Mac OS X Software Preview ICC Matching Mode 1. Under “Matching Mode” on the “Matching”, select ICC Matching Mode. 2. Click the “Matching Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting 3. 4. Details “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. Colorimetric (No White-Point Correction) Performs Colorimetric color matching but without white point correction. “Saturation” Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Click the “Input Prole” list and select an input prole. Click the “Printer Prole” list and select a printer prole. Mac OS X Software 493 Preview ColorSync 1. Place a checkmark on “Soft Proof” to simulate the output product in Layout Area. 494 Mac OS X Software Preview Preferences Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Preferences” from the “imagePROGRAF Advanced Preview” menu. You can set the preferences for Preview. “Units” Set the unit for paper length, margins, and so on. Zoom Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Zoom” from the “View” menu. You can enlarge or reduce the screen display. Scaling Set the magnication for enlargement or reduction of the screen display. Note • You can input between 10 and 400. • You can change the numbers by clicking “▼” button. Go to Page Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Go to Page” from the “View” menu. Note • You can not select “Go to Page” if the document is only one page. “Page” Input the page number in numerical characters to display in the preview area. Note • You can change the numbers in the range of the page of the documents. Mac OS X Software 495 Preview Print with No Borders You can use the borderless printing function to print without margins surrounding the image. Note • With some media borderless printing can be performed only between two edges. • To use the borderless printing function, the specied media must be set to the printer. 1. 2. 3. 4. On the Paper Settings Panel (→P.480) , select “Roll Paper” in Paper Source. 5. Click the “Print” button. On the Output Settings panel, click the “Enlarged/Reduced Printing” check box on. Select “Fit Roll Paper Width”. Click the “Borderless Printing” check box on. Borderless printing begins. 496 Mac OS X Software Preview Print on the Center You can print on the center of the media loaded in the printer. Note • This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Borderless Printing”. 1. On the Output Settings panel, click the “Print Centered” check box on. 2. Click the “Print” button. Printing on the center begins. Mac OS X Software 497 Preview Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom You can save paper on not to feed roll paper for the empty spaces when the print data contains spaces at the top or bottom. Note • This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Borderless Printing”. 1. 2. On the Paper Settings Panel (→P.480) , select “Roll Paper” in Paper Source. 3. Click the “Print” button. On the Output Settings panel, click the “No Spaces at Top or Bottom” check box on. Printing on the settings with no spaces at top or bottom begins. 498 Mac OS X Software Preview Print Page Rotated 90 Degrees You can save paper by printing in landscape orientation on roll paper. 1. 2. 3. On the Paper Settings Panel (→P.480) , select “Roll Paper” in Paper Source. 4. Click the “Print” button. On the Output Settings panel, click the “Rotate Page” check box on. Select “Rotate Right 90 Degrees” or “Rotate Left 90 Degrees”. Printing on rotating 90 degrees begins. Mac OS X Software 499 Preview Display with Fitting to the Width of the Paper In the preview area, you can display to the width of the paper. 1. 2. Select “Fit to Width” from the tool bar. Fitting to the width of the paper, it is displayed. 500 Mac OS X Software Preview Display with All In the preview area, you can display all. 1. 2. Select “Fit Screen” from the tool bar. All is displayed. Mac OS X Software 501 Preview Display with Actual Size In the preview area, you can display the actual size. 1. 2. Select “Actual Size” from the tool bar. Actual size is displayed. 502 Mac OS X Software Preview Moving a Page You can move a page to display in the preview area. 1. Select each button in “Go to Page” on the tool bar. Setting Details Go to the rst page. Go to the previous page. Go to the next page. Go to the last page. 2. The target page appears. Note • You can also move a page by clicking the page on the thumbnails. Mac OS X Software 503 Free Layout Free Layout The Features of Free Layout The main features of Free Layout are as follows. • Allows you to lay out at will and print a document created with application software. • You can not only lay out multiple pages on one page but also lay out and print a multiple-le document on one page, or lay out and print a document created with multiple application programs on one page. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Free Layout settings. Operating Environment You can use the Free Layout in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Mac OS X (10.3.9 to 10.5) • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver 504 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Starting Free Layout Follow the procedure below to start the Free Layout. 1. 2. Start the apllication software which you use. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 3. 4. Click on “Free Layout” in the “Page Setup” panel to attach a checkmark. 5. Free Layout main window is displayed. Click the “Print” button in the “Print” dialog box. Mac OS X Software 505 Free Layout Free Layout Main Window The Free Layout main window consists of the menu and tool bars, layout area and dialog areas. Note • You can use the “View” menu to show or hide the tool. Menu Bar This allows you to select menus required for operations. Tool Bar This allows you to select tool buttons required for major operations. Layout Area This allows you to lay out objects and edit the object size and orientation. 506 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Dialog Area This allows you to set the print conditions and perform a print job. Mac OS X Software 507 Free Layout Paper Settings Panel This panel appears when you select Paper Settings in the dialog area. “Media Type” This allows you to select the media type. Note • Always select media type that is actually set in the printer. When the media you chose is different from the media set in the printer, you may not receive the desired print results. “Easy Settings” / “Advanced Settings” Two modes are available to provide the optimum print settings for jobs. The settings available on each mode are as follows. • Easy Settings (→P.510) • Advanced Settings (→P.512) Paper Source You can select the paper source. The following settings are available for paper source. Setting Details “Manual” Select for manual paper feed printing. “Roll Paper” Select to print on roll paper. “Roll Paper Width” This selects the width of the roll media set to the printer. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. 508 Mac OS X Software Free Layout “Copies” You can input the number of print copies in numerical characters. Note • The maximum value is 999. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Restore Defaults” Button Click the button to reset to the setting when starting Free Layout. “Print” Button Click the button to begin printing. “Update Printer Info.” Button Click the button to acquire printer information. Mac OS X Software 509 Free Layout Easy Settings You can easily select the best settings for the print job by just selecting an item from the print target list that matches the content of the document. “Print Target” You can easily select the best settings for the print job simply. If you select each “Print Target” item the corresponding comment for that item is displayed below the list. Setting Details “Default Settings” Suitable for printing normal documents that contain a mixture of text, photographs, and graphics. “Ofce Document” Suitable for printing handouts as well as general ofce documents for which print clarity is key. “Poster” The best setting for posters.Prints using vivid and high impact colors. “CAD (Color Line Drawing)” Prints the ne lines of CAD drawings and other such documents sharp and clear. CAD (B/W Line Drawing) Suitable for printing CAD drawings with sharp, dark lines. “Perspective, GIS” Suitable for attractive printing of 3D-CAD drawings, perspective drawings, and GIS drawings including maps. “Photo (Color)” Suitable for printing photographic images captured with a digital camera. “Faithful Color Reproduction” Prints by faithfully reproducing the colors of the original image. “Custom Settings” Suitable for printing documents for which Advanced Settings have been specied. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. 510 Mac OS X Software Free Layout “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. Mac OS X Software 511 Free Layout Advanced Settings Presents detailed settings for the print priority, the print quality, and other items so you can select the values for these settings yourself. “Print Priority” Select a print quality mode that is appropriate for the print job. Setting Details “Image” This mode achieves the best results for printing photographic images and illustrations. “Line Drawing” This mode is best for printing CAD drawings with ne lines or wall newssheet or other documents that contain large amounts of text. However, you may not achieve the quality you expect with printing photographs or other images with many lled areas. For these types of jobs, select “Image”. “Ofce Document” Prints common ofce documents, such as proposals, memos for distribution, etc., so they are easy to read. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. 512 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Color Settings Panel This panel appears when you select Color Settings in the dialog area. “Color Mode” You can select a color mode to suit the print job. Setting Details “Color” Enables color printing. “Monochrome” Disables color printing and converts image from continuous color to grayscaled monochrome. “Color (CAD)” Prints lines in the best color possible so they are easy to see. “Monochrome Bitmap” Prints all colors other than white in black. “Monochrome (BK ink)” Select to print all lines with black ink. Note • The availability of settings depends on the print priority and media type selections. “Color Adjustment” / “Matching” You can set the color adjustment and matching. • Color Adjustment (→P.514) • Matching (→P.516) “Restore Defaults” Button Click the button to reset to the setting when starting Free Layout. “Print” Button Click the button to begin printing. “Update Printer Info.” Button Click the button to acquire printer information. Mac OS X Software 513 Free Layout Color Adjustment You can set the color adjustment. Adjusting Color Normally colors should be adjusted in the software application, but if you see colors in the printout that do not match colors on the screen, you can perform color adjustments. 1. 2. Select “Color” on “Color Mode” in the Color Settings panel. 3. Drag each slider to the left or right to adjust. Select “Color Adjustment”. Setting Details “Cyan” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Magenta” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Yellow” Adjusts the strength of colors to compensate the hues. “Brightness” Adjusts the brightness of the entire image. When the results of the printout are brighter than the original images such as the original photo before scanning and graphics created on the display, or when you want to print in different degrees of brightness, use this feature. “Contrast” Adjusts the relative brightness between the brightest and darkest portions of the image. *For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. “Saturation” Adjusts the hues for vivid color or dark color. “Gray Tone” Adjusts gray from cool black (bluish tones) to warm black (reddish tones). Note • You can also click the up or down arrow, or enter the number directly to increase or decrease the value. 514 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Adjusting Monochrome Use the monochrome setting to print monochrome images of color photographs captured with a scanner or digital camera or other color images. 1. 2. Select “Monochrome” on “Color Mode” in the Color Settings panel. 3. Drag each slider to the left or right to adjust. Select “Color Adjustment”. Setting Details “Brightness” Adjusts the brightness of the entire image. When the results of the printout are brighter than the original images such as the original photo before scanning and graphics created on the display, or when you want to print in different degrees of brightness, use this feature. “Contrast” Adjusts the relative brightness between the brightest and darkest portions of the image. *For soft gradation, decrease the contrast. For hard gradation, increase the contrast. Note • You can also click the up or down arrow, or enter the number directly to increase or decrease the value. Mac OS X Software 515 Free Layout Matching You can set the matching. “Matching Mode” You can select a matching mode to suit the print job. Setting Details Driver Matching Mode (→P.518) Independent driver color matching is performed. ICC Matching Mode (→P.519) Color matching using ColorGear is performed. ColorSync (→P.520) Color matching using CMM from Mac OS is performed. “No Correction” No color matching is performed. Select this option when you want to perform color matching in the software application. Note • You need to set each correction on the printer driver. “Matching Method” You can select a matching method to suit the print job. “Input Prole” Select the input prole. Note • You can select only after ICC Matching Mode has been selected in “Matching Mode”. “Printer Prole” Select the printer prole. Note • You can select only after ICC Matching Mode or “ColorSync” has been selected in “Mode”. 516 Mac OS X Software Free Layout “Soft Proof” When you place a checkmark here, “ColorSync” applies to the layout area. Note • You can select only after “ColorSync” has been selected in “Matching Mode”. Mac OS X Software 517 Free Layout Driver Matching Mode 1. Under “Matching Mode”, select Driver Matching Mode. 2. Click the “Matching Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting Details “Auto” Automatically selects the best color matching method for each Image, Graphics, Text. “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. Saturation Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. 518 Mac OS X Software Free Layout ICC Matching Mode 1. Under “Matching Mode”, select ICC Matching Mode. 2. Click the “Matching Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting 3. 4. Details “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. Saturation Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. Colorimetric (No White-Point Correction) Performs Colorimetric color matching but without white point correction. Click the “Input Prole” list and select an input prole. Click the “Printer Prole” list and select a printer prole. Mac OS X Software 519 Free Layout ColorSync 1. Check that “ColorSync” is selected in “Matching Mode”. 2. Place a checkmark on “Soft Proof” to simulate the output product in Layout Area. 520 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Preferences Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Preferences” from the “imagePROGRAF Advanced Preview” menu. You can set the preferences for Free Layout. “Units” Set the unit for paper length, margins, and so on. “Gridlines” You can input a grid line width value in numerical characters so that they serve as a guide to laying out objects. Note • You can input between 10.0 and 200.0(mm) (between 0.39 and 7.87(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Divisions” You can change the number of divisions of grid lines so that they serve as a guide to laying out objects. Note • You can input between 1 and 10. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Grid Color” Select the grid line color. “Print Object Frames” You can print the object border. Note • If you do not want to print the object border, deselect the “Print Object Frames” check box. “Object Frame Style” You can select the object frame style for printing. The following settings are available for the object frame style. Setting Details “Solid Line” You can print the solid line as the frame style. “Dotted Line” You can print the dotted line as the frame style. “Dashed Line” You can print the dashed line as the frame style. Mac OS X Software 521 Free Layout Auto Arrange Spacing Change the object-to-object spacing to be applied in the operation of laying out objects automatically. Note • You can input between 0.0 and 100.0(mm) (between 0.00 and 3.94(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. 522 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Page Setup Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Page Setup” from the “File” menu.This dialog box provides selections for setting the media size, orientation and other important features. “Paper Orientation” This selects the paper orientation. The following settings are available for orientation. Setting Details “Vertical” Prints the image and text created with the application software in the orientation as it is. “Horizontal” Prints the image and text by rotating sideways 90 degrees from the orientation as specied in the application. “Roll Paper Length” Set the length of one page to print on roll paper. When you place a checkmark on “Auto Settings”, the one-page length to be printed on roll paper is automatically set so that the laid-out objects are printed on one page. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. • You can input between 203.2 and 18000.0(mm) (between 8.00 and 708.66(inch)). • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Order” Set the object layout order. The following settings are available for order. Setting Details “Upper Left to Right” The objects are laid out from upper left to right. “Upper Left to Bottom” The objects are laid out from upper left to bottom. Note • When you have selected “Roll Paper Length” > “Auto Settings” and “Paper Orientation” > “Vertical”, you can choose only “Upper Left to Right”. • When you have selected “Roll Paper Length” > “Auto Settings” and “Paper Orientation” > “Horizontal”, you can choose only “Upper Left to Bottom”. Mac OS X Software 523 Free Layout Paper Size You can select the size of the print media. Note • You cannot display this if “Roll Paper” is selected in Paper Source. Zoom Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Zoom” from the “View” menu. You can enlarge or reduce the screen display. Scaling Set the magnication for enlargement or reduction of the screen display. Note • You can input between 10 and 400. • You can change the numbers by clicking “▼” button. 524 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Format Dialog Box This dialog box appears when you select “Format” from the “Object” menu after you select an object. You can rotate, enlarge, or reduce an object. Note • When the objects are not selected, you can not select “Format”. “Rotate” When you place a checkmark here, you can select “Rotate Right” or “Rotate Left”. Setting Details “Rotate Right” Rotates the object 90 degrees clockwise. “Rotate Left” Rotates the object 90 degrees counterclockwise. Note • When several objects are selected, you cannot select “Rotate”. Scaling You can input the value for enlargement or reduction of the obeject in numerical characters. Note • You can input between 25 and 400. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. “Object Size” You can conrm the object size. Note • When several objects are selected, you cannot display “Object Size”. Mac OS X Software 525 Free Layout Laying out a Multiple-File Document on One Page You can lay out and print a multiple-le document on one page. 1. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 2. 3. Click on “Free Layout” in the “Page Setup” panel to attach a checkmark. In the “Print” dialog box, select the pages to print and the number of copies, and click the “Print” button. Free Layout starts, laying out the document created with application software in the layout area as an object. 4. Leaving Free Layout running, open other les with the application software and repeat the above steps. Laying out a Document Created with Multiple Application Programs on One Page You can lay out and print a document created with multiple application programs on one page. 1. From the application software’s “File” menu, select the printer setup menu to open the “Print” dialog box. Note • Normally, select “Print” from the “File” menu. 2. 3. Click on “Free Layout” in the “Page Setup” panel to attach a checkmark. In the “Print” dialog box, select the pages to print and the number of copies, and click the “Print” button. Free Layout starts, laying out the document created with application software in the layout area as an object. 4. Leaving Free Layout running, open the les with other application software and repeat the above steps. 526 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Selecting an Object When an object is selected, a select box (blue border) appears around the object. Note • • • • To select an object, click that object. To select multiple successive objects, click them while holding down the shift key. To select multiple arbitrary objects, click them while holding down the command key. To select all objects, select “Select All” from the “Edit” menu. Mac OS X Software 527 Free Layout Changing the Object Size You can change the object size by means of mouse operation or by specifying a scaling value. Note • The vertical-to-horizontal ratio remains unchanged when the object is enlarged or reduced. Resizing by means of mouse operation 1. 2. Select an object. Place the pointer at a corner of the selection box around the object to show the arrow handle, and drag this handle to change the object size. Resizing by specifying a scaling value 1. 2. 3. Select an object. Open the Format Dialog Box. (→P.525) Use Scaling to set the magnication for enlargement or reduction. You either enter numbers directly. Note • You can input between 25 and 400. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. 4. Click the “OK” button. 528 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Moving an Object You can move the object position. 1. 2. Select an object. Place the pointer inside the selection box of the object to show the crosshair handle, and drag it to move the object. Rotating an Object You can rotate the object. 1. 2. Select an object. Select “Rotate Left” or “Rotate Right” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may click on the “Rotate” check box in the Format Dialog Box (→P.525) then select “Rotate Right” or “Rotate Left”, and click the “OK” button. Note • When several objects are selected, you cannot select “Rotate”. Mac OS X Software 529 Free Layout Laying out Objects Automatically Click “Auto Arrange” in the tool bar. This automatically lays out objects. Alternatively, you may select “Auto Arrange Object” from the “Object” menu. Note • The object layout order varies depending on the “Order” setting on the Page Setup Dialog Box. (→P.523) 530 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Aligning Objects You can align objects systematically. 1. 2. Select multiple objects. Select the align menu from the “Object” menu. “Align Top” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the top. “Center Vertically” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the vertical center. “Align Bottom” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the bottom. Mac OS X Software 531 Free Layout “Align Left” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the left. “Center Horizontally” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the horizontal center. “Align Right” Lays out the objects, justifying them to the right. 532 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Changing the Object Overlapping Order You can change the object overlapping order. 1. 2. Select an object. Select the overlapping order menu from the “Object” menu. “Bring to Front” Moves the object to the frontmost position. “Send to Back” Moves the object to the backmost position. Mac OS X Software 533 Free Layout “Bring Forward” Moves the object one position to the front. “Send Backward” Moves the object one position to the back. 534 Mac OS X Software Free Layout Pasting a Copied or Cut Object 1. Click “Copy” or “Cut” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may select “Copy” or “Cut” from the “Edit” menu. 2. Click “Paste” from the toolbar. Alternatively, you may select “Paste” from the “Edit” menu. Note • The copied or cut object is laid out at the end of the page. Mac OS X Software 535 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy The Features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy The main features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy are as follows. • Allows the document scanned with the Color imageRUNNER to be automatically enlarged and printed. • You can perform basic printer settings such as printer selection, media type and output prole selection, and matching methods, in addition to borderless printing and enlargement/reduction process without growing through the printer driver. Note • The media type, image size, detailed media settings, and the printer settings can cause the actual print output to differ from the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy settings. Operating Environment You can use the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy in the following environments. • Compatible Operating System Mac OS X (10.3.9 to 10.5) • Software that requires installation imagePROGRAF Printer Driver 536 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Follow the procedure below to start the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. 1. Open the “Utility” panel of the “Print” dialog box. Note • Your printer is depicted in the lower-left area of this screen. 2. Click the “Set” button in “Congure Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. Note • If you click on the “Monitor Hot Folder Constantly” check box in the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, the icon of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility will appear on the Dock when starting OS X thereafter. • You can also start the utility directly by clicking on the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.app” icon in “Applications” > “Canon Utilities” > “iR Enlargement Copy”. Mac OS X Software 537 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Dialog Box The explanation below is on the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. Note • For the step to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, see “Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. (→P.537) “Delete les in the folder” From the Hot Folder list, select a hot folder and click the “Delete” button to delete only les in the hot folder. “Delete the entire folders, as well as items in the list above” From the Hot Folder list, select a hot folder and click the “Delete” button to delete the hot folder. “Delete” Button Select “Delete les in the folder” or “Delete the entire folders, as well as items in the list above” and click this button to delete the hot folder or only les in the hot folder. “Add” Button Click the button to open the “Destination Selection” dialog box so that you can add a hot folder. “Edit” Button From the Hot Folder list, select a hot folder and click this button to open the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box that allows you to edit the hot folder. “Monitor Hot Folder Constantly” If you click on the check box, the icon of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy utility will appear on the Dock when starting OS X thereafter. 538 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Hot Folder Hot folder refers to a folder used for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. • When transferred to the PC’s hot folder, the document data scanned with the Color imageRUNNER is printed in enlarged size from the printer according to the print conditions set in the hot folder. • You can create a new hot folder, edit or delete an existing one, and set print conditions at will. Note • You can create up to 10 hot folders. Creating a New Hot Folder 1. Open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. Note • For the step to open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box, see “Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy”. (→P.537) 2. Click the “Add” button in “Enlarged Copy Settings” to open the “Destination Selection” dialog box. 3. From the printer list in “Destination”, select the printer of destination. Mac OS X Software 539 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy 4. Click the “OK” button to open the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. 5. 6. 7. In “Name”, enter the name to display in the Hot Folder list. In “Hot Folder”, enter the Hot Folder name. Click the “OK” button. The created Hot Folder is listed in the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. 8. 9. 10. 11. Click the “Close” button to close the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. From the “Apple” Menu, open the “Sharing” dialog box for “System Preferences”. Select the check box labeled “File Sharing”, and click the “Options” button. Select the check box labeled “Share les and folders using FTP” and “Share les and folders using SMB” to make shared settings. Note • You can create up to 10 hot folders. 540 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Editing a Hot Folder (Setting Print Conditions) 1. Open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. 2. 3. 4. Select the Hot Folder from the Hot Folder list. From “Enlarged Copy Settings”, click “Edit” button to open the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. Make the necessary settings in the Paper Settings Panel. (→P.544) Mac OS X Software 541 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy 5. Make the necessary settings in the Output Settings Panel. (→P.549) 6. Make the necessary settings in the Color Settings Panel. (→P.551) 7. 8. 9. 10. Click the “OK” button to close the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. From the “Apple” Menu, open the “Sharing” dialog box for “System Preferences”. Select the check box labeled “File Sharing”, and click the “Options” button. Select the check box labeled “Share les and folders using FTP” and “Share les and folders using SMB” to make shared settings. Note • If you’ve made shared settings when you created a new Hot Folder, you do not need to execute steps 8 to 10. 542 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Deleting a Hot Folder 1. Open the “Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy” dialog box. 2. 3. Select the Hot Folder you want to delete from the Hot Folder list. Select “Delete the entire folders, as well as items in the list above”, and then click the “Delete” button. 4. Read the messag,e and then click the “OK” button. Note • Select “Delete les in the folder” to delete only les in the hot folder. Mac OS X Software 543 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Setting the Print Parameters You can set the print conditions in the setting panels within the “Add/Edit Hot Folder” dialog box. The settings available on each panel are as follows. • Paper Settings Panel (→P.544) • Output Settings Panel (→P.549) • Color Settings Panel (→P.551) Paper Settings Panel “Easy Settings” / “Advanced Settings” Two modes are available to provide the optimum print settings for jobs. The settings available on each mode are as follows. • Easy Settings (→P.546) • Advanced Settings (→P.548) “Media Type” This allows you to select the media type. Note • Always select media type that is actually set in the printer. When the media you chose is different from the media set in the printer, you may not receive the desired print results. Paper Source You can select the paper source. The following settings are available for paper source. Setting Details “Manual” Select for manual paper feed printing. “Roll Paper” Select to print on roll paper. 544 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy “Roll Paper Width” This selects the width of the roll media set to the printer. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. Automatic Cutting You can set the printer to cut roll paper automatically or print a guideline for cutting. The following settings are available for automatic cutting. Setting Details “Printer Default” The value set on the printer operation panel takes priority. “None” Each page is not cut after it is printed and printing continues without interruption. Print Cut Guideline A print cut guideline is printed after each page and printing continues without interruption. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. “Copies” You can input the number of print copies in numerical characters. Note • The maximum value is 999. • You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. Mac OS X Software 545 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Easy Settings You can easily select the best settings for the print job by just selecting an item from the print target list that matches the content of the document. “Print Target” You can easily select the best settings for the print job simply. If you select each “Print Target” item the corresponding comment for that item is displayed below the list. Setting Details “Default Settings” Suitable for printing normal documents that contain a mixture of text, photographs, and graphics. “Ofce Document” Suitable for printing handouts as well as general ofce documents for which print clarity is key. “Poster” The best setting for posters.Prints using vivid and high impact colors. “CAD (Color Line Drawing)” Prints the ne lines of CAD drawings and other such documents sharp and clear. CAD (B/W Line Drawing) Suitable for printing CAD drawings with sharp, dark lines. “Perspective, GIS” Suitable for attractive printing of 3D-CAD drawings, perspective drawings, and GIS drawings including maps. “Photo (Color)” Suitable for printing photographic images captured with a digital camera. “Faithful Color Reproduction” Prints by faithfully reproducing the colors of the original image. “Custom Settings” Suitable for printing documents for which Advanced Settings have been specied. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. 546 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. Mac OS X Software 547 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Advanced Settings Presents detailed settings for the print priority, the print quality, and other items so you can select the values for these settings yourself. “Print Priority” Select a print quality mode that is appropriate for the print job. Setting Details “Image” This mode achieves the best results for printing photographic images and illustrations. “Line Drawing” This mode is best for printing CAD drawings with ne lines or wall newssheet or other documents that contain large amounts of text. However, you may not achieve the quality you expect with printing photographs or other images with many lled areas. For these types of jobs, select “Image”. “Ofce Document” Prints common ofce documents, such as proposals, memos for distribution, etc., so they are easy to read. Note • The number of settings available for selection depends on the media type. “Print Quality” Selecting print quality strikes a balance between the quality of the printed image and printing speed. The level of the print quality and resolution settings are displayed in the following combinations. Setting Details Print Quality “Highest” / “High” / “Standard” / “Draft” Resolution “1200dpi” / “600dpi” / “300dpi” Note • The availability of settings is determined by the media type and print priority selections. • Printing time is longer and more ink is consumed with High than with Draft, however, print quality is higher. • Printing time is shorter and less ink is consumed with Draft than with High, however, print quality is lower. 548 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Output Settings Panel “Enlarged/Reduced Printing” Select the method for enlarged/reduced printing. The following settings are available for enlarged/reduced printing. Setting Details Fit Paper Size Enlarges/reduces the whole page automatically to t the media size selected for output. Select the media size to print from Paper Size. “Fit Roll Paper Width” Enlarges/reduces the whole page automatically to t the width of the roll paper with the page width. *Make sure that the width of the roll paper in the printer is set correctly for “Roll Paper Width” in the Paper Settings panel. *Displayed only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. Scaling Enlarges/reduces the whole page by the scaling rate as specied. Input the scaling value in numerical characters. You can specify a range between 5 and 600%. *You can change the numbers by clicking either “▲” button or “▼” button. *Although Scaling can be set to make the image larger than the media size, the part that does not t in the media cannot be printed. *This is not displayed when a checkmark is placed in “Borderless Printing”. “Borderless Printing” You can print the media without margins on all sides when the roll paper with the specic width and the specic media type is used. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. Paper Size You can select the size of the print media. Note • This is not displayed when “Fit Roll Paper Width” is set in “Enlarged/Reduced Printing”. Mac OS X Software 549 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy “Print Centered” Select this feature to print the image in the center of a cut sheet or to print left and right margins evenly from the edges of roll paper. Note • This feature is useful when you print the document enlarged or reduced with Scaling as well. When an image is scaled, it is always enlarged or reduced in reference to a starting point in the upper left corner of the page. If the image is reduced, the bottom and right margins are enlarged and the top and left margins remain unchanged. At that point, you can set all margins evenly with this feature. “No Spaces at Top or Bottom” You can set the printer to print without any empty area when the print data contains empty area at the top or bottom. Since the printer does not feed paper over the empty area, you can save paper. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. “Rotate Page” Select the method for rotating page. The following settings are available for rotating page. Setting Details “Rotate Right 90 Degrees” Rotates the portrait page right 90 degrees and print in landscape orientation. When the rotated page can t in the width of roll paper, the page is rotated automatically, and when it can not t in the width of roll paper, the page is not rotated. *When “Fit Roll Paper Width” is selected under “Enlarged/Reduced Printing”, then the image is enlarged or reduced after rotating to t the width of the roll paper. “Rotate Left 90 Degrees” Rotates the portrait page left 90 degrees and print in landscape orientation. When the rotated page can t in the width of roll paper, the page is rotated automatically, and when it can not t in the width of roll paper, the page is not rotated. *When “Fit Roll Paper Width” is selected under “Enlarged/Reduced Printing”, then the image is enlarged or reduced after rotating to t the width of the roll paper. “Rotate 180 degrees” Allows you to rotate the image 180 degrees from the vertical to the right. Note • Available only if rolls are selected in Paper Source. “Output Method” Button Click the button to open the “Output Method” dialog box. In this dialog box, you can specify the object output method. Note • To print after saving jobs in the temporary storage space, select “Save data before printing”. 550 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Color Settings Panel “Color Mode” You can select a color mode to suit the print job. Setting Details “Color” Enables color printing. “Monochrome” Disables color printing and converts image from continuous color to grayscaled monochrome. “Color (CAD)” Prints lines in the best color possible so they are easy to see. “Monochrome Bitmap” Prints all colors other than white in black. “Monochrome (BK ink)” Select to print all lines with black ink. Note • The availability of settings depends on the print priority and media type selections. “Mode” Under “Mode”, select the matching mode. Setting Details Driver Matching Mode (→P.552) Independent driver color matching is performed. ICC Matching Mode (→P.553) Color matching using ColorGear is performed. ColorSync (→P.554) Color matching using CMM from Mac OS is performed. “No Correction” No color matching is performed. Select this option when you want to perform color matching in the software application. Mac OS X Software 551 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Driver Matching Mode 1. Under “Mode”, select Driver Matching Mode. 2. Click “Matching Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting Details “Auto” Automatically selects the best color matching method for each Image, Graphics, Text. “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. Saturation Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. 552 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy ICC Matching Mode 1. Under “Mode”, select ICC Matching Mode. 2. Click “Method” list, and then select a setting. Setting 3. Details “Perceptual” Gives priority to color hue in color matching suitable for output of photographic images. “Saturation” Gives priority to vividness in color matching. Colorimetric Gives priority to reducing the differences in color between the original as it appears on the screen and the printed output. Colorimetric (No White-Point Correction) Performs Colorimetric color matching but without white point correction. Click the “Input Prole” list, and then select an input prole. Note • To match the color on the printing, select the input prole for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy of the Color imageRUNNER type in use. 4. Click the “Printer Prole” list, and then select a printer prole. Mac OS X Software 553 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy ColorSync 1. Under “Mode”, select “ColorSync”. 2. Click the “Printer Prole” list, and then select a printer prole. Note • Available when using Mac OS X 10.3.9-10.4. 554 Mac OS X Software Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Mac OS X) Scanned originals from a Color imageRUNNER can be enlarged and printed automatically. Originals you create by scanning with a Color imageRUNNER are transferred to a "hot folder" and printed automatically after enlargement according to printing conditions you specify for that folder. This processing sequence is called the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy function. To use Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy, rst complete these settings in the following order. 1. Register a hot folder on your computer. Register a hot folder on your computer for storing scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER and complete the settings for enlargement copy. 2. Complete the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER. Congure the Color imageRUNNER to send scanned originals to the hot folder. After these settings are complete, you can print enlarged copies of scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER. Registering a hot folder on your computer Folders used for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy (iR enlargement copy) are called hot folders. Register a hot folder on your computer for storing scanned originals from the Color imageRUNNER. You can specify printing conditions (such as the image quality and paper size), based on which originals transferred to the hot folder will be printed. Follow these steps to register and modify hot folders. 1. To display the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy dialog box, either double-click the Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.app icon after navigating to Canon Utilities - “iR Enlargement Copy” in the Applications folder or click C Set in the Utility pane 2. In Enlarged Copy Settings, click Add or Edit and either create or modify the hot folder. For instructions on registering and modifying hot folders, refer to the help le for Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. Mac OS X Software 555 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Completing the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER. Congure the Color imageRUNNER to send scanned originals to the hot folder. It is easy to send scanned originals to the hot folder if you assign the scanning settings and destination to a Favorites button on the Color imageRUNNER. For instructions on assigning scanning and sending settings to the Favorites button, refer to the Color imageRUNNER manual. Scanning the original and print an enlargement Follow the steps below to scan an original on the Color imageRUNNER for enlarged printing on the printer. For detailed instructions, refer to the Color imageRUNNER manual. 1. 2. 3. 4. Load the original on the platen glass or document feeder of the Color imageRUNNER. Press Send to display the screen for transmission. Press Favorites, and then press the Favorites button assigned to the hot folder. Press Start on the control panel. If you scan originals on the platen glass, after scanning all originals, press Done on the touch-panel display. Scanned originals are sent to the hot folder and automatically enlarged and printed following the conditions you specied for the folder. Note • For details on Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy, see Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy. 556 Mac OS X Software Printmonitor Printmonitor The Features of imagePROGRAF Printmonitor “imagePROGRAF Printmonitor” is a utility for checking the printer status and managing print jobs. • • • • Printer status can be checked in real time on a computer monitor. You can check the status of print jobs, cancel jobs, and manage them as needed. If a printer error occurs, you can investigate the corrective action immediately. You can also set up automatic email notication of any printer problems or errors to email addresses you designate in advance. Note • If the status of the desired printer is not shown in imagePROGRAF Printmonitor, select the printer again as follows. 1. Make sure the printer is on and connected to the network or to a local port. 2. In the Printer menu, select the name of the desired printer. After the printer is detected, the printer status is shown. 3. If information about the printer is not shown in step 2, choose Search Printer in the Printer menu. Printer names listed in the Printer menu are updated with the printers that are now detected. 4. In the Printer menu, select the name of the desired printer. After the printer is detected, the printer status is shown. Mac OS X Software 557 Printmonitor Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Printmonitor You can use the Driver Panel in imagePROGRAF Status Monitor for operations such as pausing and canceling print jobs. Preempting Other Jobs If you select a print job and click the precedes it in the print queue. button, the selected job is printed ahead of the job that currently Pausing/Resuming Print Jobs Selecting a print job and clicking the button pauses printing of the selected job. To resume printing of a paused print job, select the print job and click the button. Note • Once all the print data for a print job has been sent to the printer, the job can no longer be paused/resumed. Canceling Print Jobs Selecting a print job and clicking the button cancels printing of the selected job. Note • You cannot cancel other users’ print jobs. 558 Mac OS X Software Printmonitor Printing Held Jobs Printing of the job with a “Status” of “Holding” is paused because the paper specied by the driver does not match the paper currently loaded in the printer. Use the procedure below to print the held job. 1. 2. Select the held job and click the “Replace Paper” button. Replace the paper in the printer with the correct paper. Note • To continue printing without changing the paper in the printer, select the held job and click “Continue to print” button. Mac OS X Software 559 Network Setting Network Setting Network Setting Network Environment System requirements The system requirements, which vary depending on your network, are as follows. • Printing over a TCP/IP network (when using IPv4) • Compatible operating systems • Windows 2000 (Professional or Server) • Windows XP (Home Edition or Professional) • Windows Server 2003 (Standard Edition) • Windows Vista (Home Basic/Business/Ultimate) • Windows Server 2008 (Standard Edition or Enterprise Edition) • Windows XP Professional x64 Edition • Windows Server 2003 x64 Edition • Windows Vista x64 • Windows Server 2008 x64 • Mac OS X 10.2.8 or later • Unix (Solaris 9) • Unix (Red Hat 9) • Compatible computer • A computer that runs one of the above operating systems • Printing over a TCP/IP network (when using IPv6) • Compatible operating systems • Windows Vista (Home Basic/Business/Ultimate) • Windows Server 2008 (Standard Edition or Enterprise Edition) • Windows Vista x64 • Windows Server 2008 x64 • Mac OS X 10.3.9 or later Note • When using IPv6, you must specify IPv6 on the Control Panel or in RemoteUI. For instructions, see “Conguring TCP/IPv6 Network Settings”. (→P.568) or see “Conguring the Printer’s TCP/IP Network Settings”. (→P.570) • The imagePROGRAF printer driver is supported in Mac OS X 10.3.9 or later. 560 Network Setting Network Setting • Printing over an AppleTalk network • Compatible operating systems • Mac OS X 10.2.8-10.4 • Compatible computer • A computer that runs one of the above operating systems Note • The printer cannot be used over a LocalTalk network. • Compatible with EtherTalk Phase 2. • The imagePROGRAF printer driver is not compatible with AppleTalk. • Printing over a NetWare network • Compatible servers • Novell NetWare 4.2/5.1/6.0 • Compatible clients • Windows 2000 (Professional or Server) • Windows XP (Professional) • Compatible computer • A computer that runs one of the above operating systems Note • In NetWare 6.0, iPrint is not supported. Network Setting 561 Network Setting Network Environment After conrming what type of network environment you will connect the printer to, set up the printer and computers as needed. • Example of a Windows network In Windows networks, print over TCP/IP. Note • NetBIOS is not supported. • Example of a Macintosh network In Macintosh networks, print over AppleTalk (EtherTalk) or TCP/IP, using Bonjour (Zeroconf) functions. Note • The imagePROGRAF printer driver is not compatible with AppleTalk. • Example of a NetWare network Note • Even if there is a NetWare server in your network environment, you can use it in conjunction with TCP/IP or AppleTalk. In this case, complete the settings for each protocol you will use. 562 Network Setting Network Setting Conguring the IP Address on the Printer You must congure the printer’s IP address before using the printer in a TCP/IP network. The printer’s IP address is congured automatically when you install the printer driver following the instructions in the Setup Guide. Congure the IP address by using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility, the printer Control Panel, or ARP or PING commands, if the IP address is changed, or if you change the printer connection mode to a network connection. For details on conguring the IP address, refer to the following topics. • Conguring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility (→P.564) • Conguring the IP Address Using the Printer Control Panel (→P.565) • Conguring the IP Address Using ARP and PING Commands (→P.567) Important • If you use a DHCP server for automatic assignment of the printer’s IP address, printing may no longer be possible after the printer is turned off and on. This is because an IP address different from before has been assigned. Thus, when using DHCP server functions, consult your network administrator and congure the settings in one of the following ways. • Congure the setting for dynamic DNS updating In RemoteUI, activate the setting Enable DNS Dynamic Update. (→P.570) • Congure the setting for assignment of the same IP address each time the printer starts up Note • We recommend conguring the printer’s IP address even if you will use the printer in networks other than TCP/IP networks. Conguring the printer’s IP address enables you to use RemoteUI to congure the network settings and manage the printer with a web browser. For details on RemoteUI, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) Network Setting 563 Network Setting Conguring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility On a computer running Windows, you can use imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility provided with the printer to congure the printer’s IP address. This topic describes how to congure the IP address using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Important • To congure network settings, you must be logged in with administrative rights such as “Administrator” account. We recommend that your network administrator congure the network settings. • For instructions on installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility, see “Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility”. (→P.452) When specifying an IPv4 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv4 tab. In the Setting IP Address list, choose Manual. Enter the IP address assigned to the printer and click the Set button. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Note • To congure the IP address automatically, choose Auto in the Setting IP Address list and select DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP. • You can also specify the subnet mask and default gateway. When specifying an IPv6 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv6 tab. In IPv6, select On. When there is an IPv6-compatible router in the network environment, select On in Stateless Address. Additionally, when there is an DHCPv6-compatible server in the network environment, select On in DHCPv6. Note • When there is no IPv6-compatible router or DHCPv6-compatible server, select On in Manual and enter the IPv6 Address and Prex Length. 7. 8. 9. Click Set. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. 564 Network Setting Network Setting Conguring the IP Address Using the Printer Control Panel This topic describes how to congure the printer’s IP address on the Control Panel. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select TCP/IP, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select IPv4, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select IPv4 Settings, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select IP Address, and then press the OK button. After you press ◄ or ► to select the input eld, numerical input is possible. Press the ▲ or ▼ button to enter the value. Note • Pressing the ▲ button increases the number by 1. The maximum value is “9,” after which “0” is displayed. • Pressing the ▼ button decreases the number by 1. The minimum value is “0,” after which “9” is displayed. • Hold down ▲ or ▼ to increase or decrease the value continuously. • Make sure the IP address you enter for the printer is not the same as any computer IP address in your network. 10. 11. Repeat steps 8 and 9 to complete the settings, and then press the OK button. Press the Menu button. If you have changed the settings, a conrmation message is displayed. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. Network Setting 565 Network Setting Important • Be sure to complete step 11. This will activate the values you have entered. • You can also specify the subnet mask and default gateway on the Control Panel. Note • If an error message is displayed, check the settings and correct any invalid values. 566 Network Setting Network Setting Conguring the IP Address Using ARP and PING Commands This topic describes how to congure the IP address using ARP and PING commands. To use the ARP and PING commands, you will need to know the printer’s MAC address. You can conrm the MAC address on the Control Panel. 1. Check the printer’s MAC address. You can conrm the MAC address on the Control Panel as follows: 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Ethernet Driver, and then press the OK button. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select MAC Address, and then press the OK button. Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. • You can investigate the MAC address by printing an interface setting report. (→P.65) 2. 3. In Windows, open a command prompt, or in Mac OS X, start Terminal. Execute the following command to add entries to the ARP table for managing IP addresses and corresponding MAC addresses. arp -s [IP address] [the printer’s MAC address you have veried] Example: arp -s xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx 00-1E-8F-xx-xx-xx Note • In Mac OS X when using Terminal, enter the arp command in the format “arp -s xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx 00:1E:8F:xx:xx:xx.” For details, refer to the help le for the command line. 4. Execute the following command to send the IP address to the printer and congure it. ping [IP address as specied in the ARP command] -l 479 Example: ping xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx -l 479 Note • In “-l,” the “l” is the letter “l”. • In Mac OS X when using Terminal, enter the ping command in the format “ping -s 479 xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx.” For details, refer to the help le for the command line. Network Setting 567 Network Setting Note • The subnet mask and default gateway are set to “0.0.0.0.” Use RemoteUI to change the subnet mask and default gateway to match your network settings. For details on RemoteUI, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) Conguring TCP/IPv6 Network Settings When printing in a TCP/IPv6 network, you must congure the TCP/IPv6 settings on the Control Panel. Follow the steps below to congure the TCP/IPv6 network settings. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select TCP/IP, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select IPv6, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select IPv6 Support, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. Important • Once you set IPv6 Support to On, the IPv6 StlessAddrs setting takes effect. • You can also congure IPv6 StlessAddrs and DHCPv6 from the printer Control Panel. 568 Network Setting Network Setting Using RemoteUI Enter the printer’s IP address in a web browser to display the RemoteUI page. After you log on to RemoteUI from the page, you can check and change the status of the printer and print jobs, and congure network settings. To access RemoteUI, start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ For details on conguring printer settings for networks, refer to the following topics. • • • • Conguring the Printer’s TCP/IP Network Settings (→P.570) Conguring the Printer’s AppleTalk Network Settings (→P.574) Conguring the Printer’s NetWare Network Settings (→P.575) Specifying Printer-Related Information (→P.577) Note • RemoteUI also offers many other features. You can display the ink levels, check error messages and other status information, and cancel print jobs. • By factory default, the English screen is displayed. To change the display language, select the desired language under Language before logging on in administrator mode. Important • Use Netscape Navigator 6.0 or later, Internet Explorer 5.01 or later, or Firefox 1.5 or later as a web browser. In Mac OS X, you can also use Safari 1.32 or later or Safari 2.03 or later. • Access is not possible via a proxy server. In environments where a proxy server is used, add the printer’s IP address to Exceptions (addresses accessed without a proxy server) in the web browser proxy server settings. (Settings may vary depending on the network environment.) • Enable JavaScript and cookies in the web browser. • If you access RemoteUI with the printer name instead of its IP address, make sure the DNS settings are correctly congured. Network Setting 569 Network Setting Conguring the Printer’s TCP/IP Network Settings Follow the steps below to congure the TCP/IP network settings. When using an IPv4 IP address 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the TCP/IPv4 group to display the Edit TCP/IP Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the TCP/IP Settings Items table to complete the settings. TCP/IP Settings Items Item Default Setting Details Use DHCP Activate this setting to use DHCP for conguring the IP address. Off Use BOOTP Activate this setting to use BOOTP for conguring the IP address. Off Use RARP Activate this setting to use RARP for conguring the IP address. Off Enable DNS Dynamic Update Activate this setting to perform DNS server registration automatically. Off Use Zeroconf Function Activate this setting to use Bonjour. On IP Address Specify the printer’s IP address. 0.0.0.0 Subnet Mask Specify the printer’s subnet mask. 0.0.0.0 Gateway Address Specify the printer’s default gateway. 0.0.0.0 LPD Printing Activate this setting to use LDP Printing. On IPP Printing Activate this setting to use IPP Printing. On IPP Printer URI Specify the URI of the printer used for printer IPP printing using up to 252 characters. When using a standard Windows port for IPP printing, enter an URL which should not exceed 255 bytes for all characters for “http://"IP address"/IPP-URI.” RAW Printing Activate this setting to use Raw Printing. On RAW Mode Bi-direction Activate this setting to use Raw mode bidirectional communication. FTP Printing Activate this setting to use FTP Printing. On Use Discovery Activate this setting to use Discovery. On Scope Enter the search range. default 570 Network Setting Off Network Setting Item 7. Default Setting Details SMTP Server Address Specify the SMTP server’s IP address. You can also specify the SMTP server domain name, if desired. 0.0.0.0 Primary DNS Server Address Specify the IP address of the primary DNS server. 0.0.0.0 Secondary DNS Server Address Specify the IP address of the secondary 0.0.0.0 DNS server. DNS Host Name Specify the printer host name, up to 63 characters (1-63 characters). Use single-byte letters, numbers, and “-” (hyphens). Do not use numbers or “-” for the rst character or “-” for the last character. NB-18GBxxxxxxxxxxxx DNS Domain Name Specify the printer domain name, up to 63 characters. Use single-byte letters, numbers, “-” (hyphens), and “.” (periods). Do not use numbers, “-”, or “.” for the rst character, or “-” or “.” for the last character. blank Multicast DNS Service Name Specify the printer’s Multicast DNS service name. (1-63 characters) This name will be displayed when Bonjour functions are used. Canon iPFxxxx (xxxxxx) Click OK to display the Network page. Note • If you specify to congure the IP address using DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP, there must be a server that supports such protocol running in the network. • If you specify to congure the IP address using DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP, the IP address obtained by this method is used rst. If you cannot obtain the IP address, the address specied in IP Address is used. • It takes up to two minutes to determine whether DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP are available. We recommend clearing check boxes of options you will not use. • If you are using a DNS server, select Enable DNS Dynamic Update and enter the IP Address for DNS servers, DNS host name, and DNS domain name in Primary DNS Server Address, Secondary DNS Server Address, DNS Host Name, and DNS Domain Name, respectively. Network Setting 571 Network Setting When using an IPv6 IP address 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the TCP/IPv6 group to display the Edit TCP/IP Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the TCP/IP Settings Items table to complete the settings. TCP/IP Settings Items Item Default Setting Details Use IPv6 Activate to enable IPv6. Off Use a stateful address Activate when using a DHCP server to acquire the IP address. Off Use a stateless address Activate when using an IPv6-compatible On router to acquire the IP address. Use a manual address Activate when conguring the IP address manually. Off IP Address Enter the printer’s IP address. blank Prex Length Enter the IP address prex length. blank Default Router Address Enter the default router address. blank Prex Length Enter the prex length of the default router address. blank Primary DNS Server Address Specify the IP address of the primary DNS server. blank Secondary DNS Server Address Specify the IP address of the secondary blank DNS server. Use the same host name and domain name as IPv4 Activate when using the same DNS host Off and domain names as for IPv4. 572 Network Setting DNS Host Name Specify the printer host name, up to 63 characters (1-4 characters). Use single-byte letters, numbers, and “-” (hyphens). Do not use numbers or “-” for the rst character or “-” for the last character. NB-18GBip6xxxxxx DNS Domain Name Specify the printer domain name, up to 63 characters. Use single-byte letters, numbers, “-” (hyphens), and “.” (periods). Do not use numbers, “-”, or “.” for the rst character, or “-” or “.” for the last character. blank Network Setting Item 7. Default Setting Details Perform dynamic updating of stateful addresses Activate when assigning a stateful address dynamically. Off Dynamically update the stateless address Activate when assigning a stateless address dynamically. Off Dynamically update the manual address Activate when assigning a manual address dynamically. Off Click OK to display the Network page. Network Setting 573 Network Setting Conguring the Printer’s AppleTalk Network Settings Follow the steps below to congure the AppleTalk network settings. 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the AppleTalk group to display the Edit AppleTalk Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the AppleTalk Settings Items table to complete the settings. AppleTalk Settings Items Item Details Default Setting Phase Type Specify whether to use AppleTalk. Disabled If you will use AppleTalk, choose Phase 2. If you will not use AppleTalk, choose Disabled. Name (*1) Specify the object name used by Canon NB-18GB (xxxxxx) AppleTalk (in up to 31 single-byte or 15 double-byte characters). However, do not use the following single-byte characters: @, *, :, and =. Zone (*2) Specify the printer zone name, up * to 31 single-byte characters. However, do not use the following single-byte characters: Also avoid using “*” (which represents the default zone) in the middle of a string. *1: The object name you have specied in Name is displayed in Printer Setup Utility (or Print Center) in Mac OS X 10.2.8-10.4. If you use multiple printers in the same zone, assign a unique name to each printer. By default, the network interface name is “Canon NB-18GB (xxxxxx).” (Here, xxxxxx is the last six digits of the printer’s MAC address.) *2: If zones have been created on the network, enter the name of the printer’s zone. If there are no zones, leave the asterisk “*” entry (for the default zone) as it is. If you enter a network zone name that does not match created zones, the printer will not be detected by Macintosh computers. Consult your network administrator for information on zone names. 7. Click OK to display the Network page. 574 Network Setting Network Setting Conguring the Printer’s NetWare Network Settings Follow the steps below to congure the NetWare network settings. 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the NetWare group to display the Edit NetWare Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the NetWare Settings Items table to complete the settings. NetWare Settings Items Item Default Setting Details Frame Type Specify the type of frame to use in NetWare. NCP Burst Mode Activate this setting to use On NCP Burst Mode. This mode supports fast data transfer when printing in queue server mode. Normally, leave the setting On. Print Application Choose the print service. • Bindery PServer • RPrinter • NDS PServer • NPrinter Packet Signature Select If Requested by Server If Requested by Server to use packet signature. Bindery PServer File Server Name Specify the name of a le server that has a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Print Server Password Set a password for the print server. (0-20 characters) - Polling Interval Specify the interval to conrm jobs. (1-15 seconds) 5 Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) RPrinter Disabled NDS PServer Network Setting 575 Network Setting Item NDS PServer NPrinter 7. Printer Number Specify the number of the printer connected to the NetWare print server. (0-15) 0 Tree Name Specify the name of an NDS tree that has a NetWare print server. (0-32 characters) - Context Name Specify the name of a context that has a NetWare print server. (0-255 characters) Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-64 characters) Print Server Password Set a password for the print server. (0-20 characters) - Polling Interval Specify the interval to conrm jobs. (1-255 seconds) 5 Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Printer Number Specify the number of the printer connected to the NetWare print server. (0-254) Click OK to display the Network page. 576 Network Setting Default Setting Details 0 Network Setting Specifying Printer-Related Information Specify device information, security, and email notication settings as follows. 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Information in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Information page. To display the relevant settings page, click Edit in the upper-right corner of Device Information or Security, depending on what information you want to specify. To change the administrator password, click the Change Password button in the Security group. 6. Refer to the table of settings for device information, security, and email notication as you complete these settings. Security setting items are displayed when you click the Change Password button in the Security group. Device Information Settings Item Default Setting Details Device Name Enter a device name. (0-32 characters) blank Location Enter the location where the device is installed. (0-32 characters) blank Administrator Enter the administrator’s name. (0-32 characters) blank Phone Enter the administrator’s contact information. (0-32 characters) blank Comments(E-mail) Enter any comments regarding the administrator. (0-32 characters) blank Security Settings Item Default Setting Details New Password Enter the new password. (0-9999999) blank Conrm Enter the new password again to conrm it. (0-9999999) blank On the Security settings screen, besides entering a password, you can specify other security-related information, such as IP address-based SNMP or TCP usage restrictions, MAC address-based access restrictions, or IPP and FTP authentication settings. 7. Click OK to activate the settings. Network Setting 577 Network Setting Conguring the Communication Mode Manually This topic gives instructions for conguring the communication mode manually. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Ethernet Driver, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Auto Detect, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Off, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the Ethernet Driver menu. 7. 8. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Comm.Mode, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the communication mode, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the Ethernet Driver menu. 9. 10. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Ethernet Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the Ethernet type, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the Ethernet Driver menu. 11. 12. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Spanning Tree, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to enable or disable spanning tree support, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the Ethernet Driver menu. 13. Press the Menu button. After the conrmation message is displayed, press the OK button. The new settings will take effect after the printer restarts. 578 Network Setting Network Setting Email Notication When Printing is Finished or Errors Occur The printer can notify you of the printer status by email. Even when you are away from the printer, you can know when printing is nished or if errors occur. Receive notication via email on your mobile phone or at your computer. Use the imagePROGRAF Status Monitor (Windows) function to set up email recipients and message timing. Besides being informed of nished print jobs or errors, you can also complete settings for email notication when service is needed or it’s time to replace consumables. For detailed instructions,see “Specifying Printer-Related Information”. (→P.577) Note • For details on email notication using imagePROGRAF Status Monitor (in Windows), refer to the imagePROGRAF Status Monitor help. • Mail server authentication is only supported with imagePROGRAF Status Monitor. Network Setting 579 Network Setting Initializing the Network Settings Use RemoteUI to restore the network settings to the default values as follows. Important • Initializing the network settings will also restore the default value of the printer’s IP address. As a result, the RemoteUI page cannot be displayed in the web browser after this procedure. • For instructions on reconguring the IP address, see “Conguring the IP Address on the Printer”. (→P.563) • For details on RemoteUI, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Reset to Default settings in the lower-right corner of the Network Interface group. After conrming the message, click OK to restore the network settings to the default values. Note • You can also use imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility or the Control Panel to restore the default network settings. 580 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Network Setting (Windows) Conguring the Printer Driver Destination (Windows) This topic describes how to specify the printer driver destination if the printer’s IP address is changed, or if you will use the printer over a network connection instead of via USB connection. The procedure described below is the conguration based on the LPR or Raw protocol using the standard TCP/IP port in Windows (Standard TCP/IP Port). Important • If you will use the printer in a TCP/IP network, make sure the printer’s IP address is congured correctly. • Conguring the IP Address on the Printer (→P.563) 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Open the Printers and Faxes (or Printers) window. Right-click the icon of this printer and choose Properties to open the printer properties window. Click the Port tab to display the Port sheet. Click Add Port to display the Printer Ports dialog box. In the Available Port list, select Standard TCP/IP Port. Click New Port. After the wizard starts, a window is displayed for the Welcome to the Add Standard TCP/IP Printer Port Wizard. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. Click Next. In Printer Name or IP Address, enter the printer’s IP address. Follow the instructions on the screen to add a printer port. Click Close to close the Printer Ports dialog box. Make sure the printer port you added is displayed under Ports, and that the port is selected. Click Close to close the printer properties window. Network Setting 581 Network Setting (Windows) Sharing the Printer in Windows If you set up a computer as a print server in Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003, Windows Vista, or Windows Server 2008, the computer can receive print jobs sent from other computers (clients) connected to it for printing. This topic describes how to share the printer in Windows. Important • We recommend that your network administrator congure your network for printer sharing. 1. Open the Printers and Faxes (or Printers) window. 2. Right-click the icon of this printer and choose Sharing to open the printer properties window. 582 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) 3. On the Sharing sheet, click Share this printer and enter the shared name. 4. To print jobs from clients running other versions of Windows, click Additional Drivers and follow the instructions to install the printer driver of the corresponding version. If you are prompted to choose the location of the printer driver le, insert the provided User Software CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive and specify the folder where the printer driver is located. 5. Click OK. Important • When installing the printer driver on client computers, select "Network Printer" on the connection type screen in the printer wizard, and then select the printer shared from the computer set up as the print server. Network Setting 583 Network Setting (Windows) Conguring the Printer’s NetWare Network Settings Follow the steps below to congure the NetWare network settings. 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the NetWare group to display the Edit NetWare Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the NetWare Settings Items table to complete the settings. NetWare Settings Items Item Default Setting Details Frame Type Specify the type of frame to use in NetWare. NCP Burst Mode Activate this setting to use On NCP Burst Mode. This mode supports fast data transfer when printing in queue server mode. Normally, leave the setting On. Print Application Choose the print service. • Bindery PServer • RPrinter • NDS PServer • NPrinter Packet Signature Select If Requested by Server If Requested by Server to use packet signature. Bindery PServer File Server Name Specify the name of a le server that has a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Print Server Password Set a password for the print server. (0-20 characters) - Polling Interval Specify the interval to conrm jobs. (1-15 seconds) 5 Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) RPrinter 584 Network Setting Disabled NDS PServer Network Setting (Windows) Item NDS PServer NPrinter 7. Default Setting Details Printer Number Specify the number of the printer connected to the NetWare print server. (0-15) 0 Tree Name Specify the name of an NDS tree that has a NetWare print server. (0-32 characters) - Context Name Specify the name of a context that has a NetWare print server. (0-255 characters) Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-64 characters) Print Server Password Set a password for the print server. (0-20 characters) - Polling Interval Specify the interval to conrm jobs. (1-255 seconds) 5 Print Server Name Specify the name of a NetWare print server. (0-47 characters) Printer Number Specify the number of the printer connected to the NetWare print server. (0-254) 0 Click OK to display the Network page. Network Setting 585 Network Setting (Windows) Specifying the Printer’s Frame Type To enable communication between the printer and computers on your network, specify the Ethernet frame type in your NetWare environment. Follow these steps to specify the frame type by using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility or the printer Control Panel. Note • You can specify the frame type by using RemoteUI if the printer’s IP address is congured. Important • Before specifying the frame type, make sure the printer is on and connected to the network. • For instructions on installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility, see “Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility”. (→P.452) Specifying the frame type using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. In the list of printers, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Click the NetWare tab and select the frame type in the NetWare Frame Type list. Click the IPv4 tab and select ETHERNET II in the Frame Type list. In IP Address, enter the IP address assigned to the printer, and then enter the subnet mask in Subnet Mask and the default gateway in Gateway Address. Important • You must specify the IP address here to be able to congure NetWare protocol settings using RemoteUI. 7. 8. 9. Click Set. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. 586 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Specifying the frame type using the printer Control Panel 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select NetWare, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select NetWare, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the NetWare menu. 7. 8. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Frame Type, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the frame type to use, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the NetWare menu. 9. 10. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print Service, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired print service, and then press the OK button. The display reverts to the NetWare menu. 11. Press the Menu button. If any of the settings is changed, a conrmation message is displayed. In this case, press the OK button. Important • Be sure to complete step 11. This will activate the values you have entered. Note • If an error message is displayed, check the settings and correct any invalid values. • To cancel this process, press the Stop button. Network Setting 587 Network Setting (Windows) Specifying NetWare Print Services Before printing in a NetWare network, you must congure print services such as print servers, print queues, and so on. You can congure the print service settings from a computer using any of the following Novell software provided with NetWare. • NWADMIN • PCONSOLE Important • If you use NWADMIN to congure the print service settings, Novell Client (the Novell NetWare client software) must be installed as the client software application. • NetWare networking is unsupported in Windows Vista and Windows Server 2008. This topic gives instructions for conguring NetWare print services. The order of this procedure may vary depending on the environment. Choosing the type of print services Before completing print service settings, choose the type of print service. Refer to the following descriptions as needed. Note • In NetWare 5.1 or 6.0, NDPS may also be used as the print service. If you use NDPS, use the Novell printer gateway included with NetWare. For details on conguring NDPS, refer to the NetWare documentation. • NDS (Novell Directory Service) and bindery NDS and bindery are both supported. Use the mode that is compatible with your network environment. • Queue server mode and remote printer mode Queue server mode and remote printer mode are both supported. • Queue server mode When using queue server mode, all print server functions are supported, so there is no need for other print server software or hardware. In NDS queue server mode (NDS PServer), the NDS print server is used for printing. In bindery queue server mode (Bindery PServer), the bindery print server is used for printing. Note that if you use queue server mode, a NetWare user license is required for each network interface. • Remote printer mode In remote printer mode, the printer is controlled by the NetWare print server. Thus, a NetWare print server is required. In NDS remote printer mode (NPrinter), the NDS print server is used for printing, and in bindery remote printer mode (RPrinter), the bindery print server is used for printing. 588 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Using NWADMIN or PCONSOLE to set up the print server Use NWADMIN to set up the print server if NDS queue server mode or remote printer mode is used. 1. 2. Log into NetWare as Administrator or with equivalent rights, and then start NWADMIN. Run Quick Setup. 1. Choose Print Services Quick Setup in the Tools menu. 2. Enter a desired name in Print Server Name. To use an existing print server, click the button at right and choose the name from the list. 3. Enter a desired printer name in Name. 4. To use the printer in queue server mode, choose Other/Unknown in Type. To use the printer in remote printer mode, choose Parallel in Type, click Communications, and set Ports to LPT1 and Connection Type to Manual Load. 5. Enter a desired queue name in Name. 6. In Volume, enter the volume object (that is, the object representing the physical volume on the network) where the print queue will be created. Click the button at right to choose from a list. 7. Complete other settings as needed and click OK. Note • The print server name will be required when conguring the printer’s protocol settings. Write down the print server name for future reference. • When running Quick Setup, the printer is assigned printer number “0.” When using the printer in queue server mode, do not change the printer number from “0.” 3. Set a password. 1. Right-click the print server created in step 2 and choose Details. 2. Click Change Password to open the password input dialog box. Enter the password. 3. Click OK to close the password input dialog box. 4. Click OK or Cancel to close the details dialog box. 4. To use the printer in remote printer mode, start the print server. To use the NetWare le server as the print server, enter “LOAD PSERVER.NLM” at the le server and press the Enter key. Note • This procedure is not required when using queue server mode. Network Setting 589 Network Setting (Windows) Use PCONSOLE to set up the print server if bindery queue server mode or remote printer mode is used. 1. 2. 3. Log into NetWare as Admin and start PCONSOLE. Switch to bindery mode. If the print server has not been created, create it. 1. In Available Options, select Quick Setup, and press the Enter key. 2. Enter the name of the new print server, the new printer, and the queue. Note • The print server name will be required when conguring the printer’s protocol settings. Write down the print server name for future reference. 4. Specify the printer type. 1. To use the printer in queue server mode, choose Other/Unknown in Type. To use remote printer mode, set Printer Type to Parallel and Position to Manual Load. 2. Press the Esc key. 3. After the conrmation message is displayed, choose Yes and press the Enter key. 5. Set a password. 1. In Available Options, select Print Servers and press the Enter key. 2. Select the print server created in step 2 and press the Enter key. 3. Select Password, and press the Enter key to display the password input dialog box. 4. Enter the password and press the Enter key. 6. Press the Esc key several times to display the dialog box for conrming that PCONSOLE is nished. 7. Click Yes to exit PCONSOLE. 590 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Specifying NetWare Protocols Follow the steps below to congure NetWare protocol settings other than the frame type by using RemoteUI. Note • For details on RemoteUI, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the NetWare group to display the Edit NetWare Protocol Settings page. 6. 7. Make sure the Frame Type indicates the frame type used on the NetWare network. To use burst mode, choose On for NCP Burst Mode. Note • Burst mode supports fast data transfer when printing in queue server mode. Normally, choose On. 8. In Print Application, click the print service to be used. Note • Only one print service selected here will be enabled. Multiple print services are not available at the same time. 9. 10. For packet signature, click If Requested by Server in Packet Signature. Complete the following settings based on the selected service. • If you have selected Bindery PServer: Queue Server Mode (Using a Bindery Print Server) 1. In File Server Name, enter the le server name. 2. In Print Server Name, enter the name of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 3. In Print Server Password, enter the password of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 4. In Polling Interval, specify the interval at which the printer checks the NetWare print queue. • If you have selected RPrinter: Remote Printer Mode (Using a Bindery Print Server) 1. In Print Server Name, enter the advertising name of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 2. In Printer Number, enter the same printer number specied in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" Network Setting 591 Network Setting (Windows) • If you have selected NDS PServer: Queue Server Mode (Using an NDS Print Server) 1. In Tree Name and Context Name, enter the tree and context name of the print server. 2. In Print Server Name, enter the name of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 3. In Print Server Password, enter the password of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 4. In Polling Interval, specify the interval at which the printer checks the NetWare print queue. • If you have selected NPrinter: Remote Printer Mode (Using a NDS Print Server) 1. In Print Server Name, enter the advertising name of the print server created in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" Usually, the advertising name is the same as the name of the print server. 2. In Printer Number, enter the same printer number specied in "Specifying NetWare Print Services. (→P.588)" 11. Click OK to display the Network page. For a list of NetWare protocol settings items, see “Conguring the Printer’s NetWare Network Settings”. (→P.575) 592 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Conguring NetWare Network Settings To print over a NetWare network, congure the network environment as follows. Important • To congure network settings, you must be logged in with administrative rights such as “Administrator” account. We recommend that your network administrator congure the network settings. 1. Specify the Ethernet frame type for communication between the printer and computers. For instructions, see “Specifying the Printer’s Frame Type”. (→P.586) 2. Specify the NetWare print services, including the print server and queue. For instructions, see “Specifying NetWare Print Services”. (→P.588) 3. Specify NetWare protocol details besides the frame type. For instructions, see “Specifying NetWare Protocols”. (→P.591) After you have completed the steps above, congure each computer for printing over the NetWare network. 4. Connect to the NetWare network. Install NetWare client software on each computer to be used for printing over the network, and log in to the NetWare server or tree. For instructions on connection, refer to the NetWare and operating system documentation. 5. Install the printer driver. Follow the instructions of your network administrator to install the printer driver on each computer to be used for printing. When installing the printer driver, choose Network Printer as the printer destination, and then choose the print queue created from the NetWare print service settings. 6. Follow these steps to congure the printer port. This step is not necessary if you specied the printer destination during installation of the printer driver. 1. Open the Printers and Faxes (or Printers) window. 2. Right-click the printer icon and choose Properties. 3. Click the Port (or Advanced) tab to display the Port (or Advanced) sheet. 4. As the destination port, specify the print queue created by conguring the NetWare print service settings. Network Setting 593 Network Setting (Windows) Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility Install imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the User Software CD-ROM provided with the printer as follows: Important • In Windows 2000/Windows XP/Windows Server 2003/Windows Vista/Windows Server 2008, you must log on with administrative rights equivalent to the “Administrator” account. 1. 2. 3. 4. Insert the User Software CD-ROM in the CD-ROM drive. On the Setup Menu window, click Install Individual Software. Click Install in imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Follow the instructions on the screen to proceed with the installation. 594 Network Setting Network Setting (Windows) Conguring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility On a computer running Windows, you can use imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility provided with the printer to congure the printer’s IP address. This topic describes how to congure the IP address using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Important • To congure network settings, you must be logged in with administrative rights such as “Administrator” account. We recommend that your network administrator congure the network settings. • For instructions on installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility, see “Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility”. (→P.452) When specifying an IPv4 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv4 tab. In the Setting IP Address list, choose Manual. Enter the IP address assigned to the printer and click the Set button. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Note • To congure the IP address automatically, choose Auto in the Setting IP Address list and select DHCP, BOOTP, or RARP. • You can also specify the subnet mask and default gateway. When specifying an IPv6 IP address 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Start imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility from the start menu. In the Device Name list displayed, select the printer to congure. Choose Protocol Settings from the Printer menu. Select the IPv6 tab. In IPv6, select On. When there is an IPv6-compatible router in the network environment, select On in Stateless Address. Additionally, when there is an DHCPv6-compatible server in the network environment, select On in DHCPv6. Note • When there is no IPv6-compatible router or DHCPv6-compatible server, select On in Manual and enter the IPv6 Address and Prex Length. 7. 8. 9. Click Set. Click OK after the Conrmation message is displayed. Exit imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Network Setting 595 Network Setting (Mac OS X) Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the Printer Driver Destination (Macintosh) Specify the printer driver destination as follows if the printer’s IP address is changed, or if you will use the printer over a network connection instead of via USB connection. • If you switch to printing in an AppleTalk network, see “Conguring the Destination for AppleTalk Networks (Macintosh)”. (→P.598) • If you switch to printing in a TCP/IP network, or if the printer’s IP address is changed, see “Conguring the Destination in TCP/IP Networks (Macintosh)”. (→P.600) • If you switch to printing in a Bonjour network, see “Conguring the Destination for Bonjour Network (Macintosh)”. (→P.602) 596 Network Setting Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the Printer’s AppleTalk Network Settings Follow the steps below to congure the AppleTalk network settings. 1. Start the web browser and enter the following URL in the Location (or Address) box to display the RemoteUI page. http://“printer IP address or name”/ Example: http://xxx.xxx.xxx.xxx/ 2. 3. 4. 5. Select Administrator Mode and click Logon. If a password has been set on the printer, enter the password. Click Network in the Device Manager menu at left to display the Network page. Click Edit in the upper-right corner of the AppleTalk group to display the Edit AppleTalk Protocol Settings page. 6. Refer to the AppleTalk Settings Items table to complete the settings. AppleTalk Settings Items Item Details Default Setting Phase Type Specify whether to use AppleTalk. Disabled If you will use AppleTalk, choose Phase 2. If you will not use AppleTalk, choose Disabled. Name (*1) Specify the object name used by Canon NB-18GB (xxxxxx) AppleTalk (in up to 31 single-byte or 15 double-byte characters). However, do not use the following single-byte characters: @, *, :, and =. Zone (*2) Specify the printer zone name, up * to 31 single-byte characters. However, do not use the following single-byte characters: Also avoid using “*” (which represents the default zone) in the middle of a string. *1: The object name you have specied in Name is displayed in Printer Setup Utility (or Print Center) in Mac OS X 10.2.8-10.4. If you use multiple printers in the same zone, assign a unique name to each printer. By default, the network interface name is “Canon NB-18GB (xxxxxx).” (Here, xxxxxx is the last six digits of the printer’s MAC address.) *2: If zones have been created on the network, enter the name of the printer’s zone. If there are no zones, leave the asterisk “*” entry (for the default zone) as it is. If you enter a network zone name that does not match created zones, the printer will not be detected by Macintosh computers. Consult your network administrator for information on zone names. 7. Click OK to display the Network page. Network Setting 597 Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the Destination for AppleTalk Networks (Macintosh) To print over an AppleTalk network, activate the AppleTalk protocol and congure the destination as follows. Activating AppleTalk on the printer Important • By factory default, the AppleTalk protocol is disabled on the printer. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Interface Setup, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select AppleTalk, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select On, and then press the OK button. Press the Menu button. If any of the settings is changed, a conrmation message is displayed. In this case, press the OK button. Important • Be sure to complete step 6. This will activate the values you have entered. Note • By using RemoteUI, you can also specify the object name used for AppleTalk, as well as the printer zone name. For details on RemoteUI, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) 598 Network Setting Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the destination (Mac OS X) Important • AppleTalk is supported in Mac OS X 10.2.8-10.4. Note • The following procedures are based on Mac OS X 10.4. The method of conguring the destination varies depending on the version of Mac OS X. 1. 2. In System Preferences, click Network to display the Network window. In Show, choose Built-in Ethernet. Next, click AppleTalk, select Make AppleTalk Active, and click Apply now. 3. Close the Network window and save the settings. Network Setting 599 Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the Destination in TCP/IP Networks (Macintosh) Follow these steps to congure the destination when using the printer in a TCP/IP network. Important • If you use the printer in a TCP/IP network, make sure the printer’s IP address is congured correctly. (→P.565) Conguring the Destination (Mac OS X) 1. Navigate to Applications > Canon Utilities > imagePROGRAF PrinterSetup and double-click imagePROGRAF PrinterSetup.app. 2. Click Next. 3. Select the printer to register and click Next. Note • When specifying an IP address, click Registering IP Address. Enter the IP address of the printer to set up in IP Address and click Next. 600 Network Setting Network Setting (Mac OS X) 4. Complete Printer Name and Location as desired and click Register. 5. Click Finish. Network Setting 601 Network Setting (Mac OS X) Conguring the Destination for Bonjour Network (Macintosh) In Mac OS X 10.2.8 and later, use Bonjour functions to easily connect the printer to the network. Follow the steps below to congure the destination if you use the printer on TCP/IP network. Important • Bonjour and IP Print (Auto) do not support printing to a printer on other network groups that require a router for connection. Make sure the computer and printer are on the same network. For information about network settings, ask your network administrator. • By default, Bonjour is activated on the printer. The printer name as displayed in Printer Setup Utility (or Print Center) in Mac OS X is predened as the Multicast DNS Service Name. You can activate or deactivate the Bonjour function or change the printer name by using RemoteUI. For instructions on changing it, see “Using RemoteUI”. (→P.569) 1. 2. 3. Choose Utilities (or Applications) in the Go menu of Finder. 4. Select the printer from the list in the Printer Browser window and click Add. Click Printer Setup Utility (or Print Center) in the Utilities folder. If the printer name is not displayed in Printer List, click Add. 602 Network Setting Adjusting the Printhead Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the Printhead Adjusting the Printhead If printed documents are affected by the following problems, try adjusting the printhead. • Printing is faint or affected by banding in different colors Execute Nozzle Check to check for printhead nozzle clogging. For instructions, see “Checking for Nozzle Clogging”. (→P.630) • Printed vertical lines are warped or colors are out of alignment Execute Head Posi. Adj. to adjust the printhead position. Normally, execute Auto(Standard) or Auto(Advanced). However, when using special paper or if printing is not improved after executing Auto(Advanced), try Manual. (→P.604) (→P.606) • Printed lines are misaligned Execute Head Inc. Adj. to adjust the angle of inclination of the printhead. Even slight misalignment can be corrected. (→P.608) • Paper rubs against the printhead, or image edges are blurred Executing Head Height to adjust the printhead height may improve printing results. (→P.611) Adjustments for Better Print Quality 603 Adjusting the Printhead Automatic Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.) If printed vertical lines are warped or colors are out of alignment, execute Head Posi. Adj. to adjust the Printhead alignment. There are two modes for automatic Printhead adjustment: Auto(Standard) and Auto(Advanced). Auto(Standard) will x most slight image distortion or color misalignment, but if not, try Auto(Advanced). Use Auto(Standard) or Auto(Advanced) to have the printer print and read a test pattern for automatic adjustment of the Printhead. Important • Always make sure the loaded paper matches the type of paper specied on the printer. Adjustment cannot be completed correctly unless the loaded paper matches the settings. • This function is not available with CAD Tracing Paper, CAD Translucent Matte Film, or CAD Clear Film. If adjustment is not possible as expected using highly transparent lm or similar media, try another type of paper, or try Manual adjustment. (→P.606) Note • When printing on special paper, or if printing is not improved after Auto(Advanced), try Manual. (→P.606) • Use Auto(Standard) if you have switched to another type of paper or if you want the boundaries between colors to appear as clear as possible. • Use Auto(Advanced) to ne-tune the space between nozzles or colors if you have switched the printhead or if clearer printing is required. We recommend Auto(Advanced) for printing at the highest level of quality. • We recommend using the type of paper you use most often for adjustment. Paper to Prepare Rolls An unused roll at least 10 inches wide Sheets Auto(Standard) : One sheet of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size Auto(Advanced) : Five sheets of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size (or one sheet when using A2 or larger) Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) 604 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the Printhead 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Posi. Adj., and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Auto(Standard) or Auto(Advanced), and then press the OK button. A test pattern is printed for adjustment. Adjustment is now nished if you have printed on a roll or a sheet of A2 size or larger. 7. If you are printing on sheets smaller than A2 size for Auto(Advanced), a conrmation message is displayed requesting you to continue printing. Press the OK button and follow the instructions displayed. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 605 Adjusting the Printhead Manual Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.) If printed vertical lines are warped or colors are out of alignment, execute Head Posi. Adj. to adjust the Printhead alignment. Normally, execute Auto(Standard) or Auto(Advanced). (→P.604) However, when printing on special paper, or if printing is not improved after Auto(Advanced), try Manual. Manual adjustment requires you to examine the printed test pattern and enter an adjustment value. Note • Manual may be unavailable in some cases, even if it is displayed in the menu. If so, execute Auto(Advanced) once. • Always make sure the loaded paper matches the type of paper specied on the printer. Adjustment cannot be completed correctly unless the loaded paper matches the settings. • We recommend using the type of paper you use most often for adjustment. Paper to Prepare Rolls An unused roll at least 10 inches wide Sheets One sheet of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Posi. Adj., and then press the OK button. 606 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the Printhead 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Manual, and then press the OK button. A test pattern is printed for adjustment. 7. 8. 9. Press ▲ or ▼ to select D, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select D-1, and then press the OK button. Examine adjustment test pattern D-1 and determine the number with straight lines. Note • If two patterns seem equally good and you cannot decide which one is better, choose an intermediate value. For example, choose 11 if you cannot decide whether pattern 10 or 12 is better. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the pattern number you have decided, and then press the OK button. Repeat steps 8-10 to specify the adjustment value for D-2 to D-5 and D-7 to D-11. Press the Back button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Register Setting, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. The adjustment value is now registered, and adjustment is complete. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 607 Adjusting the Printhead Adjusting Line Misalignment (Head Inc. Adj.) If printed lines are misaligned, execute Head Inc. Adj. to adjust the angle of inclination of the Printhead. Executing Head Inc. Adj. requires you to examine a printed test pattern and enter an adjustment value. Paper to Prepare Rolls An unused roll at least 10 inches wide Sheets One sheet of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) Note • When loading paper, specify the type of paper correctly. Using paper that you have not specied on the printer may cause feeding problems and affect the printing quality. • We recommend loading a type of paper that you use often. 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Inc. Adj., and then press the OK button. After the Carriage is moved, a message is displayed requesting you to open the Top Cover. 6. Open the Top Cover. 608 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the Printhead 7. Align the Angle Adjustment Lever with the red square and close the Top Cover. A test pattern is printed for adjustment. Important • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). Touching these parts may damage them. • If you accidentally move the Carriage, you will hear a warning tone. In this case, close the Top Cover. 8. Examine the test pattern for adjustment. Determine the straightest set of lines. 9. Open the Top Cover and move the Angle Adjustment Lever to match the number (or the square) of the straightest set of lines. If no single set of lines is perfectly straight, move the Angle Adjustment Lever to a position between the numbers (or between the number and the square) of the two sets of lines that are least misaligned. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 609 Adjusting the Printhead 10. Close the Top Cover. The Printhead is now straight, and adjustment is complete. 610 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the Printhead Troubleshooting Paper Abrasion and Blurry Images (Head Height) If the Printhead rubs against paper during printing, adjusting the Printhead height may improve results. If image edges are blurred, it may help to lower the Printhead. Note • Raise or lower the printhead, depending on the nature of the problem. (→P.670) (→P.671) (→P.676) 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Height, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired setting value, and then press the OK button. Note • Depending on the type of paper, some setting values may not be available. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 611 Adjusting the feed amount Adjusting the feed amount Adjusting the Feed Amount If printed documents are affected by the following problems, try adjusting the feed amount. • Banding in different colors • Line length is not accurate in the direction paper is fed To adjust the feed amount, do the following, in this order. 1. Depending on the issue, adjust Adj. Priority to suit the particular type of paper. (→P.613) 2. Execute Adj. Quality or Adjust Length, depending on the selection in Adj. Priority. (→P.614) (→P.616) (→P.619) 3. After executing Adj. Quality, execute Adj. Fine Feed for further adjustment as needed. (→P.618) 612 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the feed amount Selecting a Feed Amount Adjustment Method (Feed Priority) Methods of adjusting the amount paper is fed are set in Adj. Priority. Adjust Adj. Priority to suit your particular printing application. • Print Quality : Adjusts the feed amount to reduce banding across the sheet in printed documents. Adj. Quality settings are applied. When Adj. Fine Feed is executed, the Adj. Fine Feed settings are applied in addition to the Adj. Quality settings. • Print Length : Adjusts the feed amount for better accuracy of lines in printed documents. The settings of A:High or B:Standard/Draft in Adjust Length are applied. • Automatic : Print Quality or Print Length is selected, depending on Print Priority as selected in the printer driver at the time of printing. Image or Ofce Document : Print Quality is selected. Line Drawing/Text : Print Length is selected. Note • Either B:Standard/Draft or A:High in the Adjust Length menu is applied, depending on printer driver settings at the time of printing. • If you have selected Easy Settings in the printer driver, follow these steps to conrm the Print Priority setting. • Windows: Click View Settings on the Main tab to display the View Settings dialog box. • Mac OS X: Click View set. on the Main pane to display the View settings dialog box. Follow these steps to congure the settings. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Feed Priority, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adj. Priority, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Automatic, Print Quality, or Print Length, and then press the OK button. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 613 Adjusting the feed amount Automatic Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality) If printed images are affected by banding in different colors across the sheet, execute Adj. Quality for automatic adjustment of the paper feed amount. There are two modes of automatic adjustment to correct banding: Auto(GenuinePpr) and Auto(OtherPaper). In either mode, the printer prints and reads a test pattern for automatic adjustment of the feed amount. • Auto(GenuinePpr) Use this mode with paper identied in the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) • Auto(OtherPaper) Use this mode with paper not in the Paper Reference Guide, or if Auto(GenuinePpr) does not eliminate banding. (→P.95) Note • Always check the Adj. Priority values before using Auto(GenuinePpr) or Auto(OtherPaper). (→P.613) • Adjustment is not possible with Auto(GenuinePpr) and Auto(OtherPaper) when using highly transparent media. In this case, use Manual adjustment. (→P.616) • If additional ne-tuning is necessary after Auto(GenuinePpr) and Auto(OtherPaper), execute Adj. Fine Feed. (→P.618) • Use Adjust Length to ensure that lines in CAD drawings are printed at exactly the right length. (→P.619) • This may take some time, depending on the type of paper. • Use paper of the same type and size for adjustment as you will use for printing. Paper to Prepare Rolls An unused roll at least 10 inches wide Sheets Auto(GenuinePpr) : One sheet of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size Auto(OtherPaper) : Two sheets of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size (or one sheet when using A2 or larger) Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) Note • Always make sure the loaded paper matches the type of paper specied. Adjustment cannot be completed correctly unless the loaded paper matches the settings. 614 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the feed amount 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Feed Priority, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adj. Quality, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Auto(GenuinePpr) or Auto(OtherPaper), and then press the OK button. A test pattern is printed for adjustment. Adjustment is now nished if you have printed on a roll or a sheet of A2 size or larger. 8. If you are printing on sheets smaller than A2 size for Auto(GenuinePpr), a conrmation message is shown on the Display Screen requesting you to continue printing. Press the OK button and follow the instructions on the Display Screen. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 615 Adjusting the feed amount Manual Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality) If printed images are affected by banding in different colors, execute Adj. Quality for adjustment of the paper feed amount. Use Manual adjustment with highly transparent media or other paper for which Auto(GenuinePpr) or Auto(OtherPaper) cannot be used. (→P.614) Manual adjustment requires you to enter an adjustment value after a test pattern is printed. Note • Always check the Adj. Priority values before using Manual adjustment. (→P.613) • If additional ne-tuning is necessary after Manual adjustment, use Adj. Fine Feed (→P.618) • Use Adjust Length to ensure that lines in CAD drawings are printed at exactly the right length. (→P.619) • Use paper of the same type and size for adjustment as you will use for printing. Paper to Prepare Rolls An unused roll at least 10 inches wide Sheets Two sheets of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) Note • Always make sure the loaded paper matches the type of paper specied. Adjustment cannot be completed correctly unless the loaded paper matches the settings. 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Feed Priority, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adj. Quality, and then press the OK button. 616 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the feed amount 7. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Manual, and then press the OK button. Test pattern A is printed for manual adjustment. Note • When printing on sheets, follow the instructions on the Display Screen and remove the sheet. 8. Examine test pattern A for adjustment. Determine the pattern in which banding is least noticeable. Note • If banding seems least noticeable in two patterns but you cannot decide which one is better, choose an intermediate value. For example, choose 11 if you cannot decide whether pattern 10 or 12 is better. 9. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the pattern number you have decided, and then press the OK button. Test pattern B is printed for adjustment. Note • If you printed test pattern A on a sheet, follow the instructions on the Display Screen and use another sheet of the same type of paper. Additionally, after test pattern B is printed, follow the instructions on the Display Screen and remove the sheet. 10. 11. Examine test pattern B for adjustment. Determine the pattern in which banding is least noticeable. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the pattern number you have decided, and then press the OK button. The adjustment value is now registered, and adjustment is complete. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 617 Adjusting the feed amount Fine-Tuning the Paper Feed Amount (Adj. Fine Feed) If the contrast is uneven or banding in different colors appears at 50 mm (2.0 in) intervals in printed documents, try executing Adj. Fine Feed during printing to ne-tune the feed amount. Note • Always execute Adj. Quality before Adj. Fine Feed. Once you execute Adj. Quality, the Adj. Fine Feed value will revert to 0. (→P.614) (→P.616) Perform adjustment as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adj. Fine Feed, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select a setting value in the range -5 to +5, and then press the OK button. The setting is now applied. 618 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the feed amount Adjusting Line Length (Adjust Length) To ensure that lines in CAD drawings are printed at exactly the right length, use Adjust Length to adjust the amount that paper is advanced. There are two options in Adjust Length : AdjustmentPrint and Change Settings. • AdjustmentPrint After a test pattern is printed, you will measure the discrepancy based on the results of printing. • Change Settings No test pattern is printed. Instead, you will measure a document already printed to determine the discrepancy. Additionally, two modes are available in both AdjustmentPrint and Change Settings : A:High or B:Standard/Draft. Choose the mode that suits your particular printing application. • A:High This setting is applied when Highest or High is selected in Print Quality in the printer driver. • B:Standard/Draft This setting is applied when Standard or Draft is selected in Print Quality in the printer driver. Note • Always check the Adj. Priority values before using Adjust Length. (→P.613) • Use paper of the same type and size for adjustment as you will use for printing. Paper to Prepare Rolls • An unused roll at least 10 inches wide • High-precision ruler Sheets • One sheet of unused paper of at least A4/Letter size • High-precision ruler Perform adjustment as follows. 1. Load the paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) Note • Always make sure the loaded paper matches the type of paper specied. Adjustment cannot be completed correctly unless the loaded paper matches the settings. 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 619 Adjusting the feed amount 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. 6. 7. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Printer, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Feed Priority, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Adjust Length, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select AdjustmentPrint or Change Settings, and then press the OK button. When you select AdjustmentPrint, a test pattern is printed for you to measure the scale and calculate the discrepancy. The scale bar shows “Millimeter” in 50 mm units and “Inch” in 1 inch units. Note • A test pattern is printed in black when you choose A:High or in magenta if you choose B:Standard/Draft. • To cancel printing the test pattern for adjustment, hold down the Stop button. When Stop printing? is displayed, press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. 8. Press ▲ or ▼ to enter the amount of discrepancy, and then press the OK button. If the scale is shorter than the actual size, use a positive setting value. If it is longer, use a negative value. The feed amount can be adjusted in 0.02% increments. 620 Adjustments for Better Print Quality Adjusting the feed amount Adjusting the Vacuum Strength (VacuumStrngth) When printing on heavyweight paper or paper that curls or wrinkles easily, if the Printhead rubs against paper, adjusting the level of suction against paper on the Platen may improve results. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Paper tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Paper Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Paper Details, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the type of paper, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select VacuumStrngth, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select the desired setting value, and then press the OK button. Adjustments for Better Print Quality 621 Ink Tanks Maintenance Ink Tanks Ink Tanks Ink tanks that can be used in the printer are labeled with a white letter “J” in a black circle on the side. When purchasing ink tanks, make sure a “J” is printed on the label, along with the following Ink Tank serial numbers. • 130 ml (4.4 oz) per color • BK Ink Tank PFI-102BK • MBK Ink Tank PFI-102MBK • C Ink Tank PFI-102C • M Ink Tank PFI-104M • Y Ink Tank PFI-102Y Note • For instructions on ink tank replacement, see “Replacing Ink Tanks”. (→P.623) • You can also use ink tanks other than M Ink Tank PFI-104M that are simply labeled “A.” 622 Maintenance Ink Tanks Replacing Ink Tanks Compatible ink tanks Ink tanks that can be used in the printer are labeled with a white letter “J” in a black circle on the side. Request ink tanks with the same label when you purchase new ones. For details, see “Ink Tanks”. (→P.622) Precautions when handling ink tanks Take the following precautions when handling ink tanks. Caution • For safety, keep ink tanks out of the reach of children. • If ink is accidentally ingested, contact a physician immediately. • There may be ink around the ink supply section of ink tanks you removed. Handle ink tanks carefully during replacement. The ink may stain clothing. Important • Do not install used ink tanks in another model of printer. This will prevent correct ink level detection, which may damage the printer or cause other problems. • We recommend using up an Ink Tank in the course of printing within six months after breaking the seal. Printing quality may be affected if you use older ink tanks. • Do not leave the printer without ink tanks installed for extended periods (a month or more). Residual ink may become clogged inside the printer and affect printing quality. Make sure the printer is ready for Ink Tank replacement You can replace ink tanks if the Display Screen advises you to check the amount of ink left or replace ink tanks. If a message requests you to replace an Ink Tank, press the OK button. In this case, you can skip the step “Access the menu for ink tank replacement.” Follow the instructions in “Remove the ink tanks.” Important • Do not remove an Ink Tank during initialization immediately after turning on the printer, or during printhead cleaning. Note • Ink Tank replacement is possible even during printing, when print jobs are being canceled, or when paper is being advanced. Maintenance 623 Ink Tanks Access the menu for Ink Tank replacement 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Ink tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Ink Menu is displayed. 3. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Rep. Ink Tank, and then press the OK button. A message on the Display Screen requests you to open the Ink Tank Cover. Remove the Ink Tank at this point. Remove the Ink Tank 1. Open the Ink Tank Cover and check the ink lamps. Ink lamps ash when there is little ink left. 2. Press the tip of the Ink Tank Lock Lever of the color for replacement horizontally and pull the Ink Tank Lock Lever up to open it. 624 Maintenance Ink Tanks 3. Hold the Ink Tank by the grips and remove it. Press the OK button. Caution • If there is still ink in the Ink Tank you removed, store it with the ink holes (a) facing up. Otherwise, ink may leak and cause stains. Put the Ink Tank in a plastic bag and seal it. Note • Dispose of used ink tanks according to local regulations. Install the ink tanks 1. Before opening the pouch, gently agitate the Ink Tank once or twice. Agitate the ink in the Ink Tank by slowly rotating the Ink Tank upside-down and right side up repeatedly. Caution • Do not remove and agitate ink tanks that have already been installed in the printer. Ink may leak out. Important • If you do not agitate the Ink Tank, the ink may settle, which may affect printing quality. Maintenance 625 Ink Tanks 2. Open the pouch and remove the Ink Tank. Caution • Never touch the ink holes or electrical contacts. This may cause stains, damage the Ink Tank, and affect printing quality. 3. Press the OK button and insert the Ink Tank into the holder facing as shown, with the ink holes down. Important • Ink tanks cannot be loaded in the holder if the color or orientation is incorrect. If the Ink Tank does not t in the holder, do not force it into the holder. Make sure the color of the Ink Tank Lock Lever matches the color of the Ink Tank and check the orientation of the Ink Tank before reloading it. 4. Push the Ink Tank Lock Lever closed until it clicks into place. 626 Maintenance Ink Tanks 5. Make sure the Ink Lamp is lit in red. Note • If the Ink Lamp is not lit, reload the tank. 6. Close the Ink Tank Cover. Maintenance 627 Ink Tanks Checking Ink Tank Levels On the Display Screen, you can check how much ink is left in the ink tanks. To check remaining Ink Tank levels, access the Tab Selection screen on the Control Panel and press ◄ or ► to select the Ink tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. • If an error has occurred and the Tab Selection screen cannot be displayed, display Ink Info as follows. 1. Press the OK button to display Printer Info. 2. Press the ▲ or ▼ button to select Ink Info. 3. Press the OK button. The remaining ink levels shown on the Display Screen correspond to the inks identied by the Color Label on the bottom of the Display Screen. These symbols may be displayed above the ink level: “!” if ink is low, “×” if no ink is left, and “?” if you have deactivated ink level detection. The remaining ink level is indicated as shown below. If the Display Screen indicates to replace the Ink Tank, replace the Ink Tank. If a message is displayed indicating to check the remaining ink levels, or after tasks that consume a lot of ink such as large-format printing or head cleaning, check the remaining levels and replace Ink Tank as needed. (→P.623) 628 Maintenance Ink Tanks When to Replace Ink Tanks Replace or prepare to replace ink tanks in the following situations. If a message for checking the ink is shown on the Display Screen When there is little ink left, the Message Lamp is lit and Not much ink is left. is shown on the Display Screen. You can continue to print, but prepare to replace the Ink Tank. (→P.628) Before print jobs and maintenance that consume a lot of ink If little ink is left, there may not be enough for large-format printing, head cleaning, and maintenance, which require a lot of ink. In this case, replace or prepare to replace the Ink Tank before maintenance. If a message for ink replacement is shown on the Display Screen When ink runs out, the Message Lamp ashes, a message regarding Ink Tank replacement is shown on the Display Screen, and printing is disabled. Replace the Ink Tank at this point. Maintenance 629 Printheads Printheads Printhead A replacement Printhead. • Printhead PF-04 Note • For instructions on replacing the Printhead, see “Replacing the Printhead”. (→P.633) Checking for Nozzle Clogging If printing is faint or affected by banding in different colors, make sure the Printhead nozzles are clear by printing a test pattern to check the nozzles. Note • Nozzles are periodically checked to ensure they are clear. Congure the settings on the Control Panel menu in Nozzle Check. (→P.49) 1. Load unused paper. • Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls (→P.103) • Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) • Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) 2. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 3. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Test Print, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Nozzle Check, and then press the OK button. The printer now prints a test pattern for checking the nozzles. 630 Maintenance Printheads 6. Check the printing results. If the horizontal lines are not faint or incomplete, the nozzles are clear. If some sections of the horizontal lines are faint or incomplete, the nozzles for those colors are clogged. If horizontal lines are faint or incomplete, follow the steps below and check again for nozzle clogging. 1. Clean the Printhead. (→P.632) 2. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. Note • If you repeat these steps several times but the horizontal lines are still faint or incomplete, contact your Canon dealer. Maintenance 631 Printheads Cleaning the Printhead If printing is faint, cleaning the Printhead may improve results. Choose one of two Printhead cleaning modes (Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B), depending on the problem to resolve. • Head Cleaning A Use this mode if printing is faint or contains foreign substances. This method of cleaning consumes the least amount of ink. It takes about three minutes to complete. • Head Cleaning B Use this mode if no ink is ejected at all, or if Head Cleaning A does not solve the problem. It takes about three and a half minutes to complete. Caution • Do not remove the Maintenance Cartridge or ink tanks during either Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B. Note • If printing does not improve after Head Cleaning B, try repeating Head Cleaning B once or twice. If this still does not improve printing, the Printhead may have reached the end of its useful life. Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. • Nozzles are periodically checked to ensure they are clear. Congure the settings on the Control Panel menu in Nozzle Check. (→P.49) Perform cleaning as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Maintenance, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Cleaning, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B, and then press the OK button. Head cleaning is now executed. 6. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles, and determine whether cleaning has cleared the nozzles. (→P.630) 632 Maintenance Printheads Replacing the Printhead When to replace the Printhead Replace the Printhead in the following situations. • If the printing quality does not improve even after one or two cycles of Head Cleaning B from the printer menu • If the Display Screen indicates Open top cover and replace the printhead. • If your Canon dealer has advised you to replace the Printhead Compatible printheads For information on compatible printheads, see “Printhead”. (→P.630) Precautions when handling the Printhead Take the following precautions when handling the Printhead. Caution • For safety, keep the Printhead out of the reach of children. • If ink is accidentally ingested, contact a physician immediately. • Do not touch the Printhead immediately after printing. The Printhead becomes extremely hot, and there is a risk of burns. Important • There may be ink around the nozzles of the Printhead you remove. Handle the Printhead carefully during replacement. The ink may stain clothing. • Do not open the Printhead pouch until immediately before installation. After removing the Printhead from the pouch, install it right away. If the Printhead is left after the pouch is opened, the nozzles may dry out, which may affect printing quality. Maintenance 633 Printheads Access the menu for Printhead replacement Caution • When replacing the Printhead immediately after printing, wait a few minutes before replacing it. The metal parts of the Printhead become hot during printing, and there is a risk of burns from touching these parts. Note • Prepare a new Ink Tank when ink levels are low. • Your hands may become dirty during Printhead replacement. Use the gloves provided with the new Printhead for replacement. 1. If the roll is not ejected because of the cutting method selected, cut it manually and remove it. (→P.331) 2. 3. Clean inside the Top Cover. (→P.647) On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 4. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 5. 6. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Maintenance, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Replace P.head, and then press the OK button. Ink is now lled. After about two minutes, a message is shown on the Display Screen instructing you to open the Top Cover. 634 Maintenance Printheads Replace the Printhead 1. Open the Top Cover. Instructions are now shown on the Display Screen regarding Printhead replacement. Important • During Printhead replacement, do not move the Carriage from the position indicated. If you accidentally move the Carriage, you will hear a warning tone, and Printhead replacement is no longer possible. If you move the Carriage by mistake, close the Top Cover. The Carriage will be moved to the position as indicated. 2. If the Printhead Fixer Cover or Printhead Fixer Lever is dirty, use a damp cloth that you have wrung out completely to wipe it clean. Maintenance 635 Printheads Important • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). Touching these parts may damage them. • Never touch the metal contacts of the Carriage. This may damage the printer. 3. Pull the Printhead Fixer Lever forward all the way to open it completely. 4. Pull up the Printhead Fixer Cover to open it completely. 5. Remove the Printhead and press the OK button. Note • Dispose of the used Printhead in accordance with local regulations. 636 Maintenance Printheads 6. Holding the new Printhead by the grips (a), remove it from the pouch. Important • When handling the Printhead, always hold it by the grips (a). Never touch the nozzles (b) or metal contacts (c). This may damage the Printhead and affect printing quality. • Never touch the ink supply section (d). This may cause printing problems. • If you need to put a Printhead somewhere temporarily before installation, do not keep the nozzles and metal contacts facing down. If the nozzles or metal contacts are damaged, it may affect the printing quality. 7. While rmly holding the Printhead you have removed, use your other hand to remove the orange Protective Part (a). Squeeze the grips (c) of Protective Part (b) and pull it down to remove it. Important • The inside surface of the Protective Part (a) and Protective Part (b) is coated with ink to protect the nozzles. Be careful not to touch these surfaces when removing the caps. • The Printhead contains ink to protect the nozzles. We recommend removing Protective Part (b) as you hold it over the Printhead package or safely out of the way to avoid spilling ink and staining your clothes or the surrounding area. If ink accidentally spills, wipe off the ink with a dry cloth. • Do not reattach the Protective Part or protective material. Dispose of these materials in accordance with local regulations. Maintenance 637 Printheads 8. With the nozzles facing down and the metal contacts toward the back, insert the Printhead into the Carriage. Carefully push the printhead rmly into the Carriage, ensuring that the nozzles and metal contacts do not touch the carriage. 9. Pull the Printhead Fixer Cover down toward the front to lock the Printhead in place. 10. Push the Printhead Fixer Lever toward the back of the printer until it clicks. 11. Close the Top Cover. Ink now lls the system. It takes about six minutes for ink to ll the system. Important • Never remove an Ink Tank while the system is lling with ink. • After Printhead has been replaced and lled with ink, Head Posi. Adj. (Auto(Advanced)) is performed if you have selected Rep.P.head Print > On in the Control Panel menu. (→P.49) In this case, follow the instructions on the Display Screen for Printhead adjustment. If Rep.P.head Print is Off, perform Head Posi. Adj. (Auto(Advanced)) yourself. (→P.604) 638 Maintenance Maintenance Cartridge Maintenance Cartridge Maintenance Cartridge A replacement Maintenance Cartridge. • Maintenance Cartridge MC-10 Note • For instructions on replacing the Maintenance Cartridge, see “Replacing the Maintenance Cartridge”. (→P.639) Replacing the Maintenance Cartridge Compatible maintenance cartridges For information on compatible maintenance cartridges, see “Maintenance Cartridge”. (→P.639) Precautions when handling the Maintenance Cartridge Take the following precautions when handling the Maintenance Cartridge. Caution • For safety, keep the Maintenance Cartridge out of the reach of children. • If ink is accidentally ingested, contact a physician immediately. • To prevent ink from leaking from a used Maintenance Cartridge, avoid dropping the cartridge or storing it at an angle. Otherwise, ink may leak and cause stains. • Ink adheres to the top of the Maintenance Cartridge after it has been used. Handle the Maintenance Cartridge carefully during replacement. The ink may stain clothing. Important • Do not remove the Maintenance Cartridge except to replace it. • Do not install a used Maintenance Cartridge in another printer. Maintenance 639 Maintenance Cartridge Make sure the printer is ready for Maintenance Cartridge replacement You can replace Maintenance Cartridge if the Display Screen advises you to check the remaining capacity or replace the Maintenance Cartridge. If a message is displayed requesting Maintenance Cartridge replacement, you can skip the step “Access the menu for Maintenance Cartridge replacement.” Follow the instructions in “Replace the Maintenance Cartridge.” Caution • Do not replace the Maintenance Cartridge during initialization immediately after turning on the printer, during Printhead cleaning, or when ink is being absorbed. Ink may leak out. Access the menu for Maintenance Cartridge replacement 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Maintenance, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Repl. maint cart, and then press the OK button. A message on the Display Screen advises you to open the Maintenance Cartridge Cover. 640 Maintenance Maintenance Cartridge Replace the Maintenance Cartridge 1. Open the box, remove the plastic bag and packaging material, and take out the Maintenance Cartridge. Important • Never touch the metal contacts (a). This may damage the Maintenance Cartridge. 2. At this point, open the Maintenance Cartridge Cover. 3. Hold the used Maintenance Cartridge by the grip (a) with one hand and put your other hand under the Maintenance Cartridge to hold it rmly on the bottom, keeping it level as you pull it out. Caution • Used maintenance cartridges are heavy. Always grasp the cartridge rmly and keep the cartridge level during removal and storage. If you drop a used Maintenance Cartridge or store it at an angle, ink may leak and cause stains. Maintenance 641 Maintenance Cartridge Important • The remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity is recorded on each printer. Do not install a used Maintenance Cartridge in another printer. 4. Keep the used Maintenance Cartridge level as you put it in the plastic bag. Expel excess air from the plastic bag and seal the zipper. 5. Conrm the Maintenance Cartridge is right-side up, put it in the box with the packaging material attached, and store it so that it stays level. Caution • Always put the used Maintenance Cartridge back in the box and store the box on a at surface. Otherwise, ink may leak and cause stains. Note • In accordance with active and ongoing environmental programs, Canon supports recycling of used maintenance cartridges. Follow the instructions provided with the new Maintenance Cartridge that describe how to process the used Maintenance Cartridge. 6. Keeping the new Maintenance Cartridge level, insert it all the way in. 642 Maintenance Maintenance Cartridge 7. Close the Maintenance Cartridge Cover. 8. Press the OK button. The printer now initializes the Maintenance Cartridge. Maintenance 643 Maintenance Cartridge Checking the Remaining Maintenance Cartridge Capacity The Maintenance Cartridge absorbs excess ink from borderless printing, printhead cleaning, and other processes. You can conrm the remaining capacity of the Maintenance Cartridge by checking the Maintenance Cartridge capacity shown on the Display Screen. To check remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity, access the Tab Selection screen on the Control Panel and press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. If the Display Screen indicates to replace the Maintenance Cartridge, replace the Maintenance Cartridge. If a message is displayed indicating to check the remaining capacity of the Maintenance Cartridge, or before tasks that deplete much of the capacity such as head cleaning or preparations to move the printer, check the remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity and replace the Maintenance Cartridge as needed. (→P.639) 644 Maintenance Maintenance Cartridge When to Replace the Maintenance Cartridge Replace or prepare to replace the Maintenance Cartridge in the following situations. If a message for checking the Maintenance Cartridge is shown on the Display Screen When the Maintenance Cartridge is almost full, the Message Lamp is lit and The level is low is shown on the Display Screen. You can continue to print, but check the remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity and prepare to replace the Maintenance Cartridge with a new one. (→P.644) When much of the Maintenance Cartridge capacity is depleted Printhead cleaning, Printhead replacement, and preparations to transfer the printer deplete much of the Maintenance Cartridge capacity. (In particular, preparing to move the printer depletes a lot of the capacity.) Check the remaining Maintenance Cartridge capacity before this maintenance and replace the Maintenance Cartridge if necessary. If a message for the Maintenance Cartridge replacement is shown on the Display Screen When the Maintenance Cartridge is full, the Message Lamp ashes and a message to replace the Maintenance Cartridge is shown on the Display Screen. Printing is disabled, and you cannot replace the Printhead or transfer the printer. Replace the Maintenance Cartridge with a new one. Maintenance 645 Cleaning the Printer Cleaning the Printer Cleaning the Printer Exterior Clean the printer regularly to maintain better printing quality and help prevent problems. To ensure a comfortable working environment, clean the printer exterior about once a month. 1. 2. Turn the printer off. (→P.24) Unplug the power cord from the outlet. Caution • Always turn off the printer and unplug the power cord before cleaning or maintenance. Accidentally leaving the printer on poses a risk of injury if you touch moving parts inside the printer. 3. Using a damp cloth that you have wrung out completely, wipe the exterior surfaces of the printer. Dry the surfaces with a dry cloth. Caution • Never use ammable solvents such as alcohol, benzene, or thinner. If these substances come into contact with electrical components inside the printer, there is a risk of re or electrical shock. Important • If the Ejection Guide is dirty, it may soil the edge of the paper when the paper is cut. We recommend cleaning the Ejection Guide even if it does not appear dirty, because it may actually be covered with paper dust. 4. Plug the power cord into the outlet. 646 Maintenance Cleaning the Printer Cleaning Inside the Top Cover Clean inside the Top Cover about once a month to maintain better printing quality and help prevent problems. Also clean inside the Top Cover in the following situations to ensure optimal operation. • • • • • • • • If the printed surface or the underside of paper is dirty after printing After you have used up a roll After borderless printing After printing on small paper After printing on paper that generates a lot of cutting debris If you have replaced the roll After printing on paper that generates a lot of paper dust After printing on adhesive paper Important • If the Platen inside the Top Cover becomes dirty, it may soil the underside of paper. We recommend cleaning the Platen after borderless printing or printing on small paper. • If the Ejection Guide is dirty, it may soil the edge of the paper when the paper is cut. We recommend cleaning the Ejection Guide even if it does not appear dirty, because it may actually be covered with paper dust. • Printing on adhesive paper may leave adhesive on the Platen, Paper Retainer, or other parts. To prevent paper jams, we recommend cleaning inside the Top Cover after printing. 1. Open the Top Cover. 2. If paper dust has accumulated in the Vacuum holes (a) on the Platen or in the Borderless Printing Ink Grooves (b), use the Cleaning Brush (c), provided with the printer, to wipe it away. Note • If the Cleaning Brush is dirty, rinse it in water. Maintenance 647 Cleaning the Printer 3. Using a damp cloth that you have wrung out completely, wipe inside the Top Cover to clean it. Wipe away any ink residue on the Platen as a whole (a), the Paper Retainer (b), Borderless Printing Ink Grooves (c), and Ejection Guide (d). Important • Do not use a dry cloth to wipe inside the Top Cover. This may create a static charge, which may attract dust and affect the printing quality. • Never use ammable solvents such as alcohol, benzene, or thinner. If these substances come into contact with electrical components inside the printer, there is a risk of re or electrical shock. • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). 648 Maintenance Cleaning the Printer Note • When cleaning between the Platen and Ejection Guide, use a damp cloth that you have wrung out completely to wipe over the Output Tray and along grooves. 4. Close the Top Cover. Maintenance 649 Cleaning the Printer Cleaning the Printhead If printing is faint, cleaning the Printhead may improve results. Choose one of two Printhead cleaning modes (Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B), depending on the problem to resolve. • Head Cleaning A Use this mode if printing is faint or contains foreign substances. This method of cleaning consumes the least amount of ink. It takes about three minutes to complete. • Head Cleaning B Use this mode if no ink is ejected at all, or if Head Cleaning A does not solve the problem. It takes about three and a half minutes to complete. Caution • Do not remove the Maintenance Cartridge or ink tanks during either Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B. Note • If printing does not improve after Head Cleaning B, try repeating Head Cleaning B once or twice. If this still does not improve printing, the Printhead may have reached the end of its useful life. Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. • Nozzles are periodically checked to ensure they are clear. Congure the settings on the Control Panel menu in Nozzle Check. (→P.49) Perform cleaning as follows. 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Maintenance, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Cleaning, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Head Cleaning A or Head Cleaning B, and then press the OK button. Head cleaning is now executed. 6. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles, and determine whether cleaning has cleared the nozzles. (→P.630) 650 Maintenance Other Maintenance Other Maintenance Preparing to Transfer the Printer To protect the internal parts in transit, always follow these steps before transferring the printer to a new location. Refer to the Setup Guide for details on packing the printer and installing it after transfer. Important • Be sure to contact your Canon dealer before transferring the printer to a new location. Ink may leak and damage the printer if you do not prepare the printer correctly and it is tipped or stood on end in transit. Note • It is not possible to prepare the printer for transfer if the Display Screen requests you to replace the Maintenance Cartridge or check the remaining capacity. Replace the Maintenance Cartridge before transfer preparations. In this case, you will need one new Maintenance Cartridge. (→P.639) • Depending on the state of the printer, part replacement may be necessary when preparing to transfer the printer (that is, when you execute the printer menu item to prepare for transfer). Remove paper 1. Remove the paper. • Rolls (→P.116) • Sheets (→P.144) Access the Move Printer menu 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Prep.MovePrinter, and then press the OK button. Once preparations are nished, a message on the Display Screen requests you to open the Ink Tank Cover. Important • If consumables must be replaced, the message Consumables must be replaced. Call for service. is shown on the Display Screen and preparation is not possible. If this message is displayed, press the OK button and contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Maintenance 651 Other Maintenance Remove the Ink Tank 1. Open the Ink Tank Cover. 2. Pressing the tip of the Ink Tank Lock Lever horizontally, lift the Ink Tank Lock Lever to release the lock. 3. Holding the ink tanks by the grips, remove them. Note • Store the ink tanks you removed with the ink holes (a) facing up. Otherwise, ink may leak and cause stains. 4. Repeat steps 2 and 3 to remove all ink tanks. 5. Push all ink tank lock levers closed until they click into place. 652 Maintenance Other Maintenance 6. Close the Ink Tank Cover. At this point, ink is drawn out from inside the tubes. Important • Do not remove the Maintenance Cartridge during this process. When the process is nished, Completed! Turn Power Off!! is displayed. Pack the printer 1. Press the Power button and turn off the printer. Important • Turn off the printer before you unplug it. It may damage the printer if you unplug it before it is off and transfer it in that state. If you accidentally unplug the printer, plug it in again, reinstall the ink tanks, and follow this procedure again. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. Disconnect the power cord and interface cable. Tape down printer covers to secure them, in the reverse order of tape removal during installation. Remove the Stand by reversing the installation procedure, when it was attached to the printer. Disassemble and repackage the Stand by following the installation procedure in reverse. Repack the Roll Holder, Holder Stopper, and printer in shipping materials, and then package them in a shipping box. Maintenance 653 Other Maintenance Updating the Firmware Update the printer rmware to take advantage of new and improved printer functions. Conrming the rmware version 1. On the Tab Selection screen of the Control Panel, press ◄ or ► to select the Settings/Adj. tab ( ). Note • If the Tab Selection screen is not displayed, press the Menu button. 2. Press the OK button. The Set./Adj. Menu is displayed. 3. 4. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Printer Info, and then press the OK button. Press ▲ or ▼ to select System Info, and then press the OK button. The rmware version is displayed. Updating the Firmware To obtain the latest rmware, visit the Canon website. If the rmware available online is newer than the installed rmware, update the printer rmware. For details on downloading and updating the rmware, visit the Canon website. 654 Maintenance Frequently Asked Questions Troubleshooting Frequently Asked Questions Frequently Asked Questions This section presents frequently asked questions and answers. To view more detailed explanations, click the hyperlinks in the answer column. Question Answer How do I print on a roll? When printing on rolls, after loading the roll, specify the paper type and length, both on the Control Panel and in the printer driver. Þ"Loading and Printing on Rolls (→P.78) " How do I print on a sheet? When printing on sheets, specify the paper type and size in the printer driver before loading the paper. Þ"Loading and Printing on Sheets (→P.81) " How do I switch between printing on rolls and sheets? When you complete operations on the Control Panel to load or replace paper, the paper source is automatically switched to the selected paper. Þ"Loading Rolls in the Printer (→P.106) " Þ"Loading Sheets in the Printer (→P.136) " How do I change the paper type or size? Specify the type and size of paper, both on the Control Panel and in the printer driver. • Specifying it in the printer driver Þ"Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (→P.197) " • Specifying it on the Control Panel Selecting the paper type Þ"Changing the Type of Paper (→P.110) " Selecting the paper size Þ"Specifying the Paper Length (→P.112) " How do I cut the roll paper after You can wait until ink dries before cutting the roll, and you can cut rolls printing? at a desired position. Þ"Specifying the Cutting Method for Rolls (→P.129) " How do I print without borders? Borderless printing is possible on rolls. You can also specify borderless printing in the printer driver by adjusting the original size to match the paper size. Borderless printing is not supported on sheets. Þ"Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size (→P.232) " Þ"Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.239) " Þ"Borderless Printing at Actual Size (→P.225) " How do I print an A4 original enlarged on A2 paper? In the printer driver, you can adjust the original image to match the paper size or width, or you can specify enlargement or reduction before printing as desired. Þ"Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (→P.201) " Þ"Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (→P.207) " Þ"Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (→P.213) " Troubleshooting 655 Frequently Asked Questions Question How do I print without wasting paper? Answer To conserve paper, you can specify in the printer driver to rotate originals 90 degrees or to print without top and bottom margins. Þ"Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (→P.301) " Þ"Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (→P.307) " How do I print without wasting By specifying to rotate originals 90 degrees in the printer driver, you can all the blank space on the right print at A4 size to ll the width of A3 paper. side when printing an A4-sized Þ"Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (→P.301) " original at A3 size? How do I print in landscape (or You can print originals that are in landscape (or portrait) orientation portrait) orientation? automatically enlarged to t the roll width. This is an easy way to create vertical or horizontal banners. Þ"Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing) (→P.253) " How do I print on a custom paper size? You can specify custom sizes temporarily in the printer driver. Þ"Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (→P.261) " How do I register custom paper You can add desired sizes (Custom Media Sizes) in the Size Options sizes? dialog box of the printer driver. Þ"Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (→P.261) " How do I print lines thicker? By specifying Thicken Fine Lines in the printer driver, you can print ne lines thicker to make them easier to see. Þ"Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing (→P.187) " How do I modify how colors are You can adjust colors as desired in the printer driver before printing. printed? Þ"Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver (→P.177) " How do I use printer driver settings again in subsequent jobs? By saving settings information in a favorite, you can apply the settings again before printing anytime as needed. Þ"Using Favorites (→P.327) " Can I use the printer in combination with a Color imageRUNNER ? The printer can be used for automatic enlargement and printing of scanned originals from a Color imageRUNNER. Þ"Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows) (→P.432) " Þ"Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Mac OS X) (→P.555) " How do I print enlargements of By using Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy (iR enlargement copy), scanned originals from a Color you can automatically print enlargements of scanned originals from a imageRUNNER ? Color imageRUNNER. Þ"Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows) (→P.432) " Þ"Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Mac OS X) (→P.555) " 656 Troubleshooting Problems Regarding Paper Problems Regarding Paper Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot) Follow these steps to remove any scraps left in the Paper Feed Slot after you clear jammed sheets or roll paper. 1. 2. Turn the printer off. (→P.24) 3. Positioning your hands as shown, open the Roll Cover. 4. Fold an A4 sheet lengthwise four times and insert it through the gap of the Paper Feed Slot. Push the Release Lever back. Push the scrap out toward the Platen. 5. 6. Remove the scrap when it is pushed out onto the Platen. If any scraps remain inside the paper feed slot, repeat steps 4 and 5. Troubleshooting 657 Problems Regarding Paper 7. Holding it at the positions indicated, close the Roll Cover. 8. Pull the Release Lever forward. 658 Troubleshooting Problems Regarding Paper Clearing Jammed Roll Paper If paper from a roll becomes jammed, Paper jam. is shown on the Display Screen of the Control Panel. Remove the jammed paper as follows. 1. Open the Roll Cover. Use a commercially available cutter or the like to cut the paper of the loaded roll. Caution • When cutting paper, be careful to avoid injury or damage to the printer. 2. Push the Release Lever back. 3. Remove the jammed paper. • If paper is jammed inside the Top Cover 1. Open the Top Cover and move the Carriage to the left or right side manually, away from the jam. 2. Clear any jammed paper from inside the Top Cover. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. Troubleshooting 659 Problems Regarding Paper 3. Close the Top Cover. Important • Do not move the Carriage over jammed paper. This may damage the Printhead. • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). This may stain your hands and damage the printer. • If paper from a roll is jammed by the Paper Feed Slot 1. Open the Roll Cover. 2. Remove the jammed paper from the Paper Feed Slot. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 660 Troubleshooting Problems Regarding Paper • If the paper is jammed by the Ejection Guide Remove the jammed paper from the Output Tray. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 4. Pull the Release Lever forward. Troubleshooting 661 Problems Regarding Paper Clearing a Jammed Sheet If a sheet becomes jammed, Paper jam. is shown on the Display Screen of the Control Panel. Remove the jammed paper as follows. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Remove the jammed paper. • If paper is jammed inside the Top Cover 1. Open the Top Cover and move the Carriage to the left or right side manually, away from the jam. 2. Clear any jammed paper from inside the Top Cover. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. 3. Close the Top Cover. 662 Troubleshooting Problems Regarding Paper Important • Do not move the Carriage over jammed paper. This may damage the Printhead. • Do not touch the Linear Scale (a) or Carriage Shaft (b). This may stain your hands and damage the printer. • If the paper is jammed by the Paper Feed Slot Remove the jammed paper from the Paper Feed Slot. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. • If the paper is jammed by the Ejection Guide Remove the jammed paper from the Output Tray. After removing the paper, make sure there are no other scraps of paper in the printer. Troubleshooting 663 Problems Regarding Paper 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 664 Troubleshooting Problems Regarding Paper Roll Paper Cannot be Inserted into the Paper Feed Slot Cause Corrective Action The roll paper is warped. Straighten out curls and reload the roll. Paper is jammed by the paper feed slot. Remove the jammed paper. (→P.120) (→P.145) Cannot load sheets Cause The paper source selection is incorrect. Corrective Action Press the Load button and select the paper source. Paper is not cut straight Cause Corrective Action The paper is bent or curled at the cut position. Straighten out any curling by the edges of the paper. Paper rises by the ends of the cut position before it is cut. Reload the paper correctly. You are using paper that cannot be cut with the Cutter Unit. Specify Manual in Cutting Mode in the Control Panel menu and use scissors or a cutting tool to cut the roll after printing. (→P.129) Paper is not cut Cause Corrective Action In the printer driver, No or Print Cut Guideline is specied in Auto Cut. Specify Yes in Auto Cut in the printer driver. In the Control Panel menu, Cutting Mode is set to Eject or Manual. If the Cutting Mode is Eject, press the Cut button to cut the paper. If the Cutting Mode is Manual, cut rolls with scissors or the like. Depression on the leading edge is left Cause Keeping a roll in the printer for a long time without printing on it may leave a depression on the leading edge. Corrective Action When printing quality is most important, we recommend setting TrimEdge Reload to On or Automatic so that the paper edge is automatically cut before printing. (→P.35) The size of clear lm cannot be detected Cause The Platen is soiled with ink or other substances. Corrective Action Open the Top Cover and clean the entire Platen. (→P.647) Troubleshooting 665 Problems Regarding Paper Roll Paper is Continuously Ejected Cause Corrective Action Although sheets are selected as the paper source, a roll was advanced. After roll ejection stops, follow these steps to reload the roll. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Open the Roll Cover. 3. Using both hands, rotate the Roll Holder toward the back to rewind the roll. At this time, ensure that both ends of the roll are rewound evenly. 4. Pull the Release Lever forward. 5. Load the roll. At this time, be sure to press the Load button and select Load Roll Paper. (→P.106) 666 Troubleshooting Printing does not start Printing does not start The Data Reception Lamp on the Control Panel does not light up Cause Corrective Action The printer is not on. Make sure the power cord is securely plugged in, all the way. Press the Power button to turn on the printer. The printer is not selected in the printer driver. (The printer is in Sleep mode.) In Windows, select the printer by clicking Select Printer or Printer in the printing dialog box and try printing again. The print job is paused. (The printer is in Sleep mode.) In Windows, restart the print job as follows. 1. Select the printer icon in the Printers and Faxes (or Printers) window. 2. Clear Pause Printing in the File menu to restart the print job. In Mac OS X, select the printer by clicking Printer Setup Utility (or Print Center) and try printing again. In Mac OS X, restart the print job as follows. 1. Click Print & Fax. (This is identied as Printer Setup Utility in some versions of Mac OS X.) 2. Select the printer, and then Start Jobs in the Printers menu to restart the print job. The printer does not respond even if print jobs are sent Cause In the Control Panel menu, Pause Print is On. Corrective Action Set Pause Print to Off. (→P.94) Ink Filling.. is displayed Cause The printer was forced off during operation. Corrective Action Wait until the system has been lled with ink. This process may take about seven and a half minutes. The display screen indicates Agitating Cause Ink agitation is in progress. Corrective Action Please wait until ink agitation is nished. The time for agitation varies depending on how long the printer has been off. (Between about 30 seconds and two minutes.) Troubleshooting 667 The printer stops during a print job The printer stops during a print job An error message is shown on the Display Screen Status Corrective Action An error message is displayed during printing. Check the error message and take action as necessary. (See "Error Messages.") The last portion of roll paper was used during a print job, and paper could not be advanced because the trailing edge is taped to the roll. Remove the used roll and insert a new roll. (→P.116) (→P.118) (→P.78) The printer ejects blank, unprinted paper Status Corrective Action The leading edge of the roll paper was cut to straighten it. The leading edge of rolls may be cut to straighten it if you have selected Trim Edge First > On or Automatic in the Control Panel menu. (→P.133) The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles and make sure the Printhead is in good condition for printing. (→P.630) A print job was received from an incompatible printer Use the correct imagePROGRAF printer driver for driver. the printer and try printing again. The printer has received print data that includes HP RTL commands when Auto Rotate is On in the Control Panel menu. In the Control Panel, set Auto Rotate to Off and print again. (→P.49) The printer is damaged. Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. The printer stops when printing a HP-GL/2 job (the carriage stops moving) Cause Corrective Action The printer is analyzing the print job. Please wait a while until printing is nished. A job was printed when Input Resolution in the Control Panel menu was set to 600dpi. In the Control Panel menu, set Input Resolution to 300dpi and print again. (→P.49) 668 Troubleshooting Problems with the printing quality Problems with the printing quality Printing is faint Cause Corrective Action You may be printing on the wrong side of the paper. Print on the printing surface. The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles and see if they are clogged. (→P.630) Because the printer was left without ink tanks installed for some time, ink has become clogged in the ink supply system. After the ink tanks have been installed for 24 hours, run Head Cleaning B from the Control Panel. (→P.632) Paper is jammed inside the Top Cover. Follow the steps below to remove the jammed piece of paper inside the Top Cover. 1. Open the Top Cover and make sure the Carriage is not over the Platen. 2. Remove any scraps of paper inside the Top Cover. (→P.120) (→P.145) 3. Close the Top Cover. The ink was not dry when paper was cut. Specify a longer drying period in the Control Panel menu, in Paper Details > Roll DryingTime. (→P.49) Printing may be faint if Print Quality in Advanced Settings in the printer driver is set to Standard or Draft. In Advanced Settings of the printer driver, choose Highest or High in Print Quality. Printing in Draft or Standard mode is faster and consumes less ink than in Highest or High modes, but the printing quality is lower. (→P.187) Troubleshooting 669 Problems with the printing quality Paper rubs against the Printhead Cause The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Corrective Action Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. Paper has been loaded incorrectly, causing it to wrinkle. Reload the paper. (→P.106) (→P.136) The Printhead is set too low in the Control Panel menu. In the Control Panel menu, set Head Height to Automatic. (→P.611) You are printing on heavyweight paper or paper that curls or wrinkles easily after absorbing ink. When printing on Heavyweight Coated Paper or other paper-based media, choose a VacuumStrngth setting of Strong or Strongest in the Control Panel menu. If the paper still rubs, set Head Height to Highest in the Control Panel menu. (→P.621) (→P.611) When printing on CAD Tracing Paper or other lm-based media, choose a VacuumStrngth setting of Standard, Strong, or Strongest in the Control Panel menu. If the paper still rubs, set Head Height to Highest in the Control Panel menu. (→P.621) (→P.611) When printing on paper 0.1 mm (0.004 in) thick or less, choose a VacuumStrngth setting of Weakest in the Control Panel menu. If the paper still rubs, set Head Height to Highest in the Control Panel menu. (→P.621) (→P.611) When you have loaded paper, the paper you have loaded does not match the type selected on the Control Panel. 670 Troubleshooting Be sure to select the correct type of paper in the Control Panel menu when loading paper. (→P.106) (→P.136) Problems with the printing quality The edges of the paper are dirty Cause Corrective Action The Platen has become dirty after borderless printing Open the Top Cover and clean the Platen. or printing on small paper. (→P.647) The type of paper as specied on the printer does not Make sure the same type of paper is specied on the match the type specied in the printer driver. printer as in the printer driver. (→P.110) Make sure the same paper type is specied in the printer driver as on the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. The paper is wrinkled or warped. Straighten out the wrinkles or curls and reload the paper. Do not use paper that has been printed on previously. (→P.106) (→P.136) A cut line is printed because CutDustReduct. is On in the Control Panel menu to reduce cutting dust. If this function is not needed, set CutDustReduct. to Off in the Control Panel menu. (→P.49) The Printhead is set too low in the Control Panel menu. In the Control Panel menu, set Head Height to Automatic. (→P.611) You are printing on heavyweight paper or paper that curls or wrinkles easily after absorbing ink. When printing on Heavyweight Coated Paper or other paper-based media, choose a VacuumStrngth setting of Strong or Strongest in the Control Panel menu. If the paper still rubs, set Head Height to Highest in the Control Panel menu. (→P.621) (→P.611) When printing on CAD Tracing Paper or other lm-based media, choose a VacuumStrngth setting of Standard, Strong, or Strongest in the Control Panel menu. If the paper still rubs, set Head Height to Highest in the Control Panel menu. (→P.621) (→P.611) The Ejection Guide is soiled. Clean the Ejection Guide. (→P.646) Troubleshooting 671 Problems with the printing quality The surface of the paper is dirty Cause Corrective Action The Paper Retainer is soiled. Clean the Paper Retainer. (→P.647) You are using a paper that does not dry easily. In the Control Panel menu, set Roll DryingTime to at least 1 min. (→P.49) When paper that does not dry easily is used for printing, it may curl during printing and touch the Output Tray. In this case, in the Control Panel menu, set Scan Wait Time to an option other than Off. However, note that printing will now take longer. (→P.49) The back side of the paper is dirty Cause Corrective Action The Platen has become dirty after borderless printing Open the Top Cover and clean the Platen. or printing on small paper. (→P.647) The Platen has become soiled because you have set Set Width Detection to On in the Control Panel Width Detection to Off in the Control Panel menu. menu, and then open the Top Cover and clean the Platen. (→P.647) Open the Top Cover and clean the Platen. After this, manually advance the roll onto the Platen before printing. (→P.647) (→P.125) The Paper Retainer is soiled. 672 Troubleshooting Clean the Paper Retainer. (→P.647) Problems with the printing quality Printed colors are inaccurate Cause Corrective Action Color adjustment has not been activated in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver. In the Advanced Settings of the printer driver, access Color Settings in Color Mode to adjust colors. Colors have not been adjusted on the computer or monitor. Refer to the computer and monitor documentation to adjust the colors. Adjust the settings of the color management software, referring to the software documentation as needed. The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles and see if they are clogged. (→P.630) In the Windows printer driver, Application Color Matching Priority is not selected. Click Special Settings on the Layout sheet of the printer driver and select Application Color Matching Priority in the dialog box. Printhead characteristics gradually change through repeated use, and colors may change. Adjust the Printhead alignment. (→P.604) (→P.606) Color may change slightly even on the same model Follow these steps to prepare the printing of printer if you use a different version of the rmware environment. or printer driver, or when you print under different 1. Use the same version of rmware or printer driver. settings or in a different printing environment. 2. Specify the same value for all settings items. Troubleshooting 673 Problems with the printing quality Banding in different colors occurs Cause Corrective Action The paper feed amount is out of adjustment. Adjust the feed amount. (→P.612) Printing does not proceed smoothly because print jobs are interrupted during transmission. Exit other applications and cancel other print jobs. In the Control Panel menu, Adj. Priority is set to Print Length. Setting Adj. Priority to Print Quality in the Control Panel menu and adjusting the feed amount may improve results. (→P.612) The Printhead is out of alignment. Adjust the Printhead alignment. (→P.604) The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles and see if they are clogged. (→P.630) Streaks may occur if you set the Print Quality too low. Choose a higher level of Print Quality in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver and try printing again. Printing in Draft or Standard mode is faster and consumes less ink than in Highest or High modes, but the printing quality is lower. (→P.187) The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. 674 Troubleshooting Problems with the printing quality Colors in printed images are uneven Cause Corrective Action Line Drawing/Text is selected when printing images In Print Priority in the Advanced Settings of the in many solid colors. printer driver, choose Image. You are printing on paper that curls easily. Printed colors may appear uneven on the leading edge of paper that is susceptible to curling. Select a stronger level in VacuumStrngth in the Control Panel menu to increase suction against the paper, and specify a trailing margin of 20 mm (0.79 in) or more. (→P.621) Printed colors may be uneven if you set the Print Quality too low. Choose a higher level of Print Quality in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver. Printing in Draft or Standard mode is faster and consumes less ink than in Highest or High modes, but the printing quality is lower. (→P.187) Color may be uneven between dark and light image areas. Select Unidirectional Printing in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver. When borderless printing is used, the edge of the Specify No in Auto Cut in the printer driver before paper is cut during printing. Thus, ink density may be printing. In this case, the paper can be printed without slightly uneven at the edges. borders on the left and right sides only. Cut the printed document ejected from the printer, then use scissors to cut away the edges on the top and bottom. Choose a higher level of Print Quality in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver. (→P.187) The Printhead is out of alignment. Adjust the Printhead alignment. (→P.604) Allowing printed documents to dry on top of each other may cause uneven colors. To avoid uneven colors, we recommend drying each sheet separately. Density may be uneven if you use Glossy Paper or Coated Paper. In Advanced Settings of the printer driver, choose Highest or High in Print Quality. The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. Troubleshooting 675 Problems with the printing quality Image edges are blurred or white banding occurs Cause Corrective Action The Platen suction is too strong. In the Control Panel menu, set VacuumStrngth to Weakest. (→P.621) The Printhead is set too high in the Control Panel menu. In the Control Panel menu, set Head Height to Lowest. (→P.611) The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. The contrast becomes uneven during printing Cause The paper feed amount is out of adjustment. Corrective Action Adjust the feed amount. (→P.612) The type of paper specied in the printer driver does Load paper of the same type as you have specied not match the type loaded in the printer. in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. 676 Troubleshooting Problems with the printing quality The length of printed images is inaccurate in the feeding direction Cause Corrective Action In the Control Panel menu, Adj. Priority is set to Print Quality. Set Adj. Priority to Print Length in the Control Panel menu, and then execute Adjust Length. (→P.612) The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. Images are printed crooked Cause Corrective Action In the Control Panel menu, Skew Check Lv. is set to In the Control Panel menu, set Skew Check Lv. to Loose or Off. Standard. In the Control Panel menu, Width Detection is set to Off. Set Width Detection to On in the Control Panel menu. Documents are printed in monochrome Cause Corrective Action In the Advanced Settings of the printer driver, Monochrome, Monochrome (BK ink), or Monochrome Bitmap is specied in Color Mode. In the Advanced Settings of the printer driver, specify Color in Color Mode and try printing again. The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Print a test pattern to check the color ink nozzles and see if they are clogged. (→P.630) Troubleshooting 677 Problems with the printing quality Line thickness is not uniform Cause Corrective Action In the Special Settings dialog box of the Windows printer driver, Fast Graphic Process is selected. Access the printer driver Properties dialog box from Print in the File menu of the source application, and follow these steps to print. 1. Clear the option Open Preview When Print Job Starts on the Main sheet. 2. Clear the option Page Layout on the Layout sheet. 3. Click the Special Settings button in the Layout sheet to open the Special Settings dialog box, and remove the check from Fast Graphic Process. The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. Lines are misaligned Cause Corrective Action The Printhead alignment is not adjusted. Adjust the Printhead alignment. (→P.604) (→P.606) (→P.608) The type of paper specied in the printer driver does not match the type loaded in the printer. Load paper of the same type as you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.106) (→P.136) Make sure the same type of paper is specied in the printer driver as you have loaded in the printer. 1. Press the Stop button and stop printing. 2. Change the type of paper in the printer driver and try printing again. Problems with the printing quality caused by the type of paper For paper-specic troubleshooting tips to improve the printing quality, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) 678 Troubleshooting Cannot print over a network Cannot print over a network Cannot connect the printer to the network Cause Corrective Action The Ethernet cable is not connected correctly to the printer’s Ethernet port. 1. Make sure the printer is connected to the network with the correct Ethernet cable, and then turn the printer on. For instructions on connecting the cable, refer to the Setup Guide. 2. Make sure the Link indicator is lit. The bottom indicator is green if the printer is connected via 1000Base-T, while the top indicator is orange if connected via 100Base-TX and the top indicator is green if connected via 10Base-T. If the Link indicator is not lit, check the following points. • Make sure the hub is on. • Make sure the end of the Ethernet cable is connected correctly. Insert the Ethernet cable until it clicks and locks in place. • Make sure there is no problem with the Ethernet cable. If there is any problem, replace the Ethernet cable. • Check the communication mode with the hub. Although the printer normally detects the hub communication mode and transmission rate automatically (in auto negotiation mode), sometimes the hub settings cannot be detected. In this case, congure the connection method manually, specifying the communication mode in use. (→P.578) Cannot print over a TCP/IP network Cause Corrective Action The printer’s IP address is not congured correctly. Make sure the printer’s IP address is congured correctly. (→P.564) (→P.565) The printer’s TCP/IP network settings are not congured correctly. Make sure the printer’s TCP/IP network settings are congured correctly. (→P.570) The computer you are trying to print from is not congured correctly. Make sure the computer’s TCP/IP network settings are congured correctly. (→P.581) (→P.600) Troubleshooting 679 Cannot print over a network Cannot print over a NetWare network Cause Corrective Action The printer’s NetWare settings are not congured correctly. Make sure the printer’s NetWare settings are congured correctly. In particular, make sure a valid frame type is selected. (→P.575) The computer you are trying to print from is not congured correctly. Make sure the computer’s NetWare settings are congured correctly. (→P.593) The NetWare server and services are not congured Check the following points. correctly. 1. Make sure the NetWare le server is running. 2. Make sure there is enough free disk space on the NetWare le server. Insufcient disk space may prevent you from processing large print jobs. 3. Start NWADMIN or PCONSOLE and conrm that the print service is congured correctly and the print queue is available. 4. If data transmission to a printer on another subnet fails, deactivate NCP burst mode in that printer’s network protocol settings. 5. If the printer is used in queue server mode, specify “Other/Unknown” as the printer type. Cannot print over AppleTalk or Bonjour networks Cause Corrective Action The AppleTalk protocol is not enabled on the printer. Activate AppleTalk on the printer. (→P.574) The computer you are trying to print from is not congured correctly. Make sure the computer’s AppleTalk settings are congured correctly. (→P.598) (→P.602) The computer and printer are not on the same network. Due to the nature of Bonjour, you cannot print if the printer is on another network behind a router. Make sure the computer and printer are on the same network. For information about network settings, ask your network administrator. 680 Troubleshooting Installation problems Installation problems Removing Installed Printer Drivers Follow these steps to remove installed printer drivers and utilities. Removing printer drivers (Windows) Remove the printer driver as follows. Note • In Windows 2000/Windows XP/Windows Server 2003/Windows Vista/Windows Server 2008, you must log on with administrative rights, such as those of the “Administrator” account. 1. From the Windows start menu, select Programs >Canon Printer Uninstaller >imagePROGRAF Printer Driver Uninstaller to display the Delete Printer window. 2. 3. 4. Select the printer in the list and click Delete. Click Yes after the Warning message is displayed. Make sure that the printer has been removed from the list, and then click Exit. Removing printer drivers and imagePROGRAF Printmonitor (Macintosh) Remove the printer driver or imagePROGRAF Printmonitor as follows. 1. 2. Insert the User Software CD-ROM provided with the printer in the CD-ROM drive. Start the printer driver installer included in the User Software CD-ROM. Open the OS X folder and double-click iPF Driver Installer X. 3. 4. In the upper left menu, choose Uninstall, and then click Uninstall. Follow the instructions on the screen to remove the printer driver or imagePROGRAF Printmonitor. Removing imagePROGRAF Status Monitor (Windows) Remove imagePROGRAF Status Monitor as follows. 1. From the Windows start menu, select Programs >imagePROGRAF Status Monitor >Uninstaller (imagePROGRAF Status Monitor) to start the wizard. 2. 3. In the wizard window, click Delete, and then click Next. Follow the instructions on the screen to remove imagePROGRAF Status Monitor. Removing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility (Windows) Remove imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility as follows. 1. From the Windows start menu, select Programs >imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility >Uninstaller (imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility) to start the wizard. 2. 3. In the wizard window, click Delete, and then click Next. Follow the instructions on the screen to remove imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility. Troubleshooting 681 HP-GL/2 problems HP-GL/2 problems With HP-GL/2, printing is misaligned Cause Corrective Action The plotter origin is incorrect. Check the printing commands. The Margin setting in the Control Panel menu is incorrect. Adjust the Margin setting values in the Control Panel menu. Lines or images are missing in printed HP-GL/2 jobs. Cause Corrective Action The memory is full. Check the size of the data in the print job. An HP-GL/2 command not supported by this printer was received. Check the print job and settings. The printer has received print data that includes HP RTL commands when Auto Rotate is On in the Control Panel menu. In the Control Panel, set Auto Rotate to Off and print again. (→P.49) Lines are printed too thick or thin in HP-GL/2 print jobs Cause The Width setting in the Control Panel menu is incorrect. Corrective Action Check the Width setting value specied for Pen no. in Palette A or Palette B in the Control Panel menu. If ne lines are printed faintly, setting ThickenFineLines to On will print the lines more distinctly. (→P.49) HP-GL/2 jobs are printed in monochrome (or color) Cause The Color Mode setting in the Control Panel menu is incorrect. Corrective Action Check the Color Mode setting in the Control Panel menu. (→P.49) However, for optimal Printhead performance, the printer consumes trace amounts of color ink even when Monochrome is selected as Color Mode. Printed colors of lines are inaccurate during HP-GL/2 printing Cause Corrective Action AdjustFaintLines is On in the Control Panel menu. Setting AdjustFaintLines to Off in the Control Panel menu may help produce the expected results. However, lines in some colors may appear broken. 682 Troubleshooting HP-GL/2 problems HP-GL/2 jobs are printed 6 mm larger than specied Cause Corrective Action The page size of the HP-GL/2 print job, as created in In the Control Panel menu, set PageSizeProcess1 the source application, is incorrect. to On. (→P.49) HP-GL/2 jobs are printed at maximum size, even if a standard size is specied Cause Corrective Action The page size of the HP-GL/2 print job, as created in In the Control Panel menu, set PageSizeProcess2 the source application, is incorrect. or Conserve Paper to On. The layout will be changed to the optimal layout. (→P.49) HP-GL/2 printing takes a long time Cause Corrective Action Large print jobs with a lot of data take longer to print. Please wait a while until printing is nished. A job was printed when Input Resolution in the Control Panel menu was set to 600dpi. In the Control Panel menu, set Input Resolution to 300dpi and print again. (→P.49) Replotting with HP-GL/2 jobs is not possible. Cause The data was lost because of replotting. Corrective Action Data for replotting is lost after the following operations. In this case, send the print job again. • The memory buffer was cleared from the Control Panel. • The printer was turned off. • The printer has received a new HP-GL/2 print job. • Printing has been canceled The printer stops when printing a HP-GL/2 job (the carriage stops moving) Cause Corrective Action The printer is analyzing the print job. Please wait a while until printing is nished. A job was printed when Input Resolution in the Control Panel menu was set to 600dpi. In the Control Panel menu, set Input Resolution to 300dpi and print again. (→P.49) Troubleshooting 683 Other problems Other problems The printer does not go on Cause Corrective Action The printer is unplugged. Plug the power cord into the outlet, and then turn on the printer. The specied voltage is not supplied. Check the voltage of the outlet and breaker. Use a power source that conforms to the printer specications. (→P.71) 684 Troubleshooting Other problems If the Printer Makes a Strange Sound Cause Corrective Action The printer makes a sound during operation. The following sounds do not indicate a problem with the printer. • There is a sound of suction from the Platen To prevent paper from rising, paper is held against the Platen by suction from Vacuum holes under it. • There is a sound when a different size of paper is used and when the Carriage goes from side to side When paper of a different size is used, a valve is automatically activated to switch the area for paper suction, which may make a sound. This mechanism prevents suction from Vacuum holes where there is no paper. In addition, ink is ejected in sync with the movement of the Carriage back and forth to ensure optimal ink ow. At this time, the valve automatically switches the area for paper suction, which may make a sound. • Roll paper makes a uttering sound during printing There may be a uttering sound when large paper is advanced. • If you suddenly hear the tone for cleaning operations At regular intervals, for printer maintenance, cleaning operations will begin automatically, even if the printer is in Sleep mode. • If you suddenly hear the tone for ink agitation At regular intervals, to ensure optimal printing quality, the ink is agitated automatically, even if the printer is in Sleep mode. Ink agitation takes about 30 seconds. The ink is also agitated automatically under the following conditions. Note that other operations are not possible while Agitating is displayed on the control panel. • After the printer is turned on. (The time for agitation varies depending on how long the printer was off-between about 30 seconds and two minutes.) • After data transmission. (After about a minute and a half, printing operations begin. However, printing may start later after data reception, depending on the size of print data.) • After ink tank replacement. (Ink agitation takes about three and a half minutes.) In other cases, contact your Canon dealer. Troubleshooting 685 Other problems Messages advising to check the maintenance cartridge are not cleared Cause The printer has not detected the new Maintenance Cartridge that was used to replace the old one. Corrective Action Remove the new Maintenance Cartridge you have just installed and insert it again rmly. Restart the printer. The printer consumes a lot of ink Cause Corrective Action Many full-page color images are printed. In print jobs such as photos, images are lled with color. This consumes a lot of ink. This does not indicate a problem with the printer. Head Cleaning B in the Control Panel menu is executed frequently. Head Cleaning B in the Control Panel menu consumes a lot of ink. This does not indicate a problem with the printer. Unless the printer has been moved or stored for a long period or you are troubleshooting Printhead problems, we recommend not performing Head Cleaning B, to the extent possible. You have just nished initial installation, when more ink is consumed to ll the system. After initial installation or at the rst-time use after transfer, ink ows into the system between the Ink Tank and Printhead, which may cause the ink level indicators to drop to 80%. This does not indicate a problem with the printer. The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Check for nozzle clogging. (→P.630) 686 Troubleshooting Other problems Ink Level Detection Ink level detection will be deactivated if you load ink tanks once emptied. Ink level detection Ink tanks specied for this printer feature an ink level detection function to prevent the ink from running out during printing, which prevents printer damage. (→P.622) This function will not work correctly if you use rell ink tanks. As a result, printing stops. Thus, before using rell ink tanks, you must cancel the ink level detection. Printing with the ink level detection canceled may lead to printer damage and printing problems. Canon Inc. is not liable for any damage that may occur as a result of relling ink. Caution • After ink level detection has been released, this function cannot be reactivated for currently loaded Ink Tank. To use ink level detection again, replace the Ink Tank with new ones specied for use with the printer. • Repeatedly removing and inserting an Ink Tank may damage the connection between the Ink Tank and the printer, which may cause ink leakage from the Ink Tank and damage the printer. Releasing ink level detection 1. On the Display Screen, a message indicates that the ink level cannot be detected. After checking the message, press the ► button. 2. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Information, and then press the OK button. 3. A conrmation message is shown on the Display Screen about releasing ink level detection. After checking the message, press the ► button. 4. After checking the message, press the ► button. Troubleshooting 687 Other problems 5. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. 6. Check the message and press the ► button. 7. Check the message and press the ► button. 8. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. 9. A conrmation message about updating ink information is shown on the Display Screen. After checking the message, press the ► button. 10. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Yes, and then press the OK button. Ink level detection is now released. 688 Troubleshooting Messages regarding paper Error Message Messages regarding paper MediaType Mismatch Cause Corrective Action When Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu is set to Pause, the type of paper loaded does not match the type specied in the printer driver. Follow these steps to ensure the paper type matches on the printer and in the printer driver. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. 2. Either change the type of paper specied in the printer driver settings or replace the loaded paper and change the paper type setting on the printer. (→P.78) (→P.81) You tried to print a test pattern for printer adjustment on several sheets, but sheets of different types of paper were used. When printing a test pattern for adjustment, use sheets of the same type of paper, in the required quantity. Replace the paper as follows and perform adjustment again. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. 2. Replace the paper. (→P.81) 3. Execute adjustment again from the control panel menu. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, note that this error may cause paper jams and affect the printing quality. When Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu You can continue to print, but note that this error may is set to Warning, the type of paper loaded does not cause problems in the printing results. match the type specied in the printer driver. Error Message 689 Messages regarding paper The paper is too small. Cause Corrective Action When Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK is set to Pause, paper smaller than the size specied button to resume printing. in the printer driver is loaded. However, note that this error may cause paper jams and affect the printing quality. Adjust the paper size setting in the printer driver to match the size loaded in the printer as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. 2. Change the paper size setting in the printer driver to the size loaded in the printer and try printing again. Replace the loaded paper with paper of a size that matches the size setting in the printer driver as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, and then press the OK button to stop printing. 2. Replace the loaded paper to match the paper width setting in the printer driver and try printing again. When Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu is You can continue to print, but note that this error may set to Warning, paper smaller than the size specied cause problems in the printing results. in the printer driver is loaded. 690 Error Message Messages regarding paper The paper is too small. Replace paper with A4/LTR (vertical) or larger Cause The loaded paper is too small. Corrective Action Replace the paper with paper of A4/Letter (vertical) size or larger as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, press the OK button, and remove the paper. (→P.144) 2. Switch to paper A4/Letter (vertical) or larger. (→P.81) The printer will resume printing. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. Replace roll with 10 in. wide or larger roll. Cause The loaded paper is too small. Corrective Action Replace the roll with a roll 10 inches in width or larger as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, and then press the OK button. (→P.116) (→P.118) 2. Replace the roll with a roll 10 inches wide or larger. (→P.103) (→P.106) The printer will resume printing. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. Remove paper and check pap. size Cause A sheet has come out of the printer during printing. Corrective Action 1. Press the Release Lever back and remove the paper. 2. Reload the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.136) Error Message 691 Messages regarding paper PaprWidth Mismatch Cause Corrective Action When Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu is set to Pause or Warning, the width of the loaded roll does not match the width specied in Fit Roll Paper Width in the printer driver. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, note that this error may cause paper jams and affect the printing quality. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. Follow these steps to replace the roll to match the width specied in the printer driver. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, and then press the OK button. (→P.116) (→P.118) 2. Replace the paper with paper compatible for borderless printing. (→P.103) (→P.106) The printer now starts printing the print job. Make sure the roll width selected in the dialog box displayed when you select Fit Roll Paper Width in the printer driver matches the width of the roll loaded in the printer, and then try printing again. 692 Error Message Messages regarding paper Paper size not detected. Cause Corrective Action Paper has been loaded askew, or warped paper has been loaded. Follow these steps to reload the roll. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Adjust the right edge of the roll to make it parallel to the orange Paper Alignment Line. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.106) If this error recurs after you reload the roll, remove the Roll Holder from the printer, push the roll rmly in until it touches the Roll Holder ange, and reload the Roll Holder in the printer. (→P.103) Follow these step to reload a sheet. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Load the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.136) Because the Platen is soiled with ink or other substances, the size of the clear lm cannot be detected. Open the Top Cover and clean the entire Platen. (→P.647) Error Message 693 Messages regarding paper Insufcient paper for job Cause The printer has received a print job longer than the amount of roll paper left when ManageRemainRoll in the Control Panel menu is On. Corrective Action Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, the roll paper may run out during the print job and you may not be able to print all of the document. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, and then press the OK button to stop printing. Either change the printer driver Paper Source setting or the GL2 Settings > Paper Source setting in the printer menu or replace the roll with a roll that has enough paper for the print job, and then try printing again. (→P.116) (→P.106) This paper cannot be used. Cause Corrective Action Paper smaller than the printer’s minimum supported size has been loaded. Push the Release Lever back and load paper of the correct size. (→P.100) Paper has been loaded that is too small to print the test pattern for printhead adjustment or nozzle checking. Push the Release Lever back and load unused paper of A4 size or larger. More than one sheet may be required depending on the adjustment. Roll printing is selected. Cause You have attempted to print a test print sheet or other printer status information on a roll, but no roll is loaded. Corrective Action Press ▲ or ▼ to select Load Roll Paper, and then press the OK button. Load the roll, and then print. (→P.103) (→P.106) To print on sheets, follow these steps. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button to stop printing. 2. Load a sheet and try printing again. (→P.81) 694 Error Message Messages regarding paper Roll printing is selected, but sheets are loaded. Cause A print job for rolls was received when a sheet is loaded. Corrective Action Follow these steps to load and print on a roll. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Eject Cut Sheet, press the OK button, and remove the sheet. (→P.144) 2. Load a new roll. (→P.106) The printer now starts printing the print job. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. The roll is empty. Cause Corrective Action The roll is empty. Follow these steps to replace the used roll with a new roll of the same type and size. 1. Press the Release Lever back and remove the roll. (→P.116) (→P.118) 2. Load the new roll. (→P.103) (→P.106) 3. If no barcode was printed on the roll, specify the type of paper. (→P.110) 4. When you have selected ManageRemainRoll > On in the control panel menu and a barcode is not printed on the roll, also specify the paper length. (→P.112) 5. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. There is remaining roll paper, but because it could not be advanced, it could not be detected. Choose a higher level of Print Quality in the Advanced Settings of the printer driver. (→P.187) Error Message 695 Messages regarding paper Sheet printing is selected. Cause Corrective Action You have attempted to print a test print sheet or other Press ▲ or ▼ to select Load Cut Sheet, and then printer status information on a sheet, but no sheet press the OK button. Load the sheet, and then print. is loaded. (→P.81) To print on rolls, follow these steps. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button to stop printing. 2. Load a roll and try printing again. (→P.78) Regular printing is selected, but a roll is loaded. Cause A print job for printing on sheets was sent when a roll is loaded. 696 Error Message Corrective Action 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Remove Roll Paper, and then press the OK button to stop printing. 2. After removing the roll, load and print on a sheet of the type and size of paper you have specied in the printer driver. (→P.116) (→P.81) Messages regarding paper Paper jam Push the release lever back. Cause A paper jam occurred in the printer during printing. Corrective Action 1. Push the Release Lever back and remove the jammed paper. (→P.120) (→P.145) 2. Load the paper. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.106) (→P.136) Manually rewind the roll all the way and press OK. Cause A paper jam occurred when advancing the paper. Corrective Action 1. Rewind paper on the Roll Holder manually, all the way, and then press the OK button. 2. Load the paper. 3. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.106) Error Message 697 Messages regarding paper Paper is crooked. Cause Corrective Action Paper loaded crooked was detected when the paper was advanced. Follow these steps to reload the roll. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Adjust the right edge of the roll to make it parallel to the orange Paper Alignment Line. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. (→P.106) If this error recurs after you reload the roll, remove the Roll Holder from the printer, push the roll rmly in until it touches the Roll Holder ange, and reload the Roll Holder in the printer. (→P.103) Follow these step to reload a sheet. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Pull out the sheet. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. Reload the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. (→P.136) Note • To disable this message (if it is displayed repeatedly despite reloading paper, for example), choose Off or Loose in the Skew Check Lv. setting of the printer menu. However, this may cause jams and printing problems because paper may be askew when printed. Also, the Platen may become soiled, which may soil the back of the next document when it is printed. 698 Error Message Messages regarding paper Paper not aligned with right guide. Cause Corrective Action When paper was loaded, it was not aligned with the guide on the right side. Follow these step to reload a sheet. 1. Push the Release Lever back. 2. Pull out the sheet. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. Reload the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. Cannot detect papr Cause The paper has come out of the printer. Corrective Action Follow these step to reload a sheet. 1. Remove the paper and press the OK button. 2. Reload the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. (→P.136) Follow these step to reload a sheet. 1. Push the Release Lever back and remove the paper. 2. Pull the Release Lever forward. 3. Reload the sheet, aligning it with the guide on the right. (→P.136) Error Message 699 Messages regarding paper Paper cutting failed. Cause There are sheets left on the Ejection Guide. Corrective Action 1. Push the Release Lever back and remove the paper. 2. Load the paper. 3. Pull the Release Lever forward. 4. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. (→P.106) There is a foreign object by the Output Tray, obstructing the Cutter Unit. 1. Lift the Top Cover and remove the foreign object. 2. If Not nished printing. Finish printing remaining jobs? is shown on the Display Screen, press the OK button. Printing will resume, starting from the page on which the error occurred. You are not using the printer under the recommended Use the printer only where the recommended environmental conditions for the paper. environmental conditions for the paper are met. Note that various environmental conditions are recommended for various types of paper. For details on the recommended environmental conditions for paper, see Paper Reference Guide." (→P.95) You are using paper that is not compatible with automatic cutting. 1. Specify Manual as the cutting method and use In other cases, the Cutter Unit may be damaged. Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. scissors or a cutting tool to cut the roll. (→P.129) For information about paper that is compatible with automatic cutting, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) 2. Push the Release Lever back and remove the paper. End of paper feed. Cause You are pressing the ▲ button on the Control Panel and trying to rewind the roll to the edge. 700 Error Message Corrective Action Release the ▲ button. Messages regarding paper Rel lever is in wrong position. Cause The Release Lever is pushed back. Corrective Action Pull the Release Lever forward. Turn off the printer and wait a while before restoring power. Borderless printng not possible. Cause Corrective Action The print job received species a type or width of paper that is not compatible with borderless printing. Follow these steps to change the settings of the print job to enable borderless printing. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. 2. Make sure the correct printer driver for the printer is selected and try printing again. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Select None when you have set Detect Mismatch on the control panel to Warning. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print With Border, and then press the OK button to continue printing. The document will be printed with a border. The loaded paper is a size not compatible with borderless printing. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. Replace the paper with paper compatible for borderless printing as follows. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Change Paper, and then press the OK button. (→P.116) (→P.118) 2. Replace the paper with paper compatible for borderless printing. (→P.103) (→P.106) The printer now starts printing the print job. For information on types of paper compatible with borderless printing, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print With Border, and then press the OK button to continue printing. The document will be printed with a border. Error Message 701 Messages regarding paper Paper position not suitable for borderless printing. Cause Corrective Action Because paper expands or contracts depending on Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then the environment of use, it may become narrower or press the OK button. wider than the supported width for borderless printing. Use each type of paper only where the recommended environmental conditions are met. For details on environmental conditions for various paper, see the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Select None when you have set Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu to Warning. However, note that this error may affect the printing quality. The paper is loaded askew. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Fix Paper Position and straighten the paper so that the edges are between the ink grooves for borderless printing. Insert the roll rmly until it touches the ange of the Roll Holder. (→P.103) Select None when you have set Detect Mismatch in the Control Panel menu to Warning. However, note that this error may affect the printing quality. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print With Border, and then press the OK button to continue printing. The document will be printed with a border. Roll paper is not securely in contact with roll holder. Cause When the roll was loaded, the roll was not inserted rmly all the way on the Roll Holder. 702 Error Message Corrective Action Follow these steps to reload the roll. 1. Press the OK button and remove the roll holder from the printer. 2. Insert the roll rmly on the Roll Holder until it touches the ange. (→P.103) 3. Load the Roll Holder in the printer. Messages regarding ink Messages regarding ink Ink insufcient. Cause The ink level is low, so you cannot print, clean the Printhead, or do other operations that require ink. Corrective Action Press ▲ or ▼ to select Rep. Ink Tank, and then press the OK button. Replace the Ink Tank that is low with a new Ink Tank. (→P.623) Press ▲ or ▼ to select Continue to print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, note that this error may affect the printing quality. No ink left. Cause There is no ink left. Corrective Action Open the Ink Tank Cover and replace the Ink Tank for which the Ink Lamp is ashing. (→P.623) Remaining level of the ink cannot be correctly detected. Cause Ink level detection cannot work correctly if you use rell ink tanks. Corrective Action The rell ink tank can no longer be used. See the section “Ink level detection” and take the appropriate action. (→P.687) Unable to detect ink level correctly. Cause The remaining ink level could not be correctly detected. Corrective Action Close the Ink Tank Cover. The buzzer will stop once the error is cleared. Close Ink Tank Cover Cause The Ink Tank Cover is open. Corrective Action Close the Ink Tank Cover. The buzzer will stop once the error is cleared. Error Message 703 Messages regarding ink Ink tank is empty. Cause There is no ink left in an ink tank. Corrective Action Open the Ink Tank Cover and replace the Ink Tank for which the Ink Lamp is ashing. (→P.623) Not much ink is left. Cause Not much ink is left. Corrective Action Prepare a new Ink Tank. We recommend replacing the Ink Tank with a new Ink Tank at this point if you plan to print large-format or high-quantity jobs. No ink tank loaded. Cause Corrective Action There is no Ink Tank of the indicated color in the printer. Load or reload the Ink Tank. (→P.623) There is a problem with the Ink Tank. Replace it with a new Ink Tank. (→P.623) Wrong ink tank. Cause The Ink Tank in the printer is incompatible. Corrective Action Load an Ink Tank specied for use with the printer. (→P.623) Do not pull out ink tank. Cause The remaining ink level could not be correctly detected. 704 Error Message Corrective Action Install the Ink Tank that was removed. The buzzer will stop once the error is cleared. Messages regarding printing or adjustment Messages regarding printing or adjustment Cannot adjust printhead. Cause Corrective Action The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again, as follows. 1. Press the OK button to clear the error. 2. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. (→P.630) 3. Clean the Printhead if the nozzles are clogged. (→P.632) 4. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again. (→P.604) The Printhead cannot be aligned; highly transparent lm is loaded. Press the OK button to clear the error. We recommend using a type of paper that you often use, other than lm, for Printhead adjustment. (→P.604) The Printhead is installed crooked. Straighten the Printhead as follows, and then execute Head Posi. Adj. again. 1. Press the OK button to clear the error. 2. Use Head Inc. Adj. to adjust the angle of inclination of the Printhead. (→P.608) 3. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again. (→P.604) Cannot adjust paper feed. Cause The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Corrective Action Execute Adj. Quality again, as follows. 1. Press the OK button to clear the error. 2. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. (→P.630) 3. Clean the Printhead if the nozzles are clogged. (→P.632) 4. Execute Adj. Quality again. (→P.614) Highly transparent lm is loaded that cannot be used Press the OK button to clear the error, and then for automatic feed amount adjustment. adjust the feed amount manually. (→P.616) Error Message 705 Messages regarding printing or adjustment Check printed document. Cause The Printhead nozzles are becoming clogged. 706 Error Message Corrective Action If printing is faint, clean the Printhead. (→P.632) Messages regarding printheads Messages regarding printheads Cannot adjust printhead. Cause Corrective Action The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again, as follows. 1. Press the OK button to clear the error. 2. Print a test pattern to check the nozzles. (→P.630) 3. Clean the Printhead if the nozzles are clogged. (→P.632) 4. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again. (→P.604) The Printhead cannot be aligned; highly transparent lm is loaded. Press the OK button to clear the error. We recommend using a type of paper that you often use, other than lm, for Printhead adjustment. (→P.604) The Printhead is installed crooked. Straighten the Printhead as follows, and then execute Head Posi. Adj. again. 1. Press the OK button to clear the error. 2. Use Head Inc. Adj. to adjust the angle of inclination of the Printhead. (→P.608) 3. Execute Head Posi. Adj. again. (→P.604) Wrong printhead. Cause An incompatible Printhead has been installed. Corrective Action Open the Top Cover and replace the Printhead with a new one. (→P.633) Printhead error Cause There is a problem with the Printhead. Corrective Action Open the Top Cover and replace the Printhead with a new one. (→P.633) Error Message 707 Messages regarding printheads No printhead Cause No Printhead is installed. Corrective Action Install the Printhead. (→P.633) Execute printhead cleaning. Cause The Printhead nozzles are clogged. Corrective Action Follow these steps to clean the Printhead. 1. Stop printing by pressing ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing. 2. Clean the Printhead. (→P.632) If this message is still displayed, replace the Printhead. (→P.633) Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, note that this error may affect the printing quality. If OK is shown on the Display Screen, clean the Printhead. 1. Press the OK button on the Control Panel to stop printing. 2. Clean the Printhead. (→P.632) If this message is still displayed, replace the Printhead. (→P.633) 708 Error Message Messages regarding the maintenance cartridge Messages regarding the maintenance cartridge Insert the maintenance cartridge. Cause The Maintenance Cartridge is not installed. Corrective Action Install the Maintenance Cartridge. (→P.639) Wrong maintenance cartridge. Cause A Maintenance Cartridge for a different model of printer is installed. Corrective Action Replace it with the Maintenance Cartridge for your particular model. Maint. cart. The level is low Cause The Maintenance Cartridge is almost full. Corrective Action You can continue to print, but prepare a new Maintenance Cartridge to use when the message for replacement is displayed. No Maintenance Cartridge capacity. Cause The Maintenance Cartridge cannot absorb enough ink for Printhead cleaning or other operation. Corrective Action After conrming that the printer has stopped operating, replace the Maintenance Cartridge. (→P.639) Maintenance cartridge full. Cause The Maintenance Cartridge is full. Corrective Action After conrming that the printer has stopped operating, replace the Maintenance Cartridge. (→P.639) Maintenance cartridge problem. Cause Corrective Action An incompatible or used Maintenance Cartridge has been installed. Install an unused Maintenance Cartridge specied for use with the printer. (→P.639) Error Message 709 Messages regarding HP-GL/2 Messages regarding HP-GL/2 This type of paper is not compatible with HP-GL/2. Cause The printer has received a HP-GL/2 print job that cannot be printed on the paper that has been advanced. Corrective Action Follow these steps to replace the type of paper in the printer. 1. Press ▲ or ▼ to select Stop Printing, and then press the OK button. 2. Replace the paper with a type compatible with HP-GL/2. For details on paper compatible with HP-GL/2, refer to the Paper Reference Guide. (→P.95) Press ▲ or ▼ to select Print, and then press the OK button to resume printing. However, note that this error may cause paper jams and affect the printing quality. GL2: Wxxxx The memory is full. (xxxx is 0501, 0903, or 0904) Cause The printer memory is full. Corrective Action Because the entire print job could not be received, the printer may not be able to print the entire original. Check the printing results. GL2: W0502 The parameter is out of range. Cause A parameter specied in a HP-GL/2 command is out of the supported range. Corrective Action Check the print job. If you have specied ProcessingOption > Warning > On in the Control Panel menu, set it to Off instead. GL2: W0504 This command is not supported. Cause The printer has received an unsupported HP-GL/2 command. 710 Error Message Corrective Action Check the print job. If you have specied ProcessingOption > Warning > On in the Control Panel menu, set it to Off instead. Other Messages Other Messages GARO Wxxxx (x represents a number) Cause There is a problem with the print job. Corrective Action Try printing again, using the correct printer driver. It is also possible to continue printing in this state. However, you may not be able to obtain the desired printing results. ERROR Exxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number) Cause An error requiring service may have occurred. Corrective Action Write down the error code and message, turn off the printer, and contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Hardware error. xxxxxxxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number) Cause Corrective Action The last portion of roll paper was used during a print job. The paper was not advanced because the trailing edge is taped to the roll. Turn off the printer and remove the roll from the printer before restoring power. Fastening tape or the Belt Stopper has not been removed inside the Top Cover. Turn off the printer, open the Top Cover and remove the tape or the Belt Stopper before restoring power. An error requiring service may have occurred. Turn off the printer and wait at least three seconds before restoring the power. If the message is displayed again, write down the error code and message, turn off the printer, and contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Top cover is open. Cause Corrective Action The printer has detected that the Top Cover is open. Open the Top Cover fully, remove any foreign objects, and close the Top Cover again. If the error occurs again, close the Top Cover, turn off the printer, and wait a while before restoring power. Error Message 711 Other Messages Prepare for parts replacement. Cause It is almost time to replace consumables for which service is required. Corrective Action You can continue to use the printer for some time until Parts replacement time has passed. will be displayed. Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Parts replacement time has passed. Cause It is past the recommended time to replace consumables for which service is required. Corrective Action Contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Unknown le. Cause Corrective Action Data sent to keep the printer up to date (such as paper information) is in the wrong format. Check the data. Turn off the printer and wait a while before restoring power, and then resend the data. You have uploaded rmware for a different model. Check the rmware version. Turn off the printer and wait a while before restoring power, and then resend the rmware. If the message is displayed again, contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Multi-sensor error Cause Corrective Action Direct sunlight or strong lighting may be shining on the printer and causing the sensor to malfunction. Take steps to ensure the printer is not used when exposed to direct sunlight or strong lighting. The performance of a sensor inside the printer may be impaired. Turn off the printer and wait at least three seconds before restoring the power. If the message is displayed again, contact your Canon dealer for assistance. Error in cutter position. Cause The Cutter Unit stops in the middle of cutting. Corrective Action 1. Push the Release Lever back and remove the paper. 2. Pull the Release Lever forward. 712 Error Message Index Index A Attaching the Roll Holder to Rolls............................103 About This User Manual..............................................1 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Mac OS X).........................................460 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from Applications (Windows)...........................................346 Accessing the Printer Driver Dialog Box from the Operating System Menu (Windows)........................348 Accounting...............................................................437 Accounting Manager...............................................437 Accounting Manager Basic Procedures..................441 Accounting Manager Main Window.........................438 Job List Area......................................................439 Listed Job Selection Area..................................439 Menu Bar . ........................................................438 Status Bar..........................................................440 Title Bar.............................................................438 Toolbars.............................................................438 Totals Area.........................................................440 Additional Settings Pane (Mac OS X).....................474 Data Send Method............................................474 Adjusting Images.....................................................177 Adjusting Line Length (Adjust Length)....................619 Adjusting Line Misalignment (Head Inc. Adj.)..........608 Adjusting the Color in the Printer Driver..................177 Color Adjustment...............................................178 Automatic Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.)..........................................604 Automatic Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality)..........614 Automatically Acquiring Print Job Logs at Regular Intervals...................................................................446 B Banding in different colors occurs...........................674 Basic Printing Workflow.............................................76 Binding Settings Dialog Box....................................420 Binding..............................................................420 Binding Edge.....................................................420 Fold Line Color..................................................420 Fold Line Type...................................................420 Only Print Center and Edges.............................420 Print Fold Lines.................................................420 Borderless Printing..................................................232 Borderless Printing at Actual Size...................225, 246 Borderless Printing....................................225, 246 Borderless Printing Method.......................225, 246 Print Image with Actual Size......................226, 247 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Mac OS X)......................................................229, 250 Borderless Printing at Actual Size (Windows).......................................................227, 248 Color Mode........................................................177 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width................................................................239 Matching............................................................179 Borderless Printing............................................239 Adjusting the feed amount.......................................612 Borderless Printing Method...............................239 Adjusting the Printhead...........................................603 Scale to fit Roll Paper Width..............................240 Adjusting the Vacuum Strength (VacuumStrngth)...621 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X)............................................243 Adjustments for Better Print Quality........................603 Advanced Settings..................................484, 512, 548 Print Priority.......................................484, 512, 548 Print Quality.......................................484, 512, 548 Aligning Objects.............................................. 411, 531 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows)..............................................241 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X).....................................236 Align Bottom.............................................. 411, 531 Borderless Printing by Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows).......................................234 Align Left...................................................412, 532 Borderless Printing on Paper of Equivalent Size.....232 Align Right.................................................412, 532 Borderless Printing............................................232 Align Top.................................................... 411, 531 Borderless Printing Method...............................232 Center Horizontally....................................412, 532 Fit Paper Size....................................................233 Center Vertically........................................ 411, 531 Borderless printng not possible...............................701 An error message is shown on the Display Screen.....................................................................668 Index 713 Index C Choosing Paper for Printing....................................194 Canceling print jobs...................................................90 Canceling Print Jobs from Mac OS X........................92 Canceling Print Jobs from the Control Panel............90 Canceling Print Jobs from Windows..........................91 Canceling Regular Print Job Log Acquisition..........446 Cannot adjust paper feed........................................705 Cannot adjust printhead..................................705, 707 Cannot connect the printer to the network..............679 Cannot detect papr..................................................699 Cannot load sheets.................................................665 Cannot print over a NetWare network.....................680 Cannot print over a network....................................679 Cannot print over a TCP/IP network........................679 Cannot print over AppleTalk or Bonjour networks...680 Carriage.....................................................................17 Centering originals..................................................289 Changing the Object Overlapping Order.........413, 533 Bring Forward............................................413, 534 Bring to Front.............................................413, 533 Send Backward.........................................414, 534 Send to Back.............................................413, 533 Changing the Object Size................................408, 528 Resizing by means of mouse operation....408, 528 Resizing by specifying a scaling value......408, 528 Changing the Type of Paper.................... 110, 139, 195 Changing the Type of Paper.............. 110, 139, 195 Using the Same Type of Paper Regularly........................................... 111, 140, 196 Check printed document.........................................706 Checking for Nozzle Clogging.................................630 Checking Images Before Printing............................313 Checking Ink Tank Levels........................................628 Checking Instructions During Printer Operations......69 How to view instructions......................................69 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing....313 Open Preview When Print Job Starts (Windows).........................................................313 Preview (Macintosh)..........................................314 Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Mac OS X)............................................192 Choosing the Document Type and Printing Conditions (Windows).............................................190 Cleaning Inside the Top Cover................................647 Cleaning the Printer.................................................646 Cleaning the Printer Exterior...................................646 Cleaning the Printhead....................................632, 650 Clearing a Jammed Sheet...............................145, 662 Clearing Jammed Paper (Paper Feed Slot)....................................123, 148, 657 Clearing Jammed Roll Paper..........................120, 659 Close Ink Tank Cover..............................................703 Color Adjustment.............................................488, 514 Adjusting Color..........................................488, 514 Adjusting Monochrome..............................489, 515 Color Adjustment Sheet: Color (Windows)..............356 Apply to Sample................................................356 Brightness.........................................................356 Contrast.............................................................356 Cyan / Magenta / Yellow....................................356 Defaults.............................................................357 Gray Tone..........................................................356 Object Adjustment.............................................357 Sample Type.....................................................356 Saturation..........................................................357 View Color Pattern............................................356 Color Adjustment Sheet: Monochrome (Windows)...361 Apply to Sample................................................361 Brightness.........................................................361 Contrast.............................................................361 Cyan / Magenta / Yellow....................................361 Defaults.............................................................362 Gray Tone..........................................................361 Object Adjustment.............................................362 Sample Type.....................................................361 Saturation..........................................................362 View Color Pattern............................................361 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.......421, 536 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Mac OS X)......................................................317, 459 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy Dialog Box..................................................................424, 538 Checking the Layout in a Preview Before Printing (Windows).......................................................315, 342 About Button......................................................424 Add Button.................................................424, 538 Checking the Remaining Maintenance Cartridge Capacity..................................................................644 Add to Startup folder.........................................424 Choosing a Paper for Printing.................................194 Delete files in the folder.....................................538 If the paper type is not listed for selection.........194 Media Type........................................................194 714 Index Delete Button.............................................424, 538 Delete the entire folders, as well as items in the list above...........................................................538 Index Edit Button.................................................424, 538 Hot Folder..........................................................424 Monitor Hot Folder Constantly...........................538 Operation Guide Button.....................................424 Save Printed Data.............................................424 Start Button.......................................................424 Stop Button........................................................424 Color Settings Pane: Color (Mac OS X)..................467 Configuring the Destination for Bonjour Network (Macintosh)..............................................................602 Configuring the Destination in TCP/IP Networks (Macintosh)..............................................................600 Configuring the Destination (Mac OS X)...........600 Configuring the IP Address on the Printer...............563 Configuring the IP Address Using ARP and PING Commands..............................................................567 Apply to Sample................................................467 Configuring the IP Address Using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility.................................453, 564, 595 Brightness.........................................................467 When specifying an IPv4 IP address...453, 564, 595 Color Adjustment pane: color............................467 When specifying an IPv6 IP address...453, 564, 595 Contrast.............................................................467 Configuring the IP Address Using the Printer Control Panel.......................................................................565 Cyan / Magenta / Yellow....................................467 Gray Tone..........................................................467 Matching Method...............................................468 Matching Mode..................................................468 Matching pane...................................................468 Object Adjustment.............................................468 Sample Type.....................................................467 Saturation..........................................................468 View Color Pattern............................................467 Color Settings Pane: Monochrome (Mac OS X)......469 Apply to Sample................................................469 Brightness.........................................................469 Color Adjustment pane: Monochrome...............469 Contrast.............................................................469 Cyan / Magenta / Yellow....................................469 Gray Tone..........................................................469 Object Adjustment.............................................470 Sample Type.....................................................469 Saturation..........................................................470 View Color Pattern............................................469 Color Settings Panel................................487, 513, 551 Color Adjustment / Matching.....................487, 513 Color Mode........................................487, 513, 551 Mode.................................................................551 Print Button................................................487, 513 Restore Defaults Button............................487, 513 Update Printer Info. Button........................487, 513 Colors in printed images are uneven.......................675 ColorSync................................................494, 520, 554 Configuring NetWare Network Settings...................593 Configuring TCP/IPv6 Network Settings..................568 Configuring the Communication Mode Manually.....578 Configuring the Destination for AppleTalk Networks (Macintosh)..............................................................598 Activating AppleTalk on the printer....................598 Configuring the Printer Driver Destination (Macintosh)..............................................................596 Configuring the Printer Driver Destination (Windows)...............................................................581 Configuring the Printer's AppleTalk Network Settings...........................................................574, 597 Configuring the Printer's NetWare Network Settings...........................................................575, 584 Configuring the Printer's TCP/IP Network Settings...................................................................570 When using an IPv4 IP address........................570 When using an IPv6 IP address........................572 Configuring Unit Costs in Accounting Manager.......441 Configuring Units and Display Settings in Accounting Manager...............................................445 1000 Separator..................................................445 Area Display Format..........................................445 Currency Unit....................................................445 Date Display Format..........................................445 Decimal Symbol................................................445 Ink Consumed...................................................445 Paper Length.....................................................445 Paper Width.......................................................445 Confirming Print Settings (Mac OS X).....................457 Checking a preview of the settings....................457 Checking a print preview...................................458 Confirming Print Settings (Windows).......................340 Checking a preview of the settings....................340 Checking a print preview...................................341 Conserving roll paper..............................................301 Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins.........................................307 No Spaces at Top or Bottom (Conserve Paper)..............................................307 Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Mac OS X)......................310 Configuring the destination (Mac OS X)............599 Index 715 Index Conserving Roll Paper by Printing Originals Without Top and Bottom Margins (Windows).......................308 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees...................................................................301 E Easy Settings..........................................482, 510, 546 Print Quality....................................... 483, 511, 547 Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper)......301 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Mac OS X)...............................................304 Conserving Roll Paper by Rotating Originals 90 Degrees (Windows).................................................302 Control Panel.......................................................20, 22 Control Panel Display................................................26 Mode transition....................................................28 Printer status and modes....................................27 Types of tabs.......................................................26 Creating a New Hot Folder..............................426, 539 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing..............................331 Automatic Cutting..............................................331 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Mac OS X)..........333 Print Target........................................482, 510, 546 Editing a Hot Folder (Setting Print Conditions)........541 Email Notification When Printing is Finished or Errors Occur............................................................579 End of paper feed....................................................700 Enhanced Printing Options......................................177 Enlarge/Reduce the screen display.........................389 ERROR Exxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number)............................. 711 Error in cutter position.............................................712 Error Message.........................................................689 Execute printhead cleaning.....................................708 Exporting Print Job Data as a CSV File..................447 Listed Jobs........................................................447 Cutting Roll Paper After Printing (Windows)............332 Cutting the Leading Edge of Roll Paper Automatically...........................................................133 D Selected Jobs....................................................447 F Favorites Sheet (Windows).....................................372 Deleting a Hot Folder..............................................543 Depression on the leading edge is left....................665 Detailed Settings.....................................................394 Device Settings Sheet (Windows)...........................377 About.................................................................377 Color Compatibility............................................377 Device Setup Utility.................................................452 Dialog Area..............................................................382 Cancel Button....................................................382 Center Originals Across Roll.............................382 Layout Selection................................................382 Media Type / Paper Source /Paper Size...........382 No Spaces at Top or Bottom.............................382 Print Button........................................................382 Printer Information.............................................383 Status Monitor Button........................................383 Update Printer Information Button.....................383 Add....................................................................373 Application Settings Priority...............................372 Apply Favorite...................................................372 Comment...........................................................372 Delete................................................................372 Down.................................................................373 Edit....................................................................372 Export................................................................373 Favorites............................................................372 Import................................................................373 Settings Details.................................................372 Up......................................................................373 Feeding Roll Paper Manually..................................125 Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Mac OS X)..............................................................184 Fine-Tuning Colors of Photos and Images (Windows)...............................................................181 Digital Photo Front-Access......................................449 Fine-Tuning the Paper Feed Amount (Adj. Fine Feed).......................................................618 Display with Actual Size..........................................502 Finished Size Settings Dialog Box..........................419 Display with All........................................................501 Finished Size.....................................................419 Display with Fitting to the Width of the Paper..........500 Folded Duplex Window...........................................416 Do not pull out ink tank............................................704 Layout Area.......................................................417 Documents are printed in monochrome..................677 Menu Bar...........................................................416 Driver Matching Mode.............................492, 518, 552 Status Bar..........................................................417 Tool Bar.............................................................416 716 Index Index Format Dialog Box...........................................399, 525 Enl./Red.............................................................399 Object Position..................................................400 Object Size................................................400, 525 Position Sheet...................................................400 Rotate........................................................399, 525 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed in monochrome (or color)..................................................................682 HP-GL/2 Printing.....................................................170 HP-GL/2 printing takes a long time.........................683 HP-GL/2 problems...................................................682 HTML Version of the Manual for Printing.....................5 Printing a group of individual topics in the manual...................................................................7 Scaling...............................................................525 Size Sheet.........................................................399 Printing a group of topics in the manual................5 Free Layout.....................................................390, 504 Free Layout Main Window...............................393, 506 Dialog Area........................................................507 Layout Area...............................................393, 506 Printing selected topics.......................................10 I Menu Bar...................................................393, 506 ICC Matching Mode.................................493, 519, 553 Status Bar..........................................................394 If the Printer Makes a Strange Sound.....................685 Tool Bar.....................................................393, 506 Image edges are blurred or white banding occurs....676 Frequently Asked Questions...................................655 imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility.....................452 Front..........................................................................13 Images are printed crooked.....................................677 Initializing the Network Settings..............................580 G Ink Filling.. is displayed...........................................667 GARO Wxxxx (x represents a number)................... 711 Giving Priority to Particular Graphic Elements and Colors for Printing....................................................187 Advanced Settings............................................187 Color Settings....................................................188 Enhancing printing quality.................................189 Print Priority.......................................................187 Print Quality.......................................................187 GL2: W0502 The parameter is out of range............710 GL2: W0504 This command is not supported.........710 GL2: Wxxxx The memory is full. (xxxx is 0501, 0903, or 0904)..................................710 Go to Page Dialog Box............................................495 Page..................................................................495 H Handling Paper..........................................................95 Handling rolls...........................................................103 Handling sheets.......................................................136 Hardware error. xxxxxxxx-xxxx (x represents a letter or number)............................. 711 Hot Folder........................................................425, 539 How to use this manual...............................................1 How to View Instructions With Navigate....................29 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed 6 mm larger than specified..................................................................683 HP-GL/2 jobs are printed at maximum size, even if a standard size is specified.....................................683 Ink insufficient..........................................................703 Ink Level Detection..................................................687 Ink level detection..............................................687 Releasing ink level detection.............................687 Ink Tank Cover (Inside)..............................................18 Ink tank is empty......................................................704 Ink Tanks.................................................................622 Insert the maintenance cartridge.............................709 Installation problems...............................................681 Installing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility................................................................452, 594 Insufficient paper for job..........................................694 Introduction..................................................................1 J Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Printmonitor.............................................................558 Canceling Print Jobs.........................................558 Pausing/Resuming Print Jobs...........................558 Preempting Other Jobs.....................................558 Printing Held Jobs.............................................559 Job Management Using imagePROGRAF Status Monitor....................................................................436 Canceling Print Jobs.........................................436 Pausing/Resuming Print Jobs...........................436 Preempting Other Jobs.....................................436 Printing Held Jobs.............................................436 Index 717 Index K Print Priority.......................................................463 Print Quality...............................................462, 463 Keeping Track of the Amount of Roll Paper Left.....126 Print Target........................................................462 Printer................................................................461 L Reduce Print Unevenness.................................463 Launching the Accounting Manager........................437 Set.............................................................461, 463 Laying out a Document Created with Multiple Application Programs on One Page................404, 526 Sharpen Text.....................................................463 Thicken Fine Lines............................................463 Laying out a Multiple-File Document on One Page................................................................401, 526 Unidirectional Printing.......................................463 Laying out Objects Automatically....................410, 530 Main Sheet (Windows)............................................350 Layout Sheet (Windows).........................................368 Copies...............................................................369 Defaults.............................................................369 Edit Watermark..................................................368 No Spaces at Top or Bottom (Conserve Paper)..............................................369 Page Layout......................................................368 Page Options.....................................................369 Print Centered...................................................368 Reverse Order...................................................369 Rotate 180 degrees...........................................368 Set.....................................................................368 Special Settings.................................................369 Watermark.........................................................368 Watermarks.......................................................368 Line thickness is not uniform...................................678 Lines are misaligned...............................................678 Lines are printed too thick or thin in HP-GL/2 print jobs..........................................................................682 Lines or images are missing in printed HP-GL/2 jobs..........................................................................682 Loading and Printing on Rolls...................................78 Loading and Printing on Sheets................................81 Loading Rolls in the Printer.....................................106 Loading Sheets in the Printer..................................136 M Mac OS X Software.................................................454 Main Pane (Mac OS X)...........................................461 Color Mode........................................................463 Common Items..................................................461 Configuration using Advanced Settings.............463 Configuration using Easy Settings....................462 Economy Printing..............................................463 Get Information..................................................461 Media Type........................................................461 Print Preview.....................................................461 718 Index View set.............................................................462 About.................................................................351 Advanced Settings............................................350 Color Mode........................................................352 Color Settings....................................................352 Common Items..................................................350 Configuration using Advanced Settings.............352 Configuration using Easy Settings....................351 Defaults.............................................................351 Economy Printing..............................................352 Get Information..................................................350 Media Type........................................................350 Open Preview When Print Job Starts................350 Print Priority.......................................................352 Print Quality...............................................351, 352 Print Target........................................................351 Sharpen Text.....................................................352 Status Monitor...................................................350 Thicken Fine Lines............................................352 Unidirectional Printing.......................................352 View Settings.....................................................351 Maint. cart. The level is low.....................................709 Maintenance............................................................622 Maintenance Cartridge............................................639 Maintenance cartridge full.......................................709 Maintenance cartridge problem...............................709 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation...............................................................321 Mirror.................................................................321 Orientation.........................................................321 Rotate 180 degrees...........................................321 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Mac OS X)...........................................324 Making the Original Orientation Match the Paper Orientation (Windows).............................................322 Manual Adjustment to Straighten Lines and Colors (Head Posi. Adj.).....................................................606 Manual Banding Adjustment (Adj. Quality)..............616 Index Matching..........................................................490, 516 Input Profile...............................................490, 516 N Matching Method.......................................490, 516 Network Environment..............................................560 Matching Mode..........................................490, 516 Network Environment........................................562 Printer Profile.............................................490, 516 System requirements........................................560 Soft Proof..................................................491, 517 Network Setting.......................................................560 Matching Sheet (Windows).....................................359 Network Setting (Mac OS X)...................................596 Driver Matching Mode.......................................359 Network Setting (Windows).....................................581 ICC Matching Mode, Driver ICM Mode and Host ICM Mode..........................................................360 No ink left................................................................703 Input Profile Settings.........................................360 No Maintenance Cartridge capacity.........................709 Matching Method...............................................359 Matching Mode..........................................359, 360 Printer Profile Settings.......................................360 MediaType Mismatch..............................................689 Menu Operations.......................................................32 Accessing menus................................................33 Executing menu commands................................34 No ink tank loaded...................................................704 No printhead............................................................708 Not much ink is left..................................................704 Not Print Spaces at the Top/Bottom................385, 498 O Object Adjustment dialog box: Color.......................358 Graphics............................................................358 Specifying menu items........................................34 Image................................................................358 Specifying numerical values................................34 Menu Settings...........................................................49 Ink Menu..............................................................51 Text....................................................................358 Object Adjustment dialog box: Monochrome...........363 Graphics............................................................363 Job Menu.............................................................51 Image................................................................363 Paper Menu.........................................................49 Set./Adj. Menu.....................................................52 Menu Settings (During Printing)................................60 Ink Menu..............................................................60 Job Menu.............................................................60 Set./Adj. Menu.....................................................61 Menu Structure..........................................................35 Ink Menu..............................................................37 Job Menu.............................................................38 Text....................................................................363 Operating Environment...378, 390, 421, 476, 504, 536 Optional accessories.................................................70 Other Maintenance..................................................651 Other Messages...................................................... 711 Other problems........................................................684 Other useful settings...............................................318 Output Settings Panel.....................................485, 549 Borderless Printing....................................485, 549 Paper Menu.........................................................35 Enlarged/Reduced Printing.......................485, 549 Set./Adj. Menu.....................................................39 No Spaces at Top or Bottom.....................486, 550 Messages advising to check the maintenance cartridge are not cleared.........................................686 Output Method Button.......................................550 Paper Size.................................................486, 549 Messages regarding HP-GL/2.................................710 Print Button........................................................486 Messages regarding ink..........................................703 Print Centered...........................................486, 550 Messages regarding paper......................................689 Restore Defaults Button....................................486 Messages regarding printheads..............................707 Rotate Page..............................................486, 550 Messages regarding printing or adjustment............705 Messages regarding the maintenance cartridge.....709 Moving a Page................................................389, 503 Moving an Object............................................409, 529 Multi-sensor error....................................................712 Update Printer Info. Button................................486 Output Stacker........................................................150 P Page Options Dialog Box........................................397 Margins..............................................................398 Order.................................................................397 Index 719 Index Roll Paper Length..............................................397 Between Scans.................................................465 Page Options Dialog Box (Windows)......................370 Cut Speed.........................................................465 Format Settings.................................................370 Drying Time.......................................................465 Print Date..........................................................370 Media Type........................................................465 Print Page Number............................................370 Mirror.................................................................466 Print User Name................................................370 Near End Margin...............................................465 Page Setup Dialog Box...........................................523 Roll Paper Margin for Safety.............................465 Order.................................................................523 Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Windows)......354 Paper Orientation..............................................523 Between Pages.................................................354 Paper Size.........................................................524 Between Scans.................................................354 Roll Paper Length..............................................523 Cut Speed.........................................................354 Page Setup Pane (Mac OS X)................................471 Drying Time.......................................................354 Borderless Printing............................................471 Mirror.................................................................354 Enlarged/Reduced Printing...............................471 Near End Margin...............................................354 Fit Paper Size....................................................471 Roll Paper Margin for Safety.............................354 Fit Roll Paper Width..........................................471 Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Mac OS X)..............................................................464 Free Layout.......................................................472 No Spaces at Top or Bottom.............................472 Page Size..........................................................471 Paper Size.........................................................472 Paper Source....................................................471 Print Centered...................................................472 Roll Width..........................................................471 Rotate Page 90 degrees...................................472 Scaling...............................................................471 Page Setup Sheet (Windows).................................364 Borderless Printing............................................364 Defaults.............................................................366 Enlarged/Reduced Printing...............................365 Fit Paper Size............................................364, 365 Fit Roll Paper Width..........................................365 Orientation.........................................................365 Output Method...................................................366 Page Size..........................................................364 Paper Size.................................................364, 365 Paper Source....................................................365 Print Image with Actual Size..............................364 Roll Paper Options............................................365 Roll Paper Width...............................................365 Rotate Page 90 degrees (Conserve Paper)......365 Scale to fit Roll Paper Width..............................364 Scaling...............................................................365 Size Options......................................................366 Paper.........................................................................95 Paper cutting failed..................................................700 Paper Detailed Settings Dialog Box (Mac OS X)....465 Automatic Cutting..............................................465 Between Pages.................................................465 720 Index Paper Source....................................................464 Paper Information on Printer Dialog Box (Windows)...............................................................353 Paper Source....................................................353 Paper is crooked.....................................................698 Paper is not cut.......................................................665 Paper is not cut straight...........................................665 Paper jam................................................................697 Manually rewind the roll all the way and press OK.....................................................................697 Push the release lever back..............................697 Paper not aligned with right guide...........................699 Paper position not suitable for borderless printing....702 Paper rubs against the Printhead............................670 Paper Settings Panel...............................480, 508, 544 Automatic Cutting..............................................545 Copies...............................................481, 509, 545 Easy Settings / Advanced Settings....480, 508, 544 Media Type........................................480, 508, 544 Paper Source....................................480, 508, 544 Print Button................................................481, 509 Restore Defaults Button............................481, 509 Roll Paper Width...............................480, 508, 545 Update Printer Info. Button........................481, 509 Paper size not detected...........................................693 Paper Size Options Dialog Box (Windows).............367 Add....................................................................367 Custom Paper Size Name.................................367 Delete................................................................367 Paper Size.........................................................367 Paper Size List..................................................367 Units..................................................................367 Index Paper Sizes.............................................................100 Printhead.................................................................630 Rolls..................................................................100 Printhead error........................................................707 Sheets...............................................................101 Printheads...............................................................630 PaprWidth Mismatch...............................................692 Printing at full size...................................................219 Parts replacement time has passed........................712 Printing at Full Size (Mac OS X)..............................222 Pasting a Copied or Cut Object.......................415, 535 Printing at Full Size (Windows)...............................220 Pausing Printing........................................................94 Printing banners or at other non-standard sizes.....253 Preferences Dialog Box...........................395, 495, 521 Printing CAD Drawings............................................159 Auto Arrange Spacing...............................395, 522 Printing does not start.............................................667 Divisions....................................................395, 521 Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Mac OS X)..........................555 Grid Color..................................................395, 521 Gridlines....................................................395, 521 Object Frame Style....................................396, 521 Print Object Frames..........................................521 Units..................................................395, 495, 521 Prepare for parts replacement.................................712 Preparing to Transfer the Printer.............................651 Access the Move Printer menu.........................651 Completing the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER.................................................556 Registering a hot folder on your computer........555 Scanning the original and print an enlargement......................................................556 Printing Enlargements of Scanned Originals from a Color imageRUNNER (Windows)............................432 Pack the printer.................................................653 Completing the scanning settings on the Color imageRUNNER.................................................433 Remove paper...................................................651 Registering a hot folder on your computer........432 Remove the Ink Tank.........................................652 Scanning the original and print an enlargement......................................................433 Preview............................................................378, 476 Preview Main Window.....................................380, 478 Dialog Area................................................381, 479 Drawer Area......................................................479 Menu Bar...................................................380, 478 Preview Area.............................................381, 478 Status Area........................................................479 Status Bar..........................................................381 Tool Bar.....................................................380, 478 Print Area...................................................................75 Rolls....................................................................75 Sheets.................................................................75 Print on the Center..........................................384, 497 Print Page Rotated 90 Degrees..............................499 Print with No Borders..............................................496 Printed colors are inaccurate...................................673 Printed colors of lines are inaccurate during HP-GL/2 printing......................................................682 Printer Driver...................................................336, 454 Printer Driver Settings (Mac OS X).........................454 Printer Driver Settings (Windows)...........................336 Printer Menu Operations...........................................30 Menu operations during printing..........................31 Menu operations when no print job is in progress..............................................................30 Printer Parts..............................................................13 Printer Specifications.................................................71 Printing enlargements or reductions........................201 Printing From a Desired Starting Point............ 113, 141 Load paper in the desired position to start printing from.............................................. 113, 142 Set Width Detection to Off......................... 113, 141 Printing in Mac OS X.................................................84 Printing from the source application....................84 Registering the printer.........................................84 Printing in Windows...................................................83 Printing Interface Setting Reports.............................65 Confirming Interface Print information.................65 Printing Interface Print reports.............................65 Printing is faint.........................................................669 Printing Large Posters (Windows)...........................287 Printing Line Drawings and Text..............................160 Easy Settings....................................................160 Print Quality.......................................................161 Print Target........................................................160 Print targets for line drawings and text..............160 Printing Line Drawings and Text (Mac OS X)..........164 Printing Line Drawings and Text (Windows)............162 Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other........269 Free Layout (Windows).....................................269 imagePROGRAF Free Layout (Macintosh).......270 Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Mac OS X)..............................................................273 Index 721 Index Printing Multiple Originals Next to Each Other (Windows)...............................................................271 Printing Photos and Images (Mac OS X)................156 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously......................275 Printing Posters in Sections....................................286 Roll paper (banner)...........................................275 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Mac OS X)..............................................................278 Printing Multiple Pages Continuously (Windows)...............................................................276 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet...........................280 Page Layout......................................................280 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Mac OS X).......283 Printing Photos and Images (Windows)..................154 Page Layout......................................................286 Printing procedure.....................................................76 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing)...........................................253 Fit Roll Paper Width..........................................253 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Mac OS X).........................258 Print the banner.................................................259 Printing Multiple Pages Per Sheet (Windows).........281 Printing Office Documents.......................................171 Register a Custom Page Sizes.........................258 Easy Settings....................................................171 Printing Vertical or Horizontal Banners (Large-Format Printing; Windows)..........................254 Print Quality.......................................................171 Creating the banner in the application...............255 Print Target........................................................171 Printing the banner............................................255 Print targets for office documents......................171 Registering a Custom Paper Size.....................254 Printing Office Documents (Mac OS X)...................174 Printing with Selecting the Layout...........................387 Printing Office Documents (Windows).....................172 Printing With Watermarks........................................318 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes...................261 Watermark.........................................................318 Registering non-standard paper size in the printer driver......................................................261 Printing with Watermarks-COPY, FILE COPY, and so on (Windows)......................................................319 Specifying custom paper sizes for temporary use.....................................................................261 Printmonitor.............................................................557 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Mac OS X)..............................................................266 Folded Duplex...................................................418 Printing on Non-Standard Paper Sizes (Windows)...............................................................262 Printing by using Custom Paper Size................264 Printing by using Custom Size..........................262 Printing on Oversized Paper...................................219 Oversize............................................................219 Printing Options Using Rolls and Sheets..................76 Roll printing.........................................................76 Sheet printing......................................................77 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls.......................289 Centering originals relative to roll paper width....289 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Mac OS X)...292 Printing Originals Centered on Rolls (Windows).....290 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets....................295 Centering originals on sheets............................295 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Mac OS X)..............................................................298 Printing Originals Centered on Sheets (Windows)...............................................................296 Printing Photos and Images....................................152 Easy Settings....................................................152 Print Quality.......................................................153 Print Target........................................................152 Print targets for photos and images..................152 722 Index Prints using Folded Duplex.....................................418 Priority setting for rotating 90 degrees....................386 Problems Regarding Paper.....................................657 Problems with the printing quality............................669 Problems with the printing quality caused by the type of paper...........................................................678 R Reducing Dust from Cutting Rolls...........................134 Regular printing is selected, but a roll is loaded......696 Rel lever is in wrong position...................................701 Remaining level of the ink cannot be correctly detected...................................................................703 Removing Installed Printer Drivers..........................681 Removing imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility (Windows).........................................................681 Removing imagePROGRAF Status Monitor (Windows).........................................................681 Removing printer drivers (Windows).................681 Removing printer drivers and imagePROGRAF Printmonitor (Macintosh)...................................681 Removing Sheets....................................................144 Removing the Roll from the Printer......................... 116 Removing the Roll Holder from Rolls...................... 118 Replacing Ink Tanks................................................623 Index Access the menu for Ink Tank replacement......624 Compatible ink tanks.........................................623 Roll paper is not securely in contact with roll holder.......................................................................702 Install the ink tanks............................................625 Roll printing is selected, but sheets are loaded.......695 Make sure the printer is ready for Ink Tank replacement.......................................................623 Rotating an Object...........................................409, 529 Precautions when handling ink tanks................623 Remove the Ink Tank.........................................624 Replacing the Maintenance Cartridge.....................639 Access the menu for Maintenance Cartridge replacement.......................................................640 Compatible maintenance cartridges..................639 Make sure the printer is ready for Maintenance Cartridge replacement.......................................640 Precautions when handling the Maintenance Cartridge............................................................639 Replace the Maintenance Cartridge..................641 Replacing the Printhead..........................................633 Access the menu for Printhead replacement....634 Compatible printheads......................................633 Precautions when handling the Printhead.........633 Replace the Printhead.......................................635 When to replace the Printhead..........................633 Replotting with HP-GL/2 jobs is not possible..........683 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value.......213 Enlarged/Reduced Printing...............................213 Scaling...............................................................213 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Mac OS X)..............................................................216 Resizing Originals by Entering a Scaling Value (Windows)...............................................................214 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width...................207 Enlarged/Reduced Printing...............................207 Fit Roll Paper Width..........................................207 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Mac OS X)..............................................................210 Roll printing is selected...........................................694 S Searching Topics.........................................................3 Selecting a Feed Amount Adjustment Method (Feed Priority)..........................................................613 Selecting an Object.........................................407, 527 Setting the Print Parameters...........................431, 544 Apply Sharpness...............................................431 Setting the Unit Cost for Ink....................................442 To set different unit costs for each ink color......442 To set the same unit cost for all the inks...........442 Setting the Unit Cost for Items Other Than Ink and Paper.......................................................................444 Setting the Unit Cost for Paper................................443 Settings Summaries Dialog Box (Windows)............376 Copy..................................................................376 Sharing the Printer in Windows...............................582 Sheet printing is selected........................................696 Showing Job Properties..........................................448 Showing the Total Amount of Ink and Paper Consumed...............................................................448 Showing, Saving and Loading Selected Unit Cost Data.........................................................................448 Load Unit Cost Data..........................................448 Save Unit Cost Data..........................................448 Show Unit Cost Data.........................................448 Side...........................................................................15 Special Settings Dialog Box (Windows)..................371 Adjust faint lines................................................371 Resizing Originals to Fit the Roll Width (Windows)...............................................................208 Application Color Matching Priority...................371 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size............201 Fast Graphic Process........................................371 Enlarged/Reduced Printing...............................201 FineZoom Settings............................................371 Fit Paper Size....................................................201 Reduce Print Unevenness.................................371 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Mac OS X)..............................................................204 Specifications............................................................71 Resizing Originals to Match the Paper Size (Windows)...............................................................202 Interface..............................................................72 Roll Cover (Inside).....................................................17 Roll Holder Set..................................................70, 135 Roll Paper Cannot be Inserted into the Paper Feed Slot..........................................................................665 Roll Paper is Continuously Ejected.........................666 Enable Preview Switching.................................371 Ink........................................................................72 Options................................................................74 Output stacker capacity, in sheets.......................74 Paper...................................................................73 Printer..................................................................71 Printing performance...........................................71 Specifying an Existing Shared Folder as a Hot Folder......................................................................429 Index 723 Index Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings........167 Support Sheet (Windows).......................................375 Color Compatibility............................................167 Settings Summaries..........................................375 Specifying Colors and Printing CAD Drawings (Windows)...............................................................168 Support Information...........................................375 Specifying NetWare Print Services..........................588 Switching Between Displaying Jobs on Printer and Regularly Acquired Jobs..........................................447 Choosing the type of print services...................588 User Manual......................................................375 Using NWADMIN or PCONSOLE to set up the print server........................................................589 Specifying NetWare Protocols.................................591 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver.....................197 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Mac OS X)................................................88, 199, 455 Specifying Paper in the Printer Driver (Windows).................................................86, 197, 338 Specifying Printer-Related Information....................577 Specifying the Cutting Method for Rolls..................129 Eject (waiting for ink to dry after printing)..........130 Jobs on Printer..................................................447 Regularly Acquired Jobs....................................447 T The back side of the paper is dirty..........................672 The contrast becomes uneven during printing........676 The Data Reception Lamp on the Control Panel does not light up......................................................667 The display screen indicates Agitating....................667 The edges of the paper are dirty.............................671 Manual (when using media that cannot be cut with the Cutter Unit )..........................................131 The Features of Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy................................................................421, 536 Paper cutting (to have the roll cut at your specified position)..............................................132 The Features of Free Layout...........................390, 504 The Features of imagePROGRAF Printmonitor......557 Specifying the Ink Drying Time for Rolls..................127 The Features of imagePROGRAF Status Monitor....434 Mac OS X..........................................................128 The Features of Preview.................................378, 476 Windows............................................................127 The length of printed images is inaccurate in the feeding direction......................................................677 Specifying the Paper Length................................... 112 Specifying the Printer's Frame Type........................586 The paper is too small.....................................690, 691 Specifying the frame type using imagePROGRAF Device Setup Utility...........................................586 Replace paper with A4/LTR (vertical) or larger...691 Specifying the frame type using the printer Control Panel.....................................................587 Stand.........................................................................19 Starting Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy................................................................422, 537 To start by selecting imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy from the start button...........423 To start by selecting Printers and Faxes from the start button..................................................422 Starting Free Layout........................................391, 505 Starting Preview..............................................379, 477 Status Monitor.........................................................434 Status Print................................................................62 Checking the information in Status Print reports.................................................................62 Printing Status Print reports................................62 Support Pane (Mac OS X).......................................475 About.................................................................475 Settings.............................................................475 Support Information...........................................475 User Manual......................................................475 724 Index Remove paper and check pap. size..................691 Replace roll with 10 in. wide or larger roll..........691 The printer consumes a lot of ink............................686 The printer does not go on......................................684 The printer does not respond even if print jobs are sent..........................................................................667 The printer ejects blank, unprinted paper................668 The printer stops during a print job..........................668 The printer stops when printing a HP-GL/2 job (the carriage stops moving).............................668, 683 The roll is empty......................................................695 The size of clear film cannot be detected................665 The surface of the paper is dirty..............................672 This paper cannot be used......................................694 This type of paper is not compatible with HP-GL/2..................................................................710 Tiling and multiple pages per sheet.........................269 Top Cover (Inside).....................................................16 Top cover is open.................................................... 711 Troubleshooting.......................................................655 Troubleshooting Paper Abrasion and Blurry Images (Head Height).......................................................... 611 Index Turning the Printer On and Off..................................24 Turning the printer off..........................................25 W Turning the printer on..........................................24 When to Replace Ink Tanks.....................................629 Types of Paper..........................................................95 Before print jobs and maintenance that consume a lot of ink..........................................................629 Accessing the Paper Reference Guide from imagePROGRAF Support Information................95 If a message for checking the ink is shown on the Display Screen............................................629 Updating paper information.................................98 U Unable to detect ink level correctly..........................703 If a message for ink replacement is shown on the Display Screen............................................629 When to Replace the Maintenance Cartridge.........645 If a message for checking the Maintenance Cartridge is shown on the Display Screen........645 Unknown file............................................................712 If a message for the Maintenance Cartridge replacement is shown on the Display Screen...645 Updating the Firmware............................................654 Confirming the firmware version........................654 When much of the Maintenance Cartridge capacity is depleted...........................................645 Updating the Firmware......................................654 Using Favorites.......................................................327 Favorites............................................................327 Using Favorites (Mac OS X)............................330, 460 Using Favorites (Windows).............................328, 344 Printing using the favorite..........................329, 345 Registering a favorite................................328, 344 Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals................450 Using PosterArtist to Compose Originals ...............450 Using RemoteUI......................................................569 Using the Output Stacker........................................150 Note regarding the Extended position...............151 Windows Software...................................................336 With HP-GL/2, printing is misaligned.......................682 Working With Various Print Jobs.............................152 Wrong ink tank.........................................................704 Wrong maintenance cartridge.................................709 Wrong printhead......................................................707 Z Zoom Dialog Box.....................................398, 495, 524 Scaling...............................................398, 495, 524 Using the ruler.........................................................389 Utility Pane (Mac OS X)..........................................473 Set.....................................................................473 View...................................................................473 Utility Sheet (Windows)...........................................374 Color imageRUNNER Enlargement Copy.........374 Maintenance......................................................374 V View settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Mac OS X)..............................................................466 Details...............................................................466 Name.................................................................466 Print Target........................................................466 View Settings Dialog Box for the Printing Application (Windows)...............................................................355 Details...............................................................355 Name.................................................................355 Print Target........................................................355 Index 725 ©CANON INC. 2009
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.4 Linearized : Yes Create Date : 2009:04:24 14:40:56+09:00 Keywords : eng Modify Date : 2009:04:30 10:16:24+09:00 Light Source : Unknown Trapped : Unknown Creation Date : 2009:04:24 14:40:56+09:00 Mod Date : 2009:04:30 10:16:24+09:00 Author : CANON INC. Metadata Date : 2009:04:30 10:16:24+09:00 Document ID : uuid:22adccfa-ee8c-405d-acd1-16b33a9d9589 Instance ID : uuid:3bf74602-b1b9-42ca-8bc7-edd836874002 Format : application/pdf Title : iPF750 User Manual Description : V01 Creator : CANON INC. Subject : eng Page Count : 742 Page Layout : SinglePage Page Mode : UseOutlinesEXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools